t60 Manual GE
t60 Manual GE
t60 Manual GE
g
GE Industrial Systems
828743A1.CDR
E83849
T
GIS ERE
RE
GE Multilin ISO9001:2000
LISTED EM I
G
g
GE Industrial Systems
ADDENDUM
This Addendum contains information that relates to the T60 Transformer Management Relay relay, version 3.4x. This
addendum lists a number of information items that appear in the instruction manual GEK-106448B (revision F3) but
are not included in the current T60 operations.
The following functions/items are not yet available with the current version of the T60 relay:
• Signal Sources SRC 5 and SRC 6
The UCA2 specifications are not yet finalized. There will be changes to the object models described in
Appendix C: UCA/MMS Protocol.
NOTE
GE Multilin
215 Anderson Avenue, Markham, Ontario
Canada L6E 1B3
Tel: (905) 294-6222 Fax: (905) 201-2098
Internet: http://www.GEindustrial.com/multilin
Table of Contents
TABLE OF CONTENTS
INDEX
Before attempting to install or use the relay, it is imperative that all WARNINGS and CAU-
TIONS in this manual are reviewed to help prevent personal injury, equipment damage, and/
or downtime.
WARNING CAUTION
• Open the relay packaging and inspect the unit for physical damage.
• View the rear nameplate and verify that the correct model has been ordered.
Technical Support:
Made in
Tel: (905) 294-6222 http://www.ge.com/indsys/pm ®
®
Canada
Fax: (905) 201-2098 - M A A B 9 7 0 0 0 0 9 9 -
1 Historically, substation protection, control, and metering functions were performed with electromechanical equipment. This
first generation of equipment was gradually replaced by analog electronic equipment, most of which emulated the single-
function approach of their electromechanical precursors. Both of these technologies required expensive cabling and auxil-
iary equipment to produce functioning systems.
Recently, digital electronic equipment has begun to provide protection, control, and metering functions. Initially, this equip-
ment was either single function or had very limited multi-function capability, and did not significantly reduce the cabling and
auxiliary equipment required. However, recent digital relays have become quite multi-functional, reducing cabling and aux-
iliaries significantly. These devices also transfer data to central control facilities and Human Machine Interfaces using elec-
tronic communications. The functions performed by these products have become so broad that many users now prefer the
term IED (Intelligent Electronic Device).
It is obvious to station designers that the amount of cabling and auxiliary equipment installed in stations can be even further
reduced, to 20% to 70% of the levels common in 1990, to achieve large cost reductions. This requires placing even more
functions within the IEDs.
Users of power equipment are also interested in reducing cost by improving power quality and personnel productivity, and
as always, in increasing system reliability and efficiency. These objectives are realized through software which is used to
perform functions at both the station and supervisory levels. The use of these systems is growing rapidly.
High speed communications are required to meet the data transfer rates required by modern automatic control and moni-
toring systems. In the near future, very high speed communications will be required to perform protection signaling with a
performance target response time for a command signal between two IEDs, from transmission to reception, of less than 5
milliseconds. This has been established by the Electric Power Research Institute, a collective body of many American and
Canadian power utilities, in their Utilities Communications Architecture 2 (MMS/UCA2) project. In late 1998, some Euro-
pean utilities began to show an interest in this ongoing initiative.
IEDs with the capabilities outlined above will also provide significantly more power system data than is presently available,
enhance operations and maintenance, and permit the use of adaptive system configuration for protection and control sys-
tems. This new generation of equipment must also be easily incorporated into automation systems, at both the station and
enterprise levels. The GE Multilin Universal Relay (UR) has been developed to meet these goals.
a) UR BASIC DESIGN 1
The UR is a digital-based device containing a central processing unit (CPU) that handles multiple types of input and output
signals. The UR can communicate over a local area network (LAN) with an operator interface, a programming device, or
another UR device.
LAN
Programming Operator
Device Interface
827822A2.CDR
b) UR SIGNAL TYPES
The contact inputs and outputs are digital signals associated with connections to hard-wired contacts. Both ‘wet’ and ‘dry’
contacts are supported.
The virtual inputs and outputs are digital signals associated with UR-series internal logic signals. Virtual inputs include
signals generated by the local user interface. The virtual outputs are outputs of FlexLogic™ equations used to customize
the device. Virtual outputs can also serve as virtual inputs to FlexLogic™ equations.
The analog inputs and outputs are signals that are associated with transducers, such as Resistance Temperature Detec-
tors (RTDs).
The CT and VT inputs refer to analog current transformer and voltage transformer signals used to monitor AC power lines.
The UR-series relays support 1 A and 5 A CTs.
The remote inputs and outputs provide a means of sharing digital point state information between remote UR-series
devices. The remote outputs interface to the remote inputs of other UR-series devices. Remote outputs are FlexLogic™
operands inserted into UCA2 GOOSE messages and are of two assignment types: DNA standard functions and user-
defined (UserSt) functions.
The direct inputs and outputs provide a means of sharing digital point states between a number of UR-series IEDs over a
dedicated fiber (single or multimode), RS422, or G.703 interface. No switching equipment is required as the IEDs are con-
nected directly in a ring or redundant (dual) ring configuration. This feature is optimized for speed and intended for pilot-
aided schemes, distributed logic applications, or the extension of the input/output capabilities of a single relay chassis.
c) UR SCAN OPERATION
1 The UR-series devices operate in a cyclic scan fashion. The device reads the inputs into an input status table, solves the
logic program (FlexLogic™ equation), and then sets each output to the appropriate state in an output status table. Any
resulting task execution is priority interrupt-driven.
Read Inputs
Protection elements
serviced by sub-scan
Protective Elements
PKP
Solve Logic DPO
OP
Set Outputs
827823A1.CDR
The firmware (software embedded in the relay) is designed in functional modules which can be installed in any relay as
required. This is achieved with Object-Oriented Design and Programming (OOD/OOP) techniques.
Object-Oriented techniques involve the use of ‘objects’ and ‘classes’. An ‘object’ is defined as “a logical entity that contains
both data and code that manipulates that data”. A ‘class’ is the generalized form of similar objects. By using this concept,
one can create a Protection Class with the Protection Elements as objects of the class such as Time Overcurrent, Instanta-
neous Overcurrent, Current Differential, Undervoltage, Overvoltage, Underfrequency, and Distance. These objects repre-
sent completely self-contained software modules. The same object-class concept can be used for Metering, I/O Control,
HMI, Communications, or any functional entity in the system.
Employing OOD/OOP in the software architecture of the Universal Relay achieves the same features as the hardware
architecture: modularity, scalability, and flexibility. The application software for any Universal Relay (e.g. Feeder Protection,
Transformer Protection, Distance Protection) is constructed by combining objects from the various functionality classes.
This results in a ’common look and feel’ across the entire family of UR-series platform-based applications.
As described above, the architecture of the UR-series relays differ from previous devices. To achieve a general understand-
ing of this device, some sections of Chapter 5 are quite helpful. The most important functions of the relay are contained in
“elements”. A description of the UR-series elements can be found in the Introduction to Elements section in Chapter 5. An
example of a simple element, and some of the organization of this manual, can be found in the Digital Elements section. An
explanation of the use of inputs from CTs and VTs is in the Introduction to AC Sources section in Chapter 5. A description of
how digital signals are used and routed within the relay is contained in the Introduction to FlexLogic™ section in Chapter 5.
The faceplate keypad and display or the EnerVista UR Setup software interface can be used to communicate with the relay.
1
The EnerVista UR Setup software interface is the preferred method to edit settings and view actual values because the PC
monitor can display more information in a simple comprehensible format.
The following minimum requirements must be met for the EnerVista UR Setup software to properly operate on a PC.
• Pentium class or higher processor (Pentium II 300 MHz or higher recommended)
• Windows 95, 98, 98SE, ME, NT 4.0 (Service Pack 4 or higher), 2000, XP
• 64 MB of RAM (256 MB recommended) and 50 MB of available hard drive space (200 MB recommended)
• Video capable of displaying 800 x 600 or higher in High Color mode (16-bit color)
• RS232 and/or Ethernet port for communications to the relay
1.3.2 INSTALLATION
After ensuring the minimum requirements for using EnerVista UR Setup are met (see previous section), use the following
procedure to install the EnerVista UR Setup from the enclosed GE enerVista CD.
1. Insert the GE enerVista CD into your CD-ROM drive.
2. Click the Install Now button and follow the installation instructions to install the no-charge enerVista software.
3. When installation is complete, start the enerVista Launchpad application.
4. Click the IED Setup section of the Launch Pad window.
5. In the enerVista Launch Pad window, click the Install Software button and select the “T60 Transformer Management
Relay” from the Install Software window as shown below. Select the “Web” option to ensure the most recent software
release, or select “CD” if you do not have a web connection, then click the Check Now button to list software items for
the T60.
1
6. Select the T60 software program and release notes (if desired) from the list and click the Download Now button to
obtain the installation program.
7. enerVista Launchpad will obtain the installation program from the Web or CD. Once the download is complete, double-
click the installation program to install the EnerVista UR Setup software.
8. Select the complete path, including the new directory name, where the EnerVista UR Setup will be installed.
9. Click on Next to begin the installation. The files will be installed in the directory indicated and the installation program
will automatically create icons and add EnerVista UR Setup to the Windows start menu.
10. Click Finish to end the installation. The T60 device will be added to the list of installed IEDs in the enerVista Launch-
pad window, as shown below.
1
1 This section is intended as a quick start guide to using the EnerVista UR Setup software. Please refer to the EnerVista UR
Setup Help File and Chapter 4 of this manual for more information.
• Enter the Modbus port address (from the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS MODBUS PROTOCOL
MODBUS TCP PORT NUMBER setting) in the “Modbus Port” field.
9. Click the Read Order Code button to connect to the T60 device and upload the order code. If an communications error
occurs, ensure that the three EnerVista UR Setup values entered in the previous step correspond to the relay setting
values.
10. Click OK when the relay order code has been received. The new device will be added to the Site List window (or
Online window) located in the top left corner of the main EnerVista UR Setup window.
The Site Device has now been configured for Ethernet communications. Proceed to Section c) below to begin communica-
tions.
• Enter the relay slave address and COM port values (from the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS
SERIAL PORTS menu) in the “Slave Address” and “COM Port” fields.
• Enter the physical communications parameters (baud rate and parity settings) in their respective fields.
1
8. Click the Read Order Code button to connect to the T60 device and upload the order code. If an communications error
occurs, ensure that the EnerVista UR Setup serial communications values entered in the previous step correspond to
the relay setting values.
9. Click “OK” when the relay order code has been received. The new device will be added to the Site List window (or
Online window) located in the top left corner of the main EnerVista UR Setup window.
The Site Device has now been configured for RS232 communications. Proceed to Section c) Connecting to the Relay
below to begin communications.
2. The Display Properties window will open with a flashing status indicator on the lower left of the EnerVista UR Setup
window.
3. If the status indicator is red, verify that the Ethernet network cable is properly connected to the Ethernet port on the
back of the relay and that the relay has been properly setup for communications (steps A and B earlier).
4. The Display Properties settings can now be edited, printed, or changed according to user specifications.
Refer to Chapter 4 in this manual and the EnerVista UR Setup Help File for more information about the
using the EnerVista UR Setup software interface.
NOTE
1 Please refer to Chapter 3: Hardware for detailed mounting and wiring instructions. Review all WARNINGS and CAUTIONS
carefully.
1.4.2 COMMUNICATIONS
The EnerVista UR Setup software communicates to the relay via the faceplate RS232 port or the rear panel RS485 / Ether-
net ports. To communicate via the faceplate RS232 port, a standard “straight-through” serial cable is used. The DB-9 male
end is connected to the relay and the DB-9 or DB-25 female end is connected to the PC COM1 or COM2 port as described
in the CPU Communications Ports section of Chapter 3.
All messages are displayed on a 2 × 20 character vacuum fluorescent display to make them visible under poor lighting con-
ditions. An optional liquid crystal display (LCD) is also available. Messages are displayed in English and do not require the
aid of an instruction manual for deciphering. While the keypad and display are not actively being used, the display will
default to defined messages. Any high priority event driven message will automatically override the default message and
appear on the display.
Display messages are organized into ‘pages’ under the following headings: Actual Values, Settings, Commands, and Tar-
1
gets. The key navigates through these pages. Each heading page is broken down further into logical subgroups.
The MESSAGE keys navigate through the subgroups. The VALUE keys scroll increment or decrement
numerical setting values when in programming mode. These keys also scroll through alphanumeric values in the text edit
mode. Alternatively, values may also be entered with the numeric keypad.
The key initiates and advance to the next character in text edit mode or enters a decimal point. The key may be
pressed at any time for context sensitive help messages. The key stores altered setting values.
Press the key to select the desired header display page (top-level menu). The header title appears momentarily fol-
lowed by a header display page menu item. Each press of the key advances through the main heading pages as
illustrated below.
USER DISPLAYS
(when in use)
User Display 1
The setting and actual value messages are arranged hierarchically. The header display pages are indicated by double
scroll bar characters ( ), while sub-header pages are indicated by single scroll bar characters ( ). The header display
pages represent the highest level of the hierarchy and the sub-header display pages fall below this level. The MESSAGE
and keys move within a group of headers, sub-headers, setting values, or actual values. Continually pressing the
MESSAGE key from a header display displays specific information for the header category. Conversely, continually
pressing the MESSAGE key from a setting value or actual value display returns to the header display.
SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP
1 The relay is defaulted to the “Not Programmed” state when it leaves the factory. This safeguards against the installation of
a relay whose settings have not been entered. When powered up successfully, the Trouble LED will be on and the In Ser-
vice LED off. The relay in the “Not Programmed” state will block signaling of any output relay. These conditions will remain
until the relay is explicitly put in the “Programmed” state.
Select the menu message SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP INSTALLATION RELAY SETTINGS
RELAY SETTINGS:
Not Programmed
To put the relay in the “Programmed” state, press either of the VALUE keys once and then press . The face-
plate Trouble LED will turn off and the In Service LED will turn on. The settings for the relay can be programmed manually
(refer to Chapter 5) via the faceplate keypad or remotely (refer to the EnerVista UR Setup Help file) via the EnerVista UR
Setup software interface.
It is recommended that passwords be set up for each security level and assigned to specific personnel. There are two user
password security access levels, COMMAND and SETTING:
1. COMMAND
The COMMAND access level restricts the user from making any settings changes, but allows the user to perform the fol-
lowing operations:
• change state of virtual inputs
• clear event records
• clear oscillography records
• operate user-programmable pushbuttons
2. SETTING
The SETTING access level allows the user to make any changes to any of the setting values.
Refer to the Changing Settings section in Chapter 4 for complete instructions on setting up security level
passwords.
NOTE
FlexLogic™ equation editing is required for setting up user-defined logic for customizing the relay operations. See the Flex-
Logic™ section in Chapter 5 for additional details.
1.5.7 COMMISSIONING
Templated tables for charting all the required settings before entering them via the keypad are available from the GE Multi-
lin website at http://www.GEindustrial.com/multilin. Commissioning tests are also included in the COMMISSIONING chap-
ter of this manual.
The T60 Transformer Management Relay is a microprocessor-based relay for protection of small, medium, and large three-
phase power transformers. The relay can be configured with a maximum of four three-phase current inputs and four ground
current inputs, and can satisfy applications with transformer windings connected between two breakers, such as in a ring
bus or in breaker-and-a-half configurations. The T60 performs magnitude and phase shift compensation internally, eliminat-
ing requirements for external CT connections and auxiliary CTs.
The Percent Differential element is the main protection device in the T60. Instantaneous Differential protection, Volts-per- 2
Hertz, Restricted Ground Fault, and many current, voltage, and frequency-based protection elements are also incorpo-
rated. The T60 includes sixteen fully programmable universal comparators, or FlexElements™, that provide additional flex-
ibility by allowing the user to customize their own protection functions that respond to any signals measured or calculated
by the relay.
The metering functions of the T60 include true RMS and phasors for currents and voltages, current harmonics and THD,
symmetrical components, frequency, power, power factor, and energy.
Diagnostic features include an Event Recorder capable of storing 1024 time-tagged events, oscillography capable of stor-
ing up to 64 records with programmable trigger, content and sampling rate, and Data Logger acquisition of up to 16 chan-
nels, with programmable content and sampling rate. Diagnostic features include a sequence of records capable of storing
1024 time-tagged events. The internal clock used for time-tagging can be synchronized with an IRIG-B signal or via the
SNTP protocol over the Ethernet port. This precise time stamping allows the sequence of events to be determined through-
out the system. Events can also be programmed (via FlexLogic™ equations) to trigger oscillography data capture which
may be set to record the measured parameters before and after the event for viewing on a personal computer (PC). These
tools significantly reduce troubleshooting time and simplify report generation in the event of a system fault.
A faceplate RS232 port may be used to connect to a PC for the programming of settings and the monitoring of actual val-
ues. A variety of communications modules are available. Two rear RS485 ports allow independent access by operating and
engineering staff. All serial ports use the Modbus® RTU protocol. The RS485 ports may be connected to system computers
with baud rates up to 115.2 kbps. The RS232 port has a fixed baud rate of 19.2 kbps. Optional communications modules
include a 10BaseF Ethernet interface which can be used to provide fast, reliable communications in noisy environments.
Another option provides two 10BaseF fiber optic ports for redundancy. The Ethernet port supports MMS/UCA2, Modbus®/
TCP, and TFTP protocols, and allows access to the relay via any standard web browser (UR web pages). The IEC 60870-
5-104 protocol is supported on the Ethernet port. DNP 3.0 and IEC 60870-5-104 cannot be enabled at the same time.
The T60 IEDs use flash memory technology which allows field upgrading as new features are added. The following Single
Line Diagram illustrates the relay functionality using ANSI (American National Standards Institute) device numbers.
TYPICAL CONFIGURATION
THE AC SIGNAL PATH IS CONFIGURABLE
Winding 1 Winding 2
3 3
2
50P-1 50G-1 50G-2 50P-2
67P
3V_0
67N
87G-1 87G-2
51N-1 51N-2
50N-1 50N-2
Calculate Calculate
3I_0 3I_0
50/87
Block
87T
Metering
59N 24 81 U 81 O 27X
2.1.2 ORDERING
The relay is available as a 19-inch rack horizontal mount unit or as a reduced size (¾) vertical mount unit, and consists of
the following module functions: power supply, CPU, CT/VT DSP, digital input/output, transducer input/output. Each of these
modules can be supplied in a number of configurations which must be specified at the time of ordering. The information
required to completely specify the relay is provided in the following table (full details of available relay modules are con-
tained in Chapter 3: Hardware).
2 Table 2–3: T60 ORDER CODES
T60 - * 00 - H * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - P ** - U ** - W ** Full Size Horizontal Mount
T60 - * 00 - V * * - F ** - H ** - M ** - # ** Reduced Size Vertical Mount (see note below for value of slot #)
BASE UNIT T60 | | | | | | | | | | | Base Unit
CPU A | | | | | | | | | | RS485 + RS485 (ModBus RTU, DNP)
C | | | | | | | | | | RS485 + 10BaseF (MMS/UCA2, Modbus TCP/IP, DNP)
D | | | | | | | | | | RS485 + Redundant 10BaseF (MMS/UCA2, Modbus TCP/IP, DNP)
SOFTWARE 00 | | | | | | | | | No Software Options
MOUNT/ H C | | | | | | | Horizontal (19” rack)
FACEPLATE Horizontal (19” rack) with User-Programmable Pushbuttons
H P | | | | | | |
V F | | | | | | | Vertical (3/4 rack)
POWER H | | | | | | 125 / 250 V AC/DC
SUPPLY 24 to 48 V (DC only)
L | | | | | |
CT/VT DSP 8A | 8A | | | Standard 4CT/4VT
8B | 8B | | | Sensitive Ground 4CT/4VT
8C | 8C | | | Standard 8CT
8D | 8D | | | Sensitive Ground 8CT
DIGITAL I/O | XX XX XX XX No Module
4A 4A 4A 4A 4A 4 Solid-State (No Monitoring) MOSFET Outputs
4B 4B 4B 4B 4B 4 Solid-State (Voltage w/ opt Current) MOSFET Outputs
4C 4C 4C 4C 4C 4 Solid-State (Current w/ opt Voltage) MOSFET Outputs
4L 4L 4L 4L 4L 14 Form-A (No Monitoring) Latchable Outputs
67 67 67 67 67 8 Form-A (No Monitoring) Outputs
6A 6A 6A 6A 6A 2 Form-A (Volt w/ opt Curr) & 2 Form-C outputs, 8 Digital Inputs
6B 6B 6B 6B 6B 2 Form-A (Volt w/ opt Curr) & 4 Form-C Outputs, 4 Digital Inputs
6C 6C 6C 6C 6C 8 Form-C Outputs
6D 6D 6D 6D 6D 16 Digital Inputs
6E 6E 6E 6E 6E 4 Form-C Outputs, 8 Digital Inputs
6F 6F 6F 6F 6F 8 Fast Form-C Outputs
6G 6G 6G 6G 6G 4 Form-A (Voltage w/ opt Current) Outputs, 8 Digital Inputs
6H 6H 6H 6H 6H 6 Form-A (Voltage w/ opt Current) Outputs, 4 Digital Inputs
6K 6K 6K 6K 6K 4 Form-C & 4 Fast Form-C Outputs
6L 6L 6L 6L 6L 2 Form-A (Curr w/ opt Volt) & 2 Form-C Outputs, 8 Digital Inputs
6M 6M 6M 6M 6M 2 Form-A (Curr w/ opt Volt) & 4 Form-C Outputs, 4 Digital Inputs
6N 6N 6N 6N 6N 4 Form-A (Current w/ opt Voltage) Outputs, 8 Digital Inputs
6P 6P 6P 6P 6P 6 Form-A (Current w/ opt Voltage) Outputs, 4 Digital Inputs
6R 6R 6R 6R 6R 2 Form-A (No Monitoring) & 2 Form-C Outputs, 8 Digital Inputs
6S 6S 6S 6S 6S 2 Form-A (No Monitoring) & 4 Form-C Outputs, 4 Digital Inputs
6T 6T 6T 6T 6T 4 Form-A (No Monitoring) Outputs, 8 Digital Inputs
6U 6U 6U 6U 6U 6 Form-A (No Monitoring) Outputs, 4 Digital Inputs
TRANSDUCER I/O 5C 5C 5C 5C 5C 8 RTD Inputs
(maximum of 3 per unit)
5E 5E 5E 5E 5E 4 RTD Inputs, 4 dcmA Inputs
5F 5F 5F 5F 5F 8 dcmA Inputs
INTER-RELAY 7A 820 nm, multi-mode, LED, 1 Channel
COMMUNICATIONS
7B 1300 nm, multi-mode, LED, 1 Channel
7C 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 1 Channel
7D 1300 nm, single-mode, LASER, 1 Channel
7H 820 nm, multi-mode, LED, 2 Channels
7I 1300 nm, multi-mode, LED, 2 Channels
7J 1300 nm, single-mode, ELED, 2 Channels
7K 1300 nm, single-mode, LASER, 2 Channels
7L Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 820 nm, multi-mode, LED
7M Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, multi-mode, LED
7P Channel 1 - RS422; Channel 2 - 1300 nm, single-mode, LASER
7R G.703, 1 Channel
7S G.703, 2 Channels
7T RS422, 1 Channel
7W RS422, 2 Channels
For vertical mounting units, # = slot P for digital and transducer 72 1550 nm, single-mode, LASER, 1 Channel
input/output modules; # = slot R for inter-relay communications
73 1550 nm, single-mode, LASER, 2 Channel
NOTE modules
76 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, multi-mode, LED, 1 Channel
77 IEEE C37.94, 820 nm, multi-mode, LED, 2 Channels
The order codes for replacement modules to be ordered separately are shown in the following table. When ordering a
replacement CPU module or Faceplate, please provide the serial number of your existing unit.
The operating times below include the activation time of a trip rated Form-A output contact unless otherwise indi-
cated. FlexLogic™ operands of a given element are 4 ms faster. This should be taken into account when using
NOTE
FlexLogic™ to interconnect with other protection or control elements of the relay, building FlexLogic™ equations, or
2 interfacing with other IEDs or power system devices via communications or different output contacts.
PERCENT DIFFERENTIAL PHASE/NEUTRAL/GROUND TOC
Characteristic: Differential Restraint pre-set Current: Phasor or RMS
Number of zones: 2 Pickup level: 0.000 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001
Minimum pickup: 0.05 to 1.00 pu in steps of 0.001 Dropout level: 97% to 98% of Pickup
Slope 1 range: 15 to 100% in steps of 1% Level accuracy:
Slope 2 range: 50 to 100% in steps of 1% for 0.1 to 2.0 × CT: ±0.5% of reading or ±1% of rated
(whichever is greater)
Kneepoint 1: 1.0 to 2.0 pu in steps of 0.0001
for > 2.0 × CT: ±1.5% of reading > 2.0 × CT rating
Kneepoint 2: 2.0 to 30.0 pu in steps of 0.0001
Curve shapes: IEEE Moderately/Very/Extremely
2nd harmonic inhibit level: 1.0 to 40.0% in steps of 0.1 Inverse; IEC (and BS) A/B/C and Short
2nd harmonic inhibit function: Adaptive, Traditional, Disabled Inverse; GE IAC Inverse, Short/Very/
2nd harmonic inhibit mode: Per-phase, 2-out-of-3, Average Extremely Inverse; I2t; FlexCurves™
5th harmonic inhibit range: 1.0 to 40.0% in steps of 0.1 (programmable); Definite Time (0.01 s
base curve)
Operate times:
Harmonic inhibits selected: 20 to 30 ms at 60 Hz; Curve multiplier: Time Dial = 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of
20 to 35 ms at 50 Hz 0.01
No harmonic inhibits selected: 5 to 20 ms Reset type: Instantaneous/Timed (per IEEE)
Dropout level: 97 to 98% of pickup Timing accuracy: Operate at > 1.03 × actual Pickup
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading or ±1% of rated ±3.5% of operate time or ±½ cycle
(whichever is greater) (whichever is greater)
Characteristic angle:
Independent for forward and reverse
–90 to 90° in steps of 1
Operate time: < 30 ms at 1.10 × Pickup at 60 Hz 2
AUXILIARY OVERVOLTAGE
Limit angle: 40 to 90° in steps of 1, independent for Pickup level: 0.000 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001
forward and reverse
Dropout level: 97 to 98% of Pickup
Angle accuracy: ±2°
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading from 10 to 208 V
Offset impedance: 0.00 to 250.00 Ω in steps of 0.01
Pickup delay: 0 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Pickup level: 0.002 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.01
Reset delay: 0 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
Dropout level: 97 to 98%
Timing accuracy: ±3% of operate time or ±4 ms
Operation time: < 16 ms at 3 × Pickup at 60 Hz
(whichever is greater)
PHASE UNDERVOLTAGE Operate time: < 30 ms at 1.10 × pickup at 60 Hz
Pickup level: 0.000 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001
VOLTS PER HERTZ
Dropout level: 102 to 103% of Pickup Voltage: Phasor only
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading from 10 to 208 V Pickup level: 0.80 to 4.00 in steps of 0.01 pu V/Hz
Curve shapes: GE IAV Inverse; Dropout level: 97 to 98% of Pickup
Definite Time (0.1s base curve)
Level accuracy: ±0.02 pu
Curve multiplier: Time Dial = 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of
0.01 Timing curves: Definite Time; Inverse A, B, and C,
FlexCurves™ A, B, C, and D
Timing accuracy: Operate at < 0.90 × Pickup
TD Multiplier: 0.05 to 600.00 s in steps of 0.01
±3.5% of operate time or ±4 ms (which-
ever is greater) Reset delay: 0.0 to 1000.0 s in steps of 0.1
Timing accuracy: ±3% or ± 4 ms (whichever is greater)
AUXILIARY UNDERVOLTAGE
Pickup level: 0.000 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001 UNDERFREQUENCY
Dropout level: 102 to 103% of pickup Minimum signal: 0.10 to 1.25 pu in steps of 0.01
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading from 10 to 208 V Pickup level: 20.00 to 65.00 Hz in steps of 0.01
Curve shapes: GE IAV Inverse, Definite Time Dropout level: Pickup + 0.03 Hz
Curve multiplier: Time Dial = 0 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 Level accuracy: ±0.01 Hz
Timing accuracy: ±3% of operate time or ±4 ms Time delay: 0 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
(whichever is greater) Timer accuracy: ±3% or 4 ms, whichever is greater
PHASE OVERVOLTAGE OVERFREQUENCY
Voltage: Phasor only Pickup level: 20.00 to 65.00 Hz in steps of 0.01
Pickup level: 0.000 to 3.000 pu in steps of 0.001 Dropout level: Pickup – 0.03 Hz
Dropout level: 97 to 98% of Pickup Level accuracy: ±0.01 Hz
Level accuracy: ±0.5% of reading from 10 to 208 V Time delay: 0 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
Pickup delay: 0.00 to 600.00 in steps of 0.01 s Timer accuracy: ±3% or 4 ms, whichever is greater
Operate time: < 30 ms at 1.10 × Pickup at 60 Hz
Timing accuracy: ±3% or ±4 ms (whichever is greater)
Programmability: any logical variable, contact, or virtual Operation: drive FlexLogic™ operands
input USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUTTONS (OPTIONAL)
FLEXELEMENTS™ Number of pushbuttons: 12
Number of elements: 16 Mode: Self-Reset, Latched
Operating signal: any analog actual value, or two values in Display message: 2 lines of 20 characters each
differential mode SELECTOR SWITCH
Operating signal mode: Signed or Absolute Value Number of elements: 2
Operating mode: Level, Delta Upper position limit: 1 to 7 in steps of 1
Comparator direction: Over, Under Selecting mode: Time-out or Acknowledge
Pickup Level: –30.000 to 30.000 pu in steps of 0.001 Time-out timer: 3.0 to 60.0 s in steps of 0.1
Hysteresis: 0.1 to 50.0% in steps of 0.1 Control inputs: step-up and 3-bit
Delta dt: 20 ms to 60 days Power-up mode: restore from non-volatile memory or syn-
Pickup & dropout delay: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001 chronize to a 3-bit control input or Synch/
Restore mode
NON-VOLATILE LATCHES
Type: Set-dominant or Reset-dominant
Number: 16 (individually programmed)
Output: Stored in non-volatile memory
Execution sequence: As input prior to protection, control, and
FlexLogic™
2.2.3 MONITORING
2.2.4 METERING
2.2.5 INPUTS
2.2.7 OUTPUTS
LATCHING RELAY 48 V DC 2 KΩ 2 KΩ
Make and carry for 0.2 s: 30 A as per ANSI C37.90 24 V DC 2 KΩ 2 KΩ
Carry continuous: 6A Note: values for 24 V and 48 V are the same due to a
required 95% voltage drop across the load impedance.
Break at L/R of 40 ms: 0.25 A DC max.
Operate time: < 4 ms Operate time: < 0.6 ms
Contact material: Silver alloy INTERNAL LIMITING RESISTOR:
Control: separate operate and reset inputs Power: 2 watts
Control mode: operate-dominant or reset-dominant Resistance: 100 ohms
2.2.8 COMMUNICATIONS
2.2.10 ENVIRONMENTAL
IEC 61000-4-3
IEC 60255-22-3
Ontario Hydro C-5047-77
THERMAL
Products go through an environmental test based upon an
Accepted Quality Level (AQL) sampling process.
2.2.13 APPROVALS
APPROVALS CE:
UL Listed for the USA and Canada LVD 73/23/EEC: IEC 1010-1
EMC 81/336/EEC: EN 50081-2, EN 50082-2
2.2.14 MAINTENANCE
MOUNTING CLEANING
Attach mounting brackets using 20 inch-pounds (±2 inch-pounds) Normally, cleaning is not required; but for situations where dust
of torque. has accumulated on the faceplate display, a dry cloth can be used.
The relay is available as a 19-inch rack horizontal mount unit or as a reduced size (¾) vertical mount unit, with a removable
faceplate. The modular design allows the relay to be easily upgraded or repaired by a qualified service person. The face-
plate is hinged to allow easy access to the removable modules, and is itself removable to allow mounting on doors with lim-
ited rear depth. There is also a removable dust cover that fits over the faceplate, which must be removed when attempting
to access the keypad or RS232 communications port.
The vertical and horizontal case dimensions are shown below, along with panel cutout details for panel mounting. When
planning the location of your panel cutout, ensure that provision is made for the faceplate to swing open without interfer-
ence to or from adjacent equipment.
The relay must be mounted such that the faceplate sits semi-flush with the panel or switchgear door, allowing the operator
access to the keypad and the RS232 communications port. The relay is secured to the panel with the use of four screws
supplied with the relay.
3
e UR SERIES
Module withdrawal and insertion may only be performed when control power has been removed from the
unit. Inserting an incorrect module type into a slot may result in personal injury, damage to the unit or con-
WARNING
nected equipment, or undesired operation!
Proper electrostatic discharge protection (i.e. a static strap) must be used when coming in contact with
modules while the relay is energized!
WARNING
The relay, being modular in design, allows for the withdrawal and insertion of modules. Modules must only be replaced with
like modules in their original factory configured slots.
The faceplate can be opened to the left, once the sliding latch on the right side has been pushed up, as shown below. This
allows for easy accessibility of the modules for withdrawal.
3
828705AK.CDR
The relay follows a convention with respect to terminal number assignments which are three characters long assigned in
order by module slot position, row number, and column letter. Two-slot wide modules take their slot designation from the
first slot position (nearest to CPU module) which is indicated by an arrow marker on the terminal block. See the following
figure for an example of rear terminal assignments.
3-6
TYPICAL CONFIGURATION
3.2WIRING
OPEN DELTA
3.2 WIRING
A A
B B
C C
WINDING 1
WINDING 2
(5 amp CTs)
A
B
C
WINDING 3
F 5c
F 6a
F 6c
F 7a
F 7c
F 5a
F 5a
F 5c
F 6a
F 6c
F 7a
F 7c
F 8a
F 8c
F 1a
F 1b
F 1c
F 2a
F 2b
F 2c
F 3a
F 3b
F 3c
F 4a
F 4b
F 4c
M 8c
M 1a
M 1b
M 1c
M 2a
M 2b
M 2c
M 3a
M 3b
M 3c
M 4a
M 4b
M 4c
M 5a
M 5b
M 5c
M 6a
M 6b
M 6c
M 7a
M 7b
M 7c
M 8a
M 8b
IB
IC
IB
IB
VA
VB
VC
VA
VB
VC
VX
IA
IG
IC
IC
IA
IG
IA
IG
VA
VB
VC
VA
VB
VC
VX
IA5
IA1
IB5
IB1
IC5
IC1
IG5
IG1
IA5
IA1
IB5
IB1
IC5
IC1
IG5
IG1
IA5
IA1
IB5
IB1
IC5
IC1
IG5
IG1
H 7c CONTACT IN H 7c H 1b
V
H 8a CONTACT IN H 8a H 1c
H 8c CONTACT IN H 8c I H 2a
H 7b COMMON H7b H2 H 2b
V
H 2c
H 8b SURGE
I H 3a
H3 H 3b
V TC2
H 3c UR COMPUTER
I H 4a
( DC ONLY )
1 1 8
H4 H 4b
V TXD 2 2 3 RXD
B 1b
GE Multilin H 4c
1
CRITICAL RXD 3 3 2 TXD
VOLTAGE SUPV.
B 1a I H 5a
FAILURE H5 H 5b 4 4 20
B 2b V
H 5c SGND 5 5 7 SGND
B 3a 48 VDC
B 3b OUTPUT
T60 TRANSFORMER MANAGEMENT RELAY I H 6a 6 6 6
H6 H 6b 7 7 4
B 5a MED V
DC H 6c
B5b HI CONTROL 8 8 5
B 6b LO POWER 9 9 22
AC or DC DIGITAL I/O 6D
B 6a
Shielded B 8a SURGE
POWER SUPPLY
9 PIN 25 PIN
twisted pairs B 8b FILTER
DIGITAL I/O 6C CONNECTOR CONNECTOR
D2a
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P7
P8
SURGE
RS485
9A
D3a
COM 1
D4a COM
COMMON U1b
COMMON U5b
COMMON U7b
COMMON U3b
PERSONAL
CONTACT IN U 1a
CONTACT IN U 2a
CONTACT IN U 3a
CONTACT IN U 4a
CONTACT IN U 5a
CONTACT IN U 6a
CONTACT IN U 7a
CONTACT IN U 8a
CONTACT IN U 1c
CONTACT IN U 2c
CONTACT IN U 3c
CONTACT IN U 4c
CONTACT IN U 5c
CONTACT IN U 6c
CONTACT IN U 7c
CONTACT IN U 8c
D3b
RS485 COMPUTER
D4b RS-232
COM 2
CPU
U 1a
U 1c
U 2a
U 2c
U 1b
U 3a
U 3c
U 4a
U 4c
U 3b
U 5a
U 5c
U 6a
U 6c
U 5b
U 7a
U 7c
U 8a
U 8c
U 7b
U 8b
P 1a
P 1b
P 1c
P 2a
P 2b
P 2c
P 3a
P 3b
P 3c
P 4a
P 4b
P 4c
P 5a
P 5b
P 5c
P 6a
P 6b
P 6c
P 7a
P 7b
P 7c
P 8a
P 8b
P 8c
GE Multilin
3 HARDWARE 3.2 WIRING
Filter networks and transient protection clamps are used in module hardware to prevent damage caused by high peak volt-
age transients, radio frequency interference (RFI) and electromagnetic interference (EMI). These protective components
can be damaged by application of the ANSI/IEEE C37.90 specified test voltage for a period longer than the specified one
minute. For testing of dielectric strength where the test interval may exceed one minute, always observe the following pre-
cautions:
1. The connection from ground to the Filter Ground (Terminal 8b) and Surge Ground (Terminal 8a) must be removed
before testing.
2. Some versions of the digital I/O module have a Surge Ground connection on Terminal 8b. On these module types, this
connection must be removed before testing.
CONTROL POWER SUPPLIED TO THE RELAY MUST BE CONNECTED TO THE MATCHING POWER SUPPLY
RANGE OF THE RELAY. IF THE VOLTAGE IS APPLIED TO THE WRONG TERMINALS, DAMAGE MAY
CAUTION
OCCUR!
The T60 relay, like almost all electronic relays, contains electrolytic capacitors. These capacitors are well
known to be subject to deterioration over time if voltage is not applied periodically. Deterioration can be
NOTE
avoided by powering the relays up once a year.
The power supply module can be ordered with either of two possible voltage ranges. Each range has a dedicated input
connection for proper operation. The ranges are as shown below (see the Technical Specifications section for details):
• LO range: 24 to 48 V (DC only) nominal
A CT/VT module may have voltage inputs on Channels 1 through 4 inclusive, or Channels 5 through 8 inclusive. Channels
1 and 5 are intended for connection to Phase A, and are labeled as such in the relay. Channels 2 and 6 are intended for
connection to Phase B, and are labeled as such in the relay. Channels 3 and 7 are intended for connection to Phase C and
are labeled as such in the relay. Channels 4 and 8 are intended for connection to a single phase source. If voltage, this
channel is labelled the auxiliary voltage (VX). If current, this channel is intended for connection to a CT between a system
neutral and ground, and is labelled the ground current (IG).
a) CT INPUTS
VERIFY THAT THE CONNECTION MADE TO THE RELAY NOMINAL CURRENT OF 1 A OR 5 A MATCHES
THE SECONDARY RATING OF THE CONNECTED CTs. UNMATCHED CTs MAY RESULT IN EQUIPMENT
CAUTION
DAMAGE OR INADEQUATE PROTECTION.
The CT/VT module may be ordered with a standard ground current input that is the same as the phase current inputs (Type
8A) or with a sensitive ground input (Type 8B) which is 10 times more sensitive (see the Technical Specifications section for
more details). Each AC current input has an isolating transformer and an automatic shorting mechanism that shorts the
input when the module is withdrawn from the chassis. There are no internal ground connections on the current inputs. Cur-
rent transformers with 1 to 50000 A primaries and 1 A or 5 A secondaries may be used.
CT connections for both ABC and ACB phase rotations are identical as shown in the Typical Wiring Diagram.
The exact placement of a Zero Sequence CT so that ground fault current will be detected is shown below. Twisted pair
cabling on the zero sequence CT is recommended.
b) VT INPUTS
The phase voltage channels are used for most metering and protection purposes. The auxiliary voltage channel is used as
input for the Synchrocheck and Volts/Hertz features.
~ 1b
~ 2b
~ 3b
~ 4b
~ 5a
~ 6a
~ 7a
~ 8a
~ 1a
~ 2a
~ 3a
~ 4a
~ 2c
~ 5c
~ 6c
~ 7c
~ 8c
~ 1c
~ 3c
~ 4c
VX
VB
VC
VA
VX
VB
VC
IG5
IG1
VA
IG
IA5
IA1
IA
IB
IB5
IB1
IC5
IC
IC1
~ 2b
~ 3b
~ 4b
~ 5b
~ 6b
~ 7b
~ 8b
~ 1a
~ 2a
~ 3a
~ 5a
~ 6a
~ 7a
~ 4a
~ 8a
~ 1c
~ 2c
~ 6c
~ 3c
~ 4c
~ 5c
~ 7c
~ 8c
IG5
IG1
IG5
IG1
IG
IG
IA5
IA1
IA5
IA1
IA
IA
IB
IB
IB5
IB1
IC5
IC
IC1
IB5
IB1
IC5
IC
IC1
CURRENT INPUTS
8C / 8D
827831A9-X3.CDR
NOTE
Every digital input/output module has 24 terminal connections. They are arranged as 3 terminals per row, with 8 rows in
total. A given row of three terminals may be used for the outputs of one relay. For example, for Form-C relay outputs, the
terminals connect to the normally open (NO), normally closed (NC), and common contacts of the relay. For a Form-A out-
put, there are options of using current or voltage detection for feature supervision, depending on the module ordered. The
terminal configuration for contact inputs is different for the two applications. When a digital input/output module is ordered
with contact inputs, they are arranged in groups of four and use two rows of three terminals. Ideally, each input would be
totally isolated from any other input. However, this would require that every input have two dedicated terminals and limit the
available number of contacts based on the available number of terminals. So, although each input is individually optically
isolated, each group of four inputs uses a single common as a reasonable compromise. This allows each group of four out-
puts to be supplied by wet contacts from different voltage sources (if required) or a mix of wet and dry contacts.
The tables and diagrams on the following pages illustrate the module types (6A, etc.) and contact arrangements that may
3 be ordered for the relay. Since an entire row is used for a single contact output, the name is assigned using the module slot
position and row number. However, since there are two contact inputs per row, these names are assigned by module slot
position, row number, and column position.
UR-SERIES FORM-A / SOLID STATE (SSR) OUTPUT CONTACTS:
Some Form-A/SSR outputs include circuits to monitor the DC voltage across the output contact when it is open, and the DC
current through the output contact when it is closed. Each of the monitors contains a level detector whose output is set to
logic “On = 1” when the current in the circuit is above the threshold setting. The voltage monitor is set to “On = 1” when the
current is above about 1 to 2.5 mA, and the current monitor is set to “On = 1” when the current exceeds about 80 to 100
mA. The voltage monitor is intended to check the health of the overall trip circuit, and the current monitor can be used to
seal-in the output contact until an external contact has interrupted current flow. The block diagrams of the circuits are below
above for the Form-A outputs with:
a) optional voltage monitor
b) optional current monitor
c) with no monitoring
V Load V
~#c + ~#c +
a) Voltage with optional Voltage monitoring only Both voltage and current monitoring
current monitoring
827821A5.CDR
~#a
~#b -
Load
~#c +
c) No monitoring
The operation of voltage and current monitors is reflected with the corresponding FlexLogic™ operands (Cont Op # Von, Cont
Op # Voff, Cont Op # Ion, and Cont Op # Ioff) which can be used in protection, control and alarm logic. The typical application of
the voltage monitor is breaker trip circuit integrity monitoring; a typical application of the current monitor is seal-in of the
control command. Refer to the Digital Elements section of Chapter 5 for an example of how Form-A/SSR contacts can be
applied for breaker trip circuit integrity monitoring.
Relay contacts must be considered unsafe to touch when the unit is energized! If the relay contacts need to
be used for low voltage accessible applications, it is the customer’s responsibility to ensure proper insula-
WARNING
tion levels!
USE OF FORM-A/SSR OUTPUTS IN HIGH IMPEDANCE CIRCUITS
NOTE For Form-A/SSR output contacts internally equipped with a voltage measuring cIrcuit across the contact, the circuit
has an impedance that can cause a problem when used in conjunction with external high input impedance monitor-
ing equipment such as modern relay test set trigger circuits. These monitoring circuits may continue to read the
Form-A contact as being closed after it has closed and subsequently opened, when measured as an impedance.
3
The solution to this problem is to use the voltage measuring trigger input of the relay test set, and connect the
Form-A contact through a voltage-dropping resistor to a DC voltage source. If the 48 V DC output of the power sup-
ply is used as a source, a 500 Ω, 10 W resistor is appropriate. In this configuration, the voltage across either the
Form-A contact or the resistor can be used to monitor the state of the output.
Wherever a tilde “~” symbol appears, substitute with the Slot Position of the module; wherever a number
sign "#" appears, substitute the contact number
NOTE
When current monitoring is used to seal-in the Form-A/SSR contact outputs, the FlexLogic™ operand driv-
ing the contact output should be given a reset delay of 10 ms to prevent damage of the output contact (in
NOTE
situations when the element initiating the contact output is bouncing, at values in the region of the pickup
value).
~6E I/O MODULE ~6F I/O MODULE ~6G I/O MODULE ~6H I/O MODULE
TERMINAL OUTPUT OR TERMINAL OUTPUT TERMINAL OUTPUT OR TERMINAL OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT INPUT ASSIGNMENT ASSIGNMENT INPUT ASSIGNMENT INPUT
~1 Form-C ~1 Fast Form-C ~1 Form-A ~1 Form-A
~2 Form-C ~2 Fast Form-C ~2 Form-A ~2 Form-A
~3 Form-C ~3 Fast Form-C ~3 Form-A ~3 Form-A
~4 Form-C ~4 Fast Form-C ~4 Form-A ~4 Form-A
~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs ~5 Fast Form-C ~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs ~5 Form-A
~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs ~6 Fast Form-C ~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs ~6 Form-A
~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7 Fast Form-C ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8 Fast Form-C ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs
~6K I/O MODULE ~6L I/O MODULE ~6M I/O MODULE ~6N I/O MODULE
TERMINAL OUTPUT TERMINAL OUTPUT OR TERMINAL OUTPUT OR TERMINAL OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT ASSIGNMENT INPUT ASSIGNMENT INPUT ASSIGNMENT INPUT
~1 Form-C ~1 Form-A ~1 Form-A ~1 Form-A
~2 Form-C ~2 Form-A ~2 Form-A ~2 Form-A
~3 Form-C ~3 Form-C ~3 Form-C ~3 Form-A
~4 Form-C ~4 Form-C ~4 Form-C ~4 Form-A
~5 Fast Form-C ~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs ~5 Form-C ~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs
~6 Fast Form-C ~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs ~6 Form-C ~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs
~7 Fast Form-C ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs
~8 Fast Form-C ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs
3
~6P I/O MODULE ~6R I/O MODULE ~6S I/O MODULE ~6T I/O MODULE
TERMINAL OUTPUT OR TERMINAL OUTPUT OR TERMINAL OUTPUT OR TERMINAL OUTPUT OR
ASSIGNMENT INPUT ASSIGNMENT INPUT ASSIGNMENT INPUT ASSIGNMENT INPUT
~1 Form-A ~1 Form-A ~1 Form-A ~1 Form-A
~2 Form-A ~2 Form-A ~2 Form-A ~2 Form-A
~3 Form-A ~3 Form-C ~3 Form-C ~3 Form-A
~4 Form-A ~4 Form-C ~4 Form-C ~4 Form-A
~5 Form-A ~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs ~5 Form-C ~5a, ~5c 2 Inputs
~6 Form-A ~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs ~6 Form-C ~6a, ~6c 2 Inputs
~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs
~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs
~6U I/O MODULE ~67 I/O MODULE ~4A I/O MODULE ~4B I/O MODULE
TERMINAL OUTPUT OR TERMINAL OUTPUT TERMINAL OUTPUT TERMINAL OUTPUT
ASSIGNMENT INPUT ASSIGNMENT ASSIGNMENT ASSIGNMENT
~1 Form-A ~1 Form-A ~1 Not Used ~1 Not Used
~2 Form-A ~2 Form-A ~2 Solid-State ~2 Solid-State
~3 Form-A ~3 Form-A ~3 Not Used ~3 Not Used
~4 Form-A ~4 Form-A ~4 Solid-State ~4 Solid-State
~5 Form-A ~5 Form-A ~5 Not Used ~5 Not Used
~6 Form-A ~6 Form-A ~6 Solid-State ~6 Solid-State
~7a, ~7c 2 Inputs ~7 Form-A ~7 Not Used ~7 Not Used
~8a, ~8c 2 Inputs ~8 Form-A ~8 Solid-State ~8 Solid-State
827719CY-X1.dwg
A dry contact has one side connected to Terminal B3b. This is the positive 48 V DC voltage rail supplied by the power sup-
ply module. The other side of the dry contact is connected to the required contact input terminal. Each contact input group
has its own common (negative) terminal which must be connected to the DC negative terminal (B3a) of the power supply
module. When a dry contact closes, a current of 1 to 3 mA will flow through the associated circuit.
A wet contact has one side connected to the positive terminal of an external DC power supply. The other side of this contact
is connected to the required contact input terminal. If a wet contact is used, then the negative side of the external source
must be connected to the relay common (negative) terminal of each contact group. The maximum external source voltage
for this arrangement is 300 V DC.
The voltage threshold at which each group of four contact inputs will detect a closed contact input is programmable as
17 V DC for 24 V sources, 33 V DC for 48 V sources, 84 V DC for 110 to 125 V sources, and 166 V DC for 250 V sources.
B 1b
B 1a CRITICAL
FAILURE
B 2b
POWER SUPPLY
B 3a - 48 VDC
B 3b + OUTPUT
B 5b HI+
CONTROL
B 6b LO+
POWER
B 6a -
B 8a SURGE
B 8b FILTER
827741A4.CDR
NOTE
Contact outputs may be ordered as Form-A or Form-C. The Form A contacts may be connected for external circuit supervi-
sion. These contacts are provided with voltage and current monitoring circuits used to detect the loss of DC voltage in the
circuit, and the presence of DC current flowing through the contacts when the Form-A contact closes. If enabled, the cur-
rent monitoring can be used as a seal-in signal to ensure that the Form-A contact does not attempt to break the energized
inductive coil circuit and weld the output contacts.
There is no provision in the relay to detect a DC ground fault on 48 V DC control power external output. We
recommend using an external DC supply.
NOTE
Transducer input/output modules can receive input signals from external dcmA output transducers (dcmA In) or resistance
temperature detectors (RTD). Hardware and software is provided to receive signals from these external transducers and
convert these signals into a digital format for use as required.
Every transducer input/output module has a total of 24 terminal connections. These connections are arranged as three ter-
minals per row with a total of eight rows. A given row may be used for either inputs or outputs, with terminals in column "a"
having positive polarity and terminals in column "c" having negative polarity. Since an entire row is used for a single input/
output channel, the name of the channel is assigned using the module slot position and row number.
Each module also requires that a connection from an external ground bus be made to Terminal 8b. The figure below illus-
trates the transducer module types (5C, 5E, and 5F) and channel arrangements that may be ordered for the relay.
Wherever a tilde “~” symbol appears, substitute with the Slot Position of the module.
3 NOTE
827831A9-X1.CDR
Figure 3–16: TRANSDUCER I/O MODULE WIRING
A 9-pin RS232C serial port is located on the relay’s faceplate for programming with a portable (personal) computer. All that
is required to use this interface is a personal computer running the EnerVista UR Setup software provided with the relay.
Cabling for the RS232 port is shown in the following figure for both 9 pin and 25 pin connectors.
Note that the baud rate for this port is fixed at 19200 bps.
a) OPTIONS
In addition to the RS232 port on the faceplate, the relay provides the user with two additional communication port(s)
depending on the CPU module installed.
D2a Tx Tx1
Rx 10BaseF NORMAL Rx110BaseF NORMAL
9C
9D
RS485
9A
D3a COM
1 Tx2
D4a COM
COM 1 10BaseT NORMAL Rx210BaseF ALTERNATE COM
1
D3b D3b 10BaseT NORMAL
RS485 RS485
D4b D4b
COM 2 COM 2 D3b
D5b COM D5b COM RS485
D4b
D5a D5a COM 2
IRIG-B IRIG-B D5b COM
CPU
CPU
D6a D6a
D5a
D7b SURGE D7b SURGE IRIG-B
CPU
D6a
D7b SURGE GROUND
827831A9-X6.CDR
b) RS485 PORTS
RS485 data transmission and reception are accomplished over a single twisted pair with transmit and receive data alternat-
ing over the same two wires. Through the use of these port(s), continuous monitoring and control from a remote computer,
SCADA system or PLC is possible.
To minimize errors from noise, the use of shielded twisted pair wire is recommended. Correct polarity must also be
observed. For instance, the relays must be connected with all RS485 “+” terminals connected together, and all RS485 “–”
terminals connected together. The COM terminal should be connected to the common wire inside the shield, when pro-
vided. To avoid loop currents, the shield should be grounded at one point only. Each relay should also be daisy chained to
the next one in the link. A maximum of 32 relays can be connected in this manner without exceeding driver capability. For
larger systems, additional serial channels must be added. It is also possible to use commercially available repeaters to
increase the number of relays on a single channel to more than 32. Star or stub connections should be avoided entirely.
Lightning strikes and ground surge currents can cause large momentary voltage differences between remote ends of the
3 communication link. For this reason, surge protection devices are internally provided at both communication ports. An iso-
lated power supply with an optocoupled data interface also acts to reduce noise coupling. To ensure maximum reliability, all
equipment should have similar transient protection devices installed.
Both ends of the RS485 circuit should also be terminated with an impedance as shown below.
TWISTED
RELAY
SHIELD
ZT (*) PAIR D2a RS485 +
DATA RS485 PORT DATA
D3a RS485 -
36V
COM
D7b SURGE
Required
CHASSIS GROUND
D4a COMP 485COM
SCADA/PLC/COMPUTER
GROUND SHIELD AT
SCADA/PLC/COMPUTER ONLY
OR AT UR RELAY ONLY
RELAY
(*) TERMINATING IMPEDANCE AT
D2a RS485 +
EACH END (TYPICALLY 120 Ohms and 1 nF)
D3a 485 -
D7b SURGE
UP TO 32 DEVICES,
MAXIMUM 4000 FEET RELAY
ZT (*)
D2a 485 +
D3a 485 -
D7b SURGE
827757A5.DWG
CAUTION
The fiber optic communication ports allow for fast and efficient communications between relays at 10 Mbps. Optical fiber
may be connected to the relay supporting a wavelength of 820 nanometers in multimode. Optical fiber is only available for
CPU types 9C and 9D. The 9D CPU has a 10BaseF transmitter and receiver for optical fiber communications and a second
pair of identical optical fiber transmitter and receiver for redundancy.
The optical fiber sizes supported include 50/125 µm, 62.5/125 µm and 100/140 µm. The fiber optic port is designed such
that the response times will not vary for any core that is 100 µm or less in diameter. For optical power budgeting, splices are
required every 1 km for the transmitter/receiver pair (the ST type connector contributes for a connector loss of 0.2 dB). 3
When splicing optical fibers, the diameter and numerical aperture of each fiber must be the same. In order to engage or dis-
engage the ST type connector, only a quarter turn of the coupling is required.
3.2.9 IRIG-B
IRIG-B RELAY
RG58/59 COAXIAL CABLE
TIME CODE
GENERATOR + D5a IRIG-B(+)
(DC SHIFT OR RECEIVER
AMPLITUDE MODULATED
SIGNAL CAN BE USED)
- D6a IRIG-B(-)
827756A4.CDR
TO OTHER DEVICES
The T60 direct inputs/outputs feature makes use of the Type 7 series of communications modules. These modules are also
used by the L90 Line Differential Relay for inter-relay communications. The Direct I/O feature uses the communications
channel(s) provided by these modules to exchange digital state information between relays. This feature is available on all
UR-series relay models except for the L90 Line Differential relay.
The communications channels are normally connected in a ring configuration as shown below. The transmitter of one mod-
ule is connected to the receiver of the next module. The transmitter of this second module is then connected to the receiver
of the next module in the ring. This is continued to form a communications ring. The figure below illustrates a ring of four
UR-series relays with the following connections: UR1-Tx to UR2-Rx, UR2-Tx to UR3-Rx, UR3-Tx to UR4-Rx, and UR4-Tx
to UR1-Rx. A maximum of sixteen (16) UR-series relays can be connected in a single ring
Tx
3 UR #1
Rx
Tx
UR #2
Rx
Tx
UR #3
Rx
Tx
UR #4
Rx
842006A1.CDR
Rx1
UR #1
Tx2
Rx2
Tx1
Rx1
UR #2
Tx2
Rx2
Tx1
Rx1
UR #3
Tx2
Rx2
Tx1
Rx1
UR #4
Tx2
Rx2
842007A1.CDR
The following diagram shows the interconnection for three UR-series relays using two independent communication chan-
nels. UR1 and UR3 have single Type 7 communication modules; UR2 has a dual-channel module. The two communication
channels can be of different types, depending on the Type 7 modules used. To allow the Direct I/O data to ‘cross-over’ from
Channel 1 to Channel 2 on UR2, the DIRECT I/O CHANNEL CROSSOVER setting should be “Enabled” on UR2. This forces UR2
to forward messages received on Rx1 out Tx2, and messages received on Rx2 out Tx1.
Tx
UR #1
Rx
Channel #1
Tx1
Rx1
UR #2
Tx2
3
Rx2
Channel #2
Tx
UR #3
Rx
842013A1.CDR
OBSERVING ANY FIBER TRANSMITTER OUTPUT MAY CAUSE INJURY TO THE EYE.
CAUTION
The following figure shows the configuration for the 7A, 7B, 7C, 7H, 7I, and 7J fiber-only modules.
Module: 7A / 7B / 7C 7H / 7I / 7J
Connection Location: Slot X Slot X
RX1 RX1
TX1 TX1
3
RX2
TX2
The following figure shows the configuration for the 72, 73, 7D, and 7K fiber-laser module.
TX1 TX1
RX1 RX1
TX2
RX2
a) DESCRIPTION
The following figure shows the 64K ITU G.703 co-directional interface configuration.
AWG 22 twisted shielded pair is recommended for external connections, with the shield grounded only at one end. Con-
necting the shield to Pin X1a or X6a grounds the shield since these pins are internally connected to ground. Thus, if
Pin X1a or X6a is used, do not ground at the other end. This interface module is protected by surge suppression devices.
X 1a Shld.
7R
X 1b Tx -
G.703
X 2a Rx -
CHANNEL 1
X 2b Tx +
X 3a
X 3b
Rx +
SURGE
3
X 6a Shld.
X 6b Tx -
L90 COMM.
X 7a Rx - G.703
CHANNEL 2
X 7b Tx +
X 8a Rx +
X 8b SURGE
7R
Tx - X 1b X 1b Tx -
G.703 G.703
CHANNEL 1
Rx - X 2a X 2a Rx -
CHANNEL 1
Tx + X 2b X 2b Tx +
Rx + X 3a X 3a Rx +
SURGE X 3b X 3b SURGE
Shld. X 6a X 6a Shld.
Tx - X 6b X 6b Tx -
L90 COMM.
L90 COMM.
G.703 G.703
CHANNEL 2
Rx - X 7a X 7a Rx -
CHANNEL 2
Tx + X 7b X 7b Tx +
Rx + X 8a X 8a Rx +
SURGE X 8b X 8b SURGE
the module is smoothly inserted into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis, engage the
clips simultaneously. When the clips have locked into position, the module will be fully inserted.
DMX G7R
DMX G7R
a) DESCRIPTION
The following figure shows the RS422 2-Terminal interface configuration at 64K baud. AWG 22 twisted shielded pair is rec-
ommended for external connections. This interface module is protected by surge suppression devices which optically iso-
lated.
SHIELD TERMINATION
The shield pins (6a and 7b) are internally connected to the ground pin (8a). Proper shield termination is as follows:
Site 1: Terminate shield to pins 6a and/or 7b; Site 2: Terminate shield to ‘COM’ pin 2b.
The clock terminating impedance should match the impedance of the line.
W 3b Tx -
W7W
W 3a Rx -
RS422
W 2a Tx +
CHANNEL 1
W 4b Rx +
W 6a Shld.
W 5b Tx -
W 5a Rx -
RS422
W 4a Tx +
CHANNEL 2
W 6b Rx +
W 7b Shld.
W 7a +
CLOCK
W 8b -
W 2b com
W 8a SURGE
3 RS422.CDR
p/o 827831A6.CDR
Tx - W 3b W 3b Tx -
7T
7T
Rx - W 3a W 3a Rx -
RS422 RS422
Tx + W 2a W 2a Tx +
CHANNEL 1 CHANNEL 1
Rx + W 4b W 4b Rx +
Shld. W 6a W 6a Shld.
+ W 7a W 7a +
CLOCK CLOCK
- W 8b W 8b -
com W 2b + W 2b com
SURGE W 8a W 8a SURGE
64 KHz
831728A3.CDR
Data Module 1
Pin No. Signal Name
SD(A) - Send Data
7W
Tx1(+) W 2a
Tx1(-) W 3b SD(B) - Send Data
RS422
Rx1(+) W 4b RD(A) - Received Data
CHANNEL 1
Rx1(-) W 3a RD(B) - Received Data
Shld. W 6a RS(A) - Request to Send (RTS)
+ W 7a RS(B) - Request to Send (RTS)
CLOCK
- W 8b RT(A) - Receive Timing
Tx2(+) W 4a RT(B) - Receive Timing
Tx2(-) W 5b CS(A) - Clear To Send
RS422
Rx2(+) W 6b CS(B) - Clear To Send
CHANNEL 2
Local Loopback
L90 COMM.
Rx2(-) W 5a
Shld. W 7b Remote Loopback
com W 2b Signal Ground
SURGE W 8a ST(A) - Send Timing
ST(B) - Send Timing
Data Module 2
3
Pin No. Signal Name
TT(A) - Terminal Timing
TT(B) - Terminal Timing
SD(A) - Sand Data
SD(B) - Sand Data
RD(A) - Received Data
RD(B) - Received Data
RS(A) - Request to Send (RTS)
RS(B) - Request to Send (RTS)
CS(A) - Clear To Send
CS(B) - Clear To Send
Local Loopback
Remote Loopback
Signal Ground
ST(A) - Send Timing
ST(B) - Send Timing
831022A2.CDR
c) TRANSIT TIMING
The RS422 Interface accepts one clock input for Transmit Timing. It is important that the rising edge of the 64 kHz Transmit
Timing clock of the Multiplexer Interface is sampling the data in the center of the Transmit Data window. Therefore, it is
important to confirm Clock and Data Transitions to ensure Proper System Operation. For example, the following figure
shows the positive edge of the Tx Clock in the center of the Tx Data bit.
Tx Clock
Tx Data
d) RECEIVE TIMING
The RS422 Interface utilizes NRZI-MARK Modulation Code and; therefore, does not rely on an Rx Clock to recapture data.
NRZI-MARK is an edge-type, invertible, self-clocking code.
To recover the Rx Clock from the data-stream, an integrated DPLL (Digital Phase Lock Loop) circuit is utilized. The DPLL is
driven by an internal clock, which is over-sampled 16X, and uses this clock along with the data-stream to generate a data
clock that can be used as the SCC (Serial Communication Controller) receive clock.
The following figure shows the combined RS422 plus Fiber interface configuration at 64K baud. The 7L, 7M, 7N, 7P, and 74
modules are used in 2-terminal with a redundant channel or 3-terminal configurations where Channel 1 is employed via the
RS422 interface (possibly with a multiplexer) and Channel 2 via direct fiber.
3 AWG 22 twisted shielded pair is recommended for external RS422 connections and the shield should be grounded only at
one end. For the direct fiber channel, power budget issues should be addressed properly.
When using a LASER Interface, attenuators may be necessary to ensure that you do not exceed Maximum
Optical Input Power to the receiver.
WARNING
W 3b Tx1 -
W7L, M, N, P and 74
W 3a Rx1 -
RS422
W 2a Tx1 +
CHANNEL 1
W 4b Rx1 +
W 6a Shld.
Tx2
FIBER
CHANNEL 2
Rx2
W 7a + CLOCK
W 8b - (CHANNEL1)
W 2b com
W 8a SURGE
L907LMNP.CDR
P/O 827831A6.CDR
The figure below shows the combined G.703 plus Fiber interface configuration at 64K baud. The 7E, 7F, 7G, 7Q, and 75
modules are used in configurations where Channel 1 is employed via the G.703 interface (possibly with a multiplexer) and
Channel 2 via direct fiber. AWG 22 twisted shielded pair is recommended for external G.703 connections connecting the
shield to Pin 1A at one end only. For the direct fiber channel, power budget issues should be addressed properly. See pre-
vious sections for more details on the G.703 and Fiber interfaces.
When using a LASER Interface, attenuators may be necessary to ensure that you do not exceed Maximum
Optical Input Power to the receiver.
WARNING
X 1a Shld.
W7E, F, G and Q
X 1b Tx -
G.703
X 2a Rx -
CHANNEL 1
X 2b Tx +
X 3a Rx +
X 3b SURGE
Tx2
FIBER
CHANNEL 2
Rx2
The UR-series IEEE C37.94 communication modules (76 and 77) are designed to interface with IEEE C37.94 compliant
digital multiplexers and/or an IEEE C37.94 compliant interface converter for use with direct input/output applications for
firmware revisions 3.30 and higher. The IEEE C37.94 standard defines a point-to-point optical link for synchronous data
between a multiplexer and a teleprotection device. This data is typically 64 kbps, but the standard provides for speeds up to
64n kbps, where n = 1, 2,…, 12. The UR-series C37.94 communication module is 64 kbps only with n fixed at 1. The frame
is a valid International Telecommunications Union (ITU-T) recommended G.704 pattern from the standpoint of framing and
data rate. The frame is 256 bits and is repeated at a frame rate of 8000 Hz, with a resultant bit rate of 2048 kbps.
The specifications for the module are as follows:
IEEE standard: C37.94 for 1 × 64 kbps optical fiber interface
Fiber optic cable type: 50 mm or 62.5 mm core diameter optical fiber
Fiber optic mode: multi-mode
Fiber optic cable length: up to 2 km
3
Fiber optic connector: type ST
Wavelength: 830 ±40 nm
Connection: as per all fiber optic connections, a Tx to Rx connection is required.
The UR-series C37.94 communication module can be connected directly to any compliant digital multiplexer that supports
the IEEE C37.94 standard as shown below.
IEEE C37.94
Fiber Interface
Digital
UR series Multiplexer
relay IEEE C37.94
compliant
up to 2 km
The UR-series C37.94 communication module can be connected to the electrical interface (G.703, RS422, or X.21) of a
non-compliant digital multiplexer via an optical-to-electrical interface converter that supports the IEEE C37.94 standard, as
shown below.
The UR-series C37.94 communication module has six (6) switches that are used to set the clock configuration. The func-
tions of these control switches is shown below.
te te
xt xt
ON ON
te te
xt
te xt
te xt
te xt
te xt
te xt
te xt
te xt
te xt
te xt
te
xt xt xt xt OFF xt xt xt xt xt xt OFF
1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6
2 ON OFF
3 OFF OFF
4 OFF OFF
5 OFF OFF
6 OFF OFF
For the Internal Timing Mode, the system clock is generated internally. Therefore, the timing switch selection should be
Internal Timing for Relay 1 and Loop Timed for Relay 2. There must be only one timing source configured.
For the Looped Timing Mode, the system clock is derived from the received line signal. Therefore, the timing selection
should be in Loop Timing Mode for connections to higher order systems.
The C37.94 communications module cover removal procedure is as follows:
1. Remove the C37.94 module (76 or 77):
The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module, must be pulled simultaneously in order
to release the module for removal. Before performing this action, control power must be removed from the relay.
The original location of the module should be recorded to help ensure that the same or replacement module is inserted
into the correct slot.
2. Remove the module cover screw.
3 3. Remove the top cover by sliding it towards the rear and then lift it upwards.
4. Set the Timing Selection Switches (Channel 1, Channel 2) to the desired timing modes (see description above).
5. Replace the top cover and the cover screw.
6. Re-insert the C37.94 module Take care to ensure that the correct module type is inserted into the correct slot posi-
tion. The ejector/inserter clips located at the top and at the bottom of each module must be in the disengaged position
as the module is smoothly inserted into the slot. Once the clips have cleared the raised edge of the chassis, engage
the clips simultaneously. When the clips have locked into position, the module will be fully inserted.
The EnerVista UR Setup software provides a graphical user interface (GUI) as one of two human interfaces to a UR device.
The alternate human interface is implemented via the device’s faceplate keypad and display (see Faceplate Interface sec-
tion in this chapter).
The EnerVista UR Setup software provides a single facility to configure, monitor, maintain, and trouble-shoot the operation
of relay functions, connected over local or wide area communication networks. It can be used while disconnected (i.e. off-
line) or connected (i.e. on-line) to a UR device. In off-line mode, settings files can be created for eventual downloading to
the device. In on-line mode, you can communicate with the device in real-time.
The EnerVista UR Setup software, provided with every T60 relay, can be run from any computer supporting Microsoft Win-
dows® 95, 98, NT, 2000, ME, and XP. This chapter provides a summary of the basic EnerVista UR Setup software interface
features. The EnerVista UR Setup Help File provides details for getting started and using the EnerVista UR Setup software
interface.
To start using the EnerVista UR Setup software, a site definition and device definition must first be created. See the EnerV-
ista UR Setup Help File or refer to the Connecting EnerVista UR Setup with the T60 section in Chapter 1 for details.
f) FILE SUPPORT
• Execution: Any EnerVista UR Setup file which is double clicked or opened will launch the application, or provide focus
to the already opened application. If the file was a settings file (has a URS extension) which had been removed from
the Settings List tree menu, it will be added back to the Settings List tree menu.
• Drag and Drop: The Site List and Settings List control bar windows are each mutually a drag source and a drop target
for device-order-code-compatible files or individual menu items. Also, the Settings List control bar window and any
4 Windows Explorer directory folder are each mutually a file drag source and drop target.
New files which are dropped into the Settings List window are added to the tree which is automatically sorted alphabet-
ically with respect to settings file names. Files or individual menu items which are dropped in the selected device menu
in the Site List window will automatically be sent to the on-line communicating device.
g) FIRMWARE UPGRADES
The firmware of a T60 device can be upgraded, locally or remotely, via the EnerVista UR Setup software. The correspond-
ing instructions are provided by the EnerVista UR Setup Help file under the topic “Upgrading Firmware”.
Modbus addresses assigned to firmware modules, features, settings, and corresponding data items (i.e. default
values, min/max values, data type, and item size) may change slightly from version to version of firmware. The
NOTE
addresses are rearranged when new features are added or existing features are enhanced or modified. The
“EEPROM DATA ERROR” message displayed after upgrading/downgrading the firmware is a resettable, self-test
message intended to inform users that the Modbus addresses have changed with the upgraded firmware. This
message does not signal any problems when appearing after firmware upgrades.
The EnerVista UR Setup software main window supports the following primary display components:
a. Title bar which shows the pathname of the active data view
b. Main window menu bar
c. Main window tool bar
d. Site List control bar window
e. Settings List control bar window
f. Device data view window(s), with common tool bar
g. Settings File data view window(s), with common tool bar
h. Workspace area with data view tabs
i. Status bar
The keypad/display/LED interface is one of two alternate human interfaces supported. The other alternate human interface
is implemented via the EnerVista UR Setup software. The faceplate interface is available in two configurations: horizontal
or vertical. The faceplate interface consists of several functional panels.
The faceplate is hinged to allow easy access to the removable modules. There is also a removable dust cover that fits over
the faceplate which must be removed in order to access the keypad panel. The following two figures show the horizontal
and vertical arrangement of faceplate panels.
MENU 7 8 9
USER 4 1 3 5 7 9 11
USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL
4
HELP MESSAGE 4 5 6
USER 5
ESCAPE 1 2 3
USER 6
2 4 6 8 10 12 ENTER VALUE 0 . +/-
USER 7 USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL
DISPLAY
MENU 7 8 9
HELP MESSAGE 4 5 6
ESCAPE 1 2 3 KEYPAD
ENTER VALUE 0 . +/-
LED PANEL 3
LED PANEL 2
USER 2
LED PANEL 1
827830A1.CDR
PHASE C
NEUTRAL/GROUND USER 3
a) LED PANEL 1
This panel provides several LED indicators, several keys, and a communications port. The RESET key is used to reset any
latched LED indicator or target message, once the condition has been cleared (these latched conditions can also be reset
via the SETTINGS INPUT/OUTPUTS RESETTING menu). The USER keys are not used in this unit. The RS232 port is
intended for connection to a portable PC.
Push in
and gently lift
up the cover.
2. Pop out the LED Module and/or the Blank Module with a screwdriver as shown below. Be careful not to damage the
plastic. 4
3. Place the left side of the customized module back to the front panel frame, then snap back the right side.
4. Put the clear Lexan Front Cover back into place.
4.2.3 DISPLAY
All messages are displayed on a 2 × 20 character vacuum fluorescent display to make them visible under poor lighting con-
ditions. An optional liquid crystal display (LCD) is also available. Messages are displayed in English and do not require the
aid of an instruction manual for deciphering. While the keypad and display are not actively being used, the display will
default to defined messages. Any high priority event driven message will automatically override the default message and
appear on the display.
4.2.4 KEYPAD
Display messages are organized into ‘pages’ under the following headings: Actual Values, Settings, Commands, and Tar-
gets. The key navigates through these pages. Each heading page is broken down further into logical subgroups.
The MESSAGE keys navigate through the subgroups. The VALUE keys scroll increment or decrement
numerical setting values when in programming mode. These keys also scroll through alphanumeric values in the text edit
mode. Alternatively, values may also be entered with the numeric keypad.
The key initiates and advance to the next character in text edit mode or enters a decimal point. The key may be
pressed at any time for context sensitive help messages. The key stores altered setting values.
4
MENU 7 8 9
HELP MESSAGE 4 5 6
ESCAPE 1 2 3
4.2.5 MENUS
a) NAVIGATION
Press the key to select the desired header display page (top-level menu). The header title appears momentarily fol-
lowed by a header display page menu item. Each press of the key advances through the main heading pages as
illustrated below.
USER DISPLAYS
(when in use)
User Display 1
b) HIERARCHY
The setting and actual value messages are arranged hierarchically. The header display pages are indicated by double
scroll bar characters ( ), while sub-header pages are indicated by single scroll bar characters ( ). The header display
pages represent the highest level of the hierarchy and the sub-header display pages fall below this level. The MESSAGE
and keys move within a group of headers, sub-headers, setting values, or actual values. Continually pressing the
MESSAGE key from a header display displays specific information for the header category. Conversely, continually
pressing the MESSAGE key from a setting value or actual value display returns to the header display.
SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP
SETTINGS Press the key until the header for the first page of Settings appears. This page
PRODUCT SETUP contains settings to configure the relay.
SETTINGS Press the MESSAGE key to move to the next Settings page. This page contains
SYSTEM SETUP settings for System Setup. Repeatedly press the MESSAGE keys to display
the other setting headers and then back to the first Settings page header.
PASSWORD From the Settings page one header (Product Setup), press the MESSAGE key
SECURITY once to display the first sub-header (Password Security).
ACCESS LEVEL: Press the MESSAGE key once more and this will display the first setting for Pass-
Restricted word Security. Pressing the MESSAGE key repeatedly will display the remaining
setting messages for this sub-header.
PASSWORD Press the MESSAGE key once to move back to the first sub-header message.
SECURITY
DISPLAY Pressing the MESSAGE key will display the second setting sub-header associ-
PROPERTIES ated with the Product Setup header.
FLASH MESSAGE Press the MESSAGE key once more and this will display the first setting for Dis-
TIME: 1.0 s play Properties.
DEFAULT MESSAGE To view the remaining settings associated with the Display Properties subheader,
INTENSITY: 25% repeatedly press the MESSAGE key. The last message appears as shown.
FLASH MESSAGE For example, select the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES FLASH
TIME: 1.0 s MESSAGE TIME setting.
MINIMUM: 0.5 Press the key to view the minimum and maximum values. Press the key
MAXIMUM: 10.0 again to view the next context sensitive help message.
Two methods of editing and storing a numerical setting value are available.
• 0 to 9 and (decimal point): The relay numeric keypad works the same as that of any electronic calculator. A num-
ber is entered one digit at a time. The leftmost digit is entered first and the rightmost digit is entered last. Pressing the
MESSAGE key or pressing the ESCAPE key, returns the original value to the display.
• VALUE : The VALUE key increments the displayed value by the step value, up to the maximum value
4 allowed. While at the maximum value, pressing the VALUE
upward from the minimum value. The VALUE
key again will allow the setting selection to continue
key decrements the displayed value by the step value, down to the
minimum value. While at the minimum value, pressing the VALUE key again will allow the setting selection to con-
tinue downward from the maximum value.
FLASH MESSAGE As an example, set the flash message time setting to 2.5 seconds. Press the appropriate
TIME: 2.5 s numeric keys in the sequence “2 . 5". The display message will change as the digits are
being entered.
NEW SETTING Until is pressed, editing changes are not registered by the relay. Therefore, press
HAS BEEN STORED to store the new value in memory. This flash message will momentarily appear as
confirmation of the storing process. Numerical values which contain decimal places will
be rounded-off if more decimal place digits are entered than specified by the step value.
ACCESS LEVEL: For example, the selections available for ACCESS LEVEL are "Restricted", "Command",
Restricted "Setting", and "Factory Service".
Enumeration type values are changed using the VALUE keys. The VALUE key displays the next selection while the
VALUE key displays the previous selection.
ACCESS LEVEL: If the ACCESS LEVEL needs to be "Setting", press the VALUE keys until the proper selec-
Setting tion is displayed. Press at any time for the context sensitive help messages.
NEW SETTING Changes are not registered by the relay until the key is pressed. Pressing
HAS BEEN STORED stores the new value in memory. This flash message momentarily appears as confirma-
tion of the storing process.
RELAY SETTINGS: When the relay is powered up, the Trouble LED will be on, the In Service LED off, and
Not Programmed this message displayed, indicating the relay is in the "Not Programmed" state and is 4
safeguarding (output relays blocked) against the installation of a relay whose settings
have not been entered. This message remains until the relay is explicitly put in the
"Programmed" state.
To change the RELAY SETTINGS: "Not Programmed" mode to "Programmed", proceed as follows:
1. Press the key until the SETTINGS header flashes momentarily and the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP message
appears on the display.
2. Press the MESSAGE key until the PASSWORD SECURITY message appears on the display.
3. Press the MESSAGE key until the INSTALLATION message appears on the display.
4. Press the MESSAGE key until the RELAY SETTINGS: Not Programmed message is displayed.
SETTINGS
SETTINGS PASSWORD
PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY
DISPLAY
PROPERTIES
↓
USER-DEFINABLE
DISPLAYS
INSTALLATION RELAY SETTINGS:
Not Programmed
5. After the RELAY SETTINGS: Not Programmed message appears on the display, press the VALUE keys change the
selection to "Programmed".
6. Press the key.
7. When the "NEW SETTING HAS BEEN STORED" message appears, the relay will be in "Programmed" state and the
In Service LED will turn on.
4. After the 'CHANGE...PASSWORD' message appears on the display, press the VALUE key or the VALUE key to
change the selection to Yes.
5. Press the key and the display will prompt you to 'ENTER NEW PASSWORD'.
6. Type in a numerical password (up to 10 characters) and press the key.
7. When the 'VERIFY NEW PASSWORD' is displayed, re-type in the same password and press .
CHANGE SETTING
PASSWORD: No
NEW PASSWORD
HAS BEEN STORED
8. When the 'NEW PASSWORD HAS BEEN STORED' message appears, your new Setting (or Command) Password will
be active.
SETTINGS PASSWORD
See page 5–7.
PRODUCT SETUP SECURITY
DISPLAY
See page 5–8.
PROPERTIES
CLEAR RELAY
See page 5–10.
RECORDS
COMMUNICATIONS
See page 5–11.
REAL TIME
See page 5–17.
CLOCK
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
See page 5–18.
FAULT REPORT
OSCILLOGRAPHY
See page 5–19.
DATA LOGGER
See page 5–21.
5
DEMAND
See page 5–21.
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
See page 5–23.
LEDS
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
See page 5–26.
SELF TESTS
CONTROL
See page 5–26.
PUSHBUTTONS
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
See page 5–28.
PUSHBUTTONS
FLEX STATE
See page 5–29.
PARAMETERS
USER-DEFINABLE
See page 5–30.
DISPLAYS
DIRECT I/O
See page 5–32.
INSTALLATION
See page 5–37.
SETTINGS AC INPUTS
See page 5–38.
SYSTEM SETUP
POWER SYSTEM
See page 5–40.
SIGNAL SOURCES
See page 5–41.
TRANSFORMER
See page 5–43.
FLEXCURVES
See page 5–52.
SETTINGS FLEXLOGIC
See page 5–71.
FLEXLOGIC EQUATION EDITOR
FLEXLOGIC
See page 5–71.
TIMERS
FLEXELEMENTS
See page 5–72.
NON-VOLATILE
See page 5–76.
LATCHES
↓
↓
5 SETTING GROUP 6
UNDERFREQUENCY
See page 5–122.
OVERFREQUENCY
See page 5–123.
DIGITAL ELEMENTS
See page 5–124.
DIGITAL COUNTERS
See page 5–127.
CONTACT OUTPUTS
See page 5–132.
VIRTUAL OUTPUTS
See page 5–134.
REMOTE DEVICES
See page 5–135.
REMOTE INPUTS
See page 5–136.
REMOTE OUTPUTS
See page 5–137.
DNA BIT PAIRS
REMOTE OUTPUTS
See page 5–138.
UserSt BIT PAIRS
RESETTING
See page 5–138.
DIRECT INPUTS
See page 5–138.
DIRECT OUTPUTS
See page 5–138.
In the design of UR relays, the term “element” is used to describe a feature that is based around a comparator. The com-
parator is provided with an input (or set of inputs) that is tested against a programmed setting (or group of settings) to deter-
mine if the input is within the defined range that will set the output to logic 1, also referred to as “setting the flag”. A single
comparator may make multiple tests and provide multiple outputs; for example, the time overcurrent comparator sets a
Pickup flag when the current input is above the setting and sets an Operate flag when the input current has been at a level
above the pickup setting for the time specified by the time-current curve settings. All comparators, except the Digital Ele-
ment which uses a logic state as the input, use analog parameter actual values as the input.
Elements are arranged into two classes, GROUPED and CONTROL. Each element classed as a GROUPED element is
provided with six alternate sets of settings, in setting groups numbered 1 through 6. The performance of a GROUPED ele-
ment is defined by the setting group that is active at a given time. The performance of a CONTROL element is independent
of the selected active setting group.
The main characteristics of an element are shown on the element logic diagram. This includes the input(s), settings, fixed
logic, and the output operands generated (abbreviations used on scheme logic diagrams are defined in Appendix F).
Some settings for current and voltage elements are specified in per-unit (pu) calculated quantities:
pu quantity = (actual quantity) / (base quantity)
• For current elements, the ‘base quantity’ is the nominal secondary or primary current of the CT. Where the current
source is the sum of two CTs with different ratios, the ‘base quantity’ will be the common secondary or primary current
to which the sum is scaled (i.e. normalized to the larger of the 2 rated CT inputs). For example, if CT1 = 300 / 5 A and
CT2 = 100 / 5 A, then in order to sum these, CT2 is scaled to the CT1 ratio. In this case, the ‘base quantity’ will be 5 A
secondary or 300 A primary.
• For voltage elements the ‘base quantity’ is the nominal primary voltage of the protected system which corresponds
(based on VT ratio and connection) to secondary VT voltage applied to the relay. For example, on a system with a
13.8 kV nominal primary voltage and with 14400:120 V Delta-connected VTs, the secondary nominal voltage (1 pu)
would be:
13800
---------------- × 120 = 115 V (EQ 5.1)
14400
For Wye-connected VTs, the secondary nominal voltage (1 pu) would be:
13800
---------------- × 120
---------- = 66.4 V (EQ 5.2)
14400 3
Many settings are common to most elements and are discussed below:
• FUNCTION setting: This setting programs the element to be operational when selected as “Enabled”. The factory
default is “Disabled”. Once programmed to “Enabled”, any element associated with the Function becomes active and
all options become available.
• NAME setting: This setting is used to uniquely identify the element.
• SOURCE setting: This setting is used to select the parameter or set of parameters to be monitored.
• PICKUP setting: For simple elements, this setting is used to program the level of the measured parameter above or
below which the pickup state is established. In more complex elements, a set of settings may be provided to define the
range of the measured parameters which will cause the element to pickup.
• PICKUP DELAY setting: This setting sets a time-delay-on-pickup, or on-delay, for the duration between the Pickup
and Operate output states.
5 • RESET DELAY setting: This setting is used to set a time-delay-on-dropout, or off-delay, for the duration between the
Operate output state and the return to logic 0 after the input transits outside the defined pickup range.
• BLOCK setting: The default output operand state of all comparators is a logic 0 or “flag not set”. The comparator
remains in this default state until a logic 1 is asserted at the RUN input, allowing the test to be performed. If the RUN
input changes to logic 0 at any time, the comparator returns to the default state. The RUN input is used to supervise
the comparator. The BLOCK input is used as one of the inputs to RUN control.
• TARGET setting: This setting is used to define the operation of an element target message. When set to Disabled, no
target message or illumination of a faceplate LED indicator is issued upon operation of the element. When set to Self-
Reset, the target message and LED indication follow the Operate state of the element, and self-resets once the oper-
ate element condition clears. When set to Latched, the target message and LED indication will remain visible after the
element output returns to logic 0 - until a RESET command is received by the relay.
• EVENTS setting: This setting is used to control whether the Pickup, Dropout or Operate states are recorded by the
event recorder. When set to Disabled, element pickup, dropout or operate are not recorded as events. When set to
Enabled, events are created for:
(Element) PKP (pickup)
(Element) DPO (dropout)
(Element) OP (operate)
The DPO event is created when the measure and decide comparator output transits from the pickup state (logic 1) to
the dropout state (logic 0). This could happen when the element is in the operate state if the reset delay time is not ‘0’.
a) BACKGROUND
The T60 may be used on systems with breaker-and-a-half or ring bus configurations. In these applications, each of the two
three-phase sets of individual phase currents (one associated with each breaker) can be used as an input to a breaker fail-
ure element. The sum of both breaker phase currents and 3I_0 residual currents may be required for the circuit relaying
and metering functions. For a three-winding transformer application, it may be required to calculate watts and vars for each
of three windings, using voltage from different sets of VTs. These requirements can be satisfied with a single UR, equipped
with sufficient CT and VT input channels, by selecting the parameter to measure. A mechanism is provided to specify the
AC parameter (or group of parameters) used as the input to protection/control comparators and some metering elements.
Selection of the parameter(s) to measure is partially performed by the design of a measuring element or protection/control
comparator by identifying the type of parameter (fundamental frequency phasor, harmonic phasor, symmetrical component,
total waveform RMS magnitude, phase-phase or phase-ground voltage, etc.) to measure. The user completes the process
by selecting the instrument transformer input channels to use and some of the parameters calculated from these channels.
The input parameters available include the summation of currents from multiple input channels. For the summed currents of
phase, 3I_0, and ground current, current from CTs with different ratios are adjusted to a single ratio before summation.
A mechanism called a “Source” configures the routing of CT and VT input channels to measurement sub-systems.
Sources, in the context of UR series relays, refer to the logical grouping of current and voltage signals such that one source
contains all the signals required to measure the load or fault in a particular power apparatus. A given source may contain all
or some of the following signals: three-phase currents, single-phase ground current, three-phase voltages and an auxiliary
voltage from a single VT for checking for synchronism.
To illustrate the concept of Sources, as applied to current inputs only, consider the breaker-and-a-half scheme below. In this
application, the current flows as shown by the arrows. Some current flows through the upper bus bar to some other location
or power equipment, and some current flows into transformer Winding 1. The current into Winding 1 is the phasor sum (or
difference) of the currents in CT1 and CT2 (whether the sum or difference is used depends on the relative polarity of the CT
connections). The same considerations apply to transformer Winding 2. The protection elements require access to the net
current for transformer protection, but some elements may need access to the individual currents from CT1 and CT2.
CT1 CT2
Through Current
WDG 1
UR Power
Platform
Transformer 5
WDG 2
The UR platform allows for a maximum of three sets of three-phase voltages and six sets of three-phase currents. The
result of these restrictions leads to the maximum number of CT/VT modules in a chassis to three. The maximum number of
Sources is six. A summary of CT/VT module configurations is shown below.
ITEM MAXIMUM NUMBER
CT/VT Module 3
CT Bank (3 phase channels, 1 ground channel) 6
Two levels of password security are provided: Command and Setting. Operations under password supervision are:
• COMMAND: changing the state of virtual inputs, clearing the event records, clearing the oscillography records,
changing the date and time, clearing energy records, clearing the data logger, user-programmable
pushbuttons
• SETTING: changing any setting, test mode operation
The Command and Setting passwords are defaulted to "Null" when the relay is shipped from the factory. When a password
is set to "Null", the password security feature is disabled.
Programming a password code is required to enable each access level. A password consists of 1 to 10 numerical charac- 5
ters. When a CHANGE ... PASSWORD setting is set to "Yes", the following message sequence is invoked:
1. ENTER NEW PASSWORD: ____________
2. VERIFY NEW PASSWORD: ____________
3. NEW PASSWORD HAS BEEN STORED
To gain write access to a "Restricted" setting, set ACCESS LEVEL to "Setting" and then change the setting, or attempt to
change the setting and follow the prompt to enter the programmed password. If the password is correctly entered, access
will be allowed. If no keys are pressed for longer than 30 minutes or control power is cycled, accessibility will automatically
revert to the "Restricted" level.
If an entered password is lost (or forgotten), consult the factory with the corresponding ENCRYPTED PASSWORD.
The T60 provides a means to raise an alarm upon failed password entry. Should password verification fail while accessing
a password-protected level of the relay (either settings or commands), the UNAUTHORIZED ACCESS FlexLogic™ oper-
and is asserted. The operand can be programmed to raise an alarm via contact outputs or communications. This feature
can be used to protect against both unauthorized and accidental access attempts.
The UNAUTHORISED ACCESS operand is reset with the COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS RESET UNAUTHORISED
ALARMScommand. Therefore, to apply this feature with security, the command level should be password-protected.
The operand does not generate events or targets. If these are required, the operand can be assigned to a digital element
programmed with event logs and/or targets enabled.
If the SETTING and COMMAND passwords are identical, this one password allows access to both commands
and settings.
NOTE
When EnerVista UR Setup is used to access a particular level, the user will continue to have access to that
level as long as there are open windows in EnerVista UR Setup. To re-establish the Password Security fea-
NOTE
ture, all URPC windows must be closed for at least 30 minutes.
Some relay messaging characteristics can be modified to suit different situations using the display properties settings.
• FLASH MESSAGE TIME: Flash messages are status, warning, error, or information messages displayed for several
seconds in response to certain key presses during setting programming. These messages override any normal mes-
5 sages. The duration of a flash message on the display can be changed to accommodate different reading rates.
• DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT: If the keypad is inactive for a period of time, the relay automatically reverts to a
default message. The inactivity time is modified via this setting to ensure messages remain on the screen long enough
during programming or reading of actual values.
• DEFAULT MESSAGE INTENSITY: To extend phosphor life in the vacuum fluorescent display, the brightness can be
attenuated during default message display. During keypad interrogation, the display always operates at full brightness.
• SCREEN SAVER FEATURE and SCREEN SAVER WAIT TIME: These settings are only visible if the T60 has a liquid
crystal display (LCD) and control its backlighting. When the SCREEN SAVER FEATURE is “Enabled”, the LCD backlighting
is turned off after the DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT followed by the SCREEN SAVER WAIT TIME, providing that no keys
have been pressed and no target messages are active. When a keypress occurs or a target becomes active, the LCD
backlighting is turned on.
• CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL: This setting modifies the current cut-off threshold. Very low currents (1 to 2% of the
rated value) are very susceptible to noise. Some customers prefer very low currents to display as zero, while others
prefer the current be displayed even when the value reflects noise rather than the actual signal. The T60 applies a cut-
off value to the magnitudes and angles of the measured currents. If the magnitude is below the cut-off level, it is substi-
tuted with zero. This applies to phase and ground current phasors as well as true RMS values and symmetrical compo-
nents. The cut-off operation applies to quantities used for metering, protection, and control, as well as those used by
communications protocols. Note that the cut-off level for the sensitive ground input is 10 times lower that the CURRENT
CUT-OFF LEVEL setting value. Raw current samples available via oscillography are not subject to cut-off.
• VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL: This setting modifies the voltage cut-off threshold. Very low secondary voltage measure-
ments (at the fractional volt level) can be affected by noise. Some customers prefer these low voltages to be displayed
as zero, while others prefer the voltage to be displayed even when the value reflects noise rather than the actual sig-
nal. The T60 applies a cut-off value to the magnitudes and angles of the measured voltages. If the magnitude is below
the cut-off level, it is substituted with zero. This operation applies to phase and auxiliary voltages, and symmetrical
components. The cut-off operation applies to quantities used for metering, protection, and control, as well as those
used by communications protocols. Raw samples of the voltages available via oscillography are not subject cut-off.
This setting relates to the actual measured voltage at the VT secondary inputs. It can be converted to per-unit values
(pu) by dividing by the PHASE VT SECONDARY setting value. For example, a PHASE VT SECONDARY setting of “66.4 V”
and a VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL setting of “1.0 V” gives a cut-off value of 1.0 V / 66.4 V = 0.015 pu.
The CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL and the VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL are used to determine the metered power cut-off levels. The
power cut-off level is calculated as shown below. For Delta connections:
We have:
CT primary = “100 A”, and
VT primary = PHASE VT SECONDARY x PHASE VT RATIO = 66.4 V x 208 = 13811.2 V
The power cut-off is therefore:
5
power cut-off = (CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL × VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL × CT primary × VT primary)/VT secondary
= ( 3 × 0.02 pu × 1.0 V × 100 A × 13811.2 V) / 66.4 V
= 720.5 watts
Any calculated power value below this cut-off will not be displayed. As well, the three-phase energy data will not accumu-
late if the total power from all three phases does not exceed the power cut-off.
Lower the VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL and CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL with care as the relay accepts lower signals
as valid measurements. Unless dictated otherwise by a specific application, the default settings of “0.02
NOTE
pu” for CURRENT CUT-OFF LEVEL and “1.0 V” for VOLTAGE CUT-OFF LEVEL are recommended.
Selected records can be cleared from user-programmable conditions with FlexLogic™ operands. Assigning user-program-
5 mable pushbuttons to clear specific records are typical applications for these commands. Since T60 responds to rising
edges of the configured FlexLogic™ operands, they must be asserted for at least 50 ms to take effect.
Clearing records with user-programmable operands is not protected by the command password. However, user-program-
mable pushbuttons are protected by the command password. Thus, if they are used to clear records, the user-programma-
ble pushbuttons can provide extra security if required.
For example, to assign User-Programmable Pushbutton 1 to clear demand records, the following settings should be
applied.
1. Assign the clear demand function to Pushbutton 1 by making the following change in the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP
CLEAR RELAY RECORDS menu:
5.2.4 COMMUNICATIONS
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS
NETWORK
MESSAGE See page 5–12.
MODBUS PROTOCOL
MESSAGE See page 5–12.
DNP PROTOCOL
MESSAGE See page 5–12.
UCA/MMS PROTOCOL
MESSAGE See page 5–15.
WEB SERVER
MESSAGE See page 5–15.
HTTP PROTOCOL
TFTP PROTOCOL
MESSAGE See page 5–15.
IEC 60870-5-104
MESSAGE See page 5–16.
PROTOCOL
MESSAGE
SNTP PROTOCOL
See page 5–17. 5
b) SERIAL PORTS
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS SERIAL PORTS
SERIAL PORTS RS485 COM1 BAUD Range: 300, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 14400, 19200,
RATE: 19200 28800, 33600, 38400, 57600, 115200. Only
active if CPU 9A is ordered.
RS485 COM1 PARITY: Range: None, Odd, Even
MESSAGE Only active if CPU Type 9A is ordered
None
RS485 COM1 RESPONSE Range: 0 to 1000 ms in steps of 10
MESSAGE Only active if CPU Type 9A is ordered
MIN TIME: 0 ms
RS485 COM2 BAUD Range: 300, 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 14400, 19200,
MESSAGE 28800, 33600, 38400, 57600, 115200
RATE: 19200
RS485 COM2 PARITY: Range: None, Odd, Even
MESSAGE
None
RS485 COM2 RESPONSE Range: 0 to 1000 ms in steps of 10
MESSAGE
MIN TIME: 0 ms
The T60 is equipped with up to 3 independent serial communication ports. The faceplate RS232 port is intended for local
use and is fixed at 19200 baud and no parity. The rear COM1 port type will depend on the CPU ordered: it may be either an
Ethernet or an RS485 port. The rear COM2 port is RS485. The RS485 ports have settings for baud rate and parity. It is
important that these parameters agree with the settings used on the computer or other equipment that is connected to
these ports. Any of these ports may be connected to a personal computer running EnerVista UR Setup. This software is
used for downloading or uploading setting files, viewing measured parameters, and upgrading the relay firmware to the lat-
est version. A maximum of 32 relays can be daisy-chained and connected to a DCS, PLC or PC using the RS485 ports.
For each RS485 port, the minimum time before the port will transmit after receiving data from a host can be
set. This feature allows operation with hosts which hold the RS485 transmitter active for some time after
NOTE
each transmission.
c) NETWORK
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK
These messages appear only if the T60 is ordered with an Ethernet card.
The IP addresses are used with DNP/Network, Modbus/TCP, MMS/UCA2, IEC 60870-5-104, TFTP, and HTTP protocols.
The NSAP address is used with the MMS/UCA2 protocol over the OSI (CLNP/TP4) stack only. Each network protocol has
a setting for the TCP/UDP PORT NUMBER. These settings are used only in advanced network configurations and should nor-
mally be left at their default values, but may be changed if required (for example, to allow access to multiple URs behind a
router). By setting a different TCP/UDP PORT NUMBER for a given protocol on each UR, the router can map the URs to the
same external IP address. The client software (URPC, for example) must be configured to use the correct port number if
these settings are used.
5 When the NSAP address, any TCP/UDP Port Number, or any User Map setting (when used with DNP) is changed,
it will not become active until power to the relay has been cycled (OFF/ON).
NOTE
Do not set more than one protocol to use the same TCP/UDP PORT NUMBER, as this will result in unreliable
operation of those protocols.
WARNING
d) MODBUS PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS MODBUS PROTOCOL
The serial communication ports utilize the Modbus protocol, unless configured for DNP operation (see the DNP Protocol
description below). This allows the EnerVista UR Setup software to be used. The UR operates as a Modbus slave device
only. When using Modbus protocol on the RS232 port, the T60 will respond regardless of the MODBUS SLAVE ADDRESS pro-
grammed. For the RS485 ports each T60 must have a unique address from 1 to 254. Address 0 is the broadcast address
which all Modbus slave devices listen to. Addresses do not have to be sequential, but no two devices can have the same
address or conflicts resulting in errors will occur. Generally, each device added to the link should use the next higher
address starting at 1. Refer to Appendix B for more information on the Modbus protocol.
e) DNP PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS DNP PROTOCOL
DNP PROTOCOL DNP PORT: Range: NONE, COM1 - RS485, COM2 - RS485, FRONT
NONE PANEL - RS232, NETWORK
The T60 supports the Distributed Network Protocol (DNP) version 3.0. The T60 can be used as a DNP slave device con-
nected to a single DNP master (usually an RTU or a SCADA master station). Since the T60 maintains one set of DNP data
change buffers and connection information, only one DNP master should actively communicate with the T60 at one time.
The DNP PORT setting selects the communications port assigned to the DNP protocol; only a single port can be assigned.
Once DNP is assigned to a serial port, the Modbus protocol is disabled on that port. Note that COM1 can be used only in
non-ethernet UR relays. When this setting is set to “Network”, the DNP protocol can be used over either TCP/IP or UDP/IP.
Refer to Appendix E for more information on the DNP protocol. The DNP ADDRESS setting is the DNP slave address. This
number identifies the T60 on a DNP communications link. Each DNP slave should be assigned a unique address. The DNP
NETWORK CLIENT ADDRESS setting can force the T60 to respond to a maximum of five specific DNP masters.
The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE FUNCTION should be “Disabled” for RS485 applications since there is no collision avoidance
mechanism. The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE TIMEOUT sets the time the T60 waits for a DNP master to confirm an unsolicited
response. The DNP UNSOL RESPONSE MAX RETRIES setting determines the number of times the T60 retransmits an unsolic-
ited response without receiving confirmation from the master; a value of “255” allows infinite re-tries. The DNP UNSOL
RESPONSE DEST ADDRESS is the DNP address to which all unsolicited responses are sent. The IP address to which unsolic-
ited responses are sent is determined by the T60 from the current TCP connection or the most recent UDP message.
The USER MAP FOR DNP ANALOGS setting allows the large pre-defined Analog Inputs points list to be replaced by the much
smaller Modbus User Map. This can be useful for users wishing to read only selected Analog Input points from the T60.
See Appendix E for more information.
The NUMBER OF SOURCES IN ANALOG LIST setting allows the selection of the number of current/voltage source values that
are included in the Analog Inputs points list. This allows the list to be customized to contain data for only the sources that
are configured. This setting is relevant only when the User Map is not used.
The DNP SCALE FACTOR settings are numbers used to scale Analog Input point values. These settings group the T60 Ana-
log Input data into types: current, voltage, power, energy, and other. Each setting represents the scale factor for all Analog
Input points of that type. For example, if the DNP VOLTAGE SCALE FACTOR setting is set to a value of 1000, all DNP Analog
Input points that are voltages will be returned with values 1000 times smaller (e.g. a value of 72000 V on the T60 will be
returned as 72). These settings are useful when Analog Input values must be adjusted to fit within certain ranges in DNP
masters. Note that a scale factor of 0.1 is equivalent to a multiplier of 10 (i.e. the value will be 10 times larger).
The DNP DEFAULT DEADBAND settings determine when to trigger unsolicited responses containing Analog Input data. These
settings group the T60 Analog Input data into types: current, voltage, power, energy, and other. Each setting represents the
5 default deadband value for all Analog Input points of that type. For example, to trigger unsolicited responses from the T60
when any current values change by 15 A, the DNP CURRENT DEFAULT DEADBAND setting should be set to “15”. Note that
these settings are the deadband default values. DNP Object 34 points can be used to change deadband values, from the
default, for each individual DNP Analog Input point. Whenever power is removed and re-applied to the T60, the default
deadbands will be in effect.
The DNP TIME SYNC IIN PERIOD setting determines how often the Need Time Internal Indication (IIN) bit is set by the T60.
Changing this time allows the DNP master to send time synchronization commands more or less often, as required.
The DNP MESSAGE FRAGMENT SIZE setting determines the size, in bytes, at which message fragmentation occurs. Large
fragment sizes allow for more efficient throughput; smaller fragment sizes cause more application layer confirmations to be
necessary which can provide for more robust data transfer over noisy communication channels.
The DNP BINARY INPUTS USER MAP setting allows for the creation of a custom DNP Binary Inputs points list. The default DNP
Binary Inputs list on the T60 contains 928 points representing various binary states (contact inputs and outputs, virtual
inputs and outputs, protection element states, etc.). If not all of these points are required in the DNP master, a custom
Binary Inputs points list can be created by selecting up to 58 blocks of 16 points. Each block represents 16 Binary Input
points. Block 1 represents Binary Input points 0 to 15, block 2 represents Binary Input points 16 to 31, block 3 represents
Binary Input points 32 to 47, etc. The minimum number of Binary Input points that can be selected is 16 (1 block). If all of
the BIN INPUT BLOCK X settings are set to “Not Used”, the standard list of 928 points will be in effect. The T60 will form the
Binary Inputs points list from the BIN INPUT BLOCK X settings up to the first occurrence of a setting value of “Not Used”.
When using the User Maps for DNP data points (Analog Inputs and/or Binary Inputs) for relays with ether-
net installed, check the “DNP Points Lists” T60 web page to ensure the desired points lists are created.
NOTE
This web page can be viewed using a web browser by entering the T60 IP address to access the T60 “Main
Menu”, then by selecting the “Device Information Menu” > “DNP Points Lists” menu item.
f) UCA/MMS PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS UCA/MMS PROTOCOL
UCA/MMS PROTOCOL DEFAULT GOOSE UPDATE Range: 1 to 60 s in steps of 1. See UserSt Bit Pairs in the
TIME: 60 s Remote Outputs section of this Chapter.
The T60 supports the Manufacturing Message Specification (MMS) protocol as specified by the Utility Communication
Architecture (UCA). UCA/MMS is supported over two protocol stacks: TCP/IP over ethernet and TP4/CLNP (OSI) over eth-
ernet. The T60 operates as a UCA/MMS server. The Remote Inputs/Outputs section in this chapter describe the peer-to-
peer GOOSE message scheme.
The UCA LOGICAL DEVICE setting represents the MMS domain name (UCA logical device) where all UCA objects are
located. The GOOSE FUNCTION setting allows for the blocking of GOOSE messages from the T60. This can be used during
testing or to prevent the relay from sending GOOSE messages during normal operation. The GLOBE.ST.LocRemDS setting
selects a FlexLogic™ operand to provide the state of the UCA GLOBE.ST.LocRemDS data item. Refer to Appendix C:
UCA/MMS Communications for additional details on the T60 UCA/MMS support.
5
g) WEB SERVER HTTP PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS WEB SERVER HTTP PROTOCOL
The T60 contains an embedded web server and is capable of transferring web pages to a web browser such as Microsoft
Internet Explorer or Netscape Navigator. This feature is available only if the T60 has the ethernet option installed. The web
pages are organized as a series of menus that can be accessed starting at the T60 “Main Menu”. Web pages are available
showing DNP and IEC 60870-5-104 points lists, Modbus registers, Event Records, Fault Reports, etc. The web pages can
be accessed by connecting the UR and a computer to an ethernet network. The Main Menu will be displayed in the web
browser on the computer simply by entering the IP address of the T60 into the “Address” box on the web browser.
h) TFTP PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS TFTP PROTOCOL
The Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) can be used to transfer files from the UR over a network. The T60 operates as a
TFTP server. TFTP client software is available from various sources, including Microsoft Windows NT. The dir.txt file
obtained from the T60 contains a list and description of all available files (event records, oscillography, etc.).
The T60 supports the IEC 60870-5-104 protocol. The T60 can be used as an IEC 60870-5-104 slave device connected to a
single master (usually either an RTU or a SCADA master station). Since the T60 maintains one set of IEC 60870-5-104
data change buffers, only one master should actively communicate with the T60 at one time. For situations where a second
master is active in a “hot standby” configuration, the UR supports a second IEC 60870-5-104 connection providing the
standby master sends only IEC 60870-5-104 Test Frame Activation messages for as long as the primary master is active.
The NUMBER OF SOURCES IN MMENC1 LIST setting allows the selection of the number of current/voltage source values that
are included in the M_ME_NC_1 (Measured value, short floating point) Analog points list. This allows the list to be custom-
ized to contain data for only the sources that are configured.
The IEC ------- DEFAULT THRESHOLD settings are the values used by the UR to determine when to trigger spontaneous
responses containing M_ME_NC_1 analog data. These settings group the UR analog data into types: current, voltage,
power, energy, and other. Each setting represents the default threshold value for all M_ME_NC_1 analog points of that
type. For example, in order to trigger spontaneous responses from the UR when any current values change by 15 A, the
IEC CURRENT DEFAULT THRESHOLD setting should be set to 15. Note that these settings are the default values of the dead-
bands. P_ME_NC_1 (Parameter of measured value, short floating point value) points can be used to change threshold val-
ues, from the default, for each individual M_ME_NC_1 analog point. Whenever power is removed and re-applied to the UR,
the default thresholds will be in effect.
The IEC 60870-5-104 and DNP protocols can not be used at the same time. When the IEC 60870-5-104 FUNC-
TION setting is set to “Enabled”, the DNP protocol will not be operational. When this setting is changed it
NOTE
will not become active until power to the relay has been cycled (Off/On).
j) SNTP PROTOCOL
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS SNTP PROTOCOL
The T60 supports the Simple Network Time Protocol specified in RFC-2030. With SNTP, the T60 can obtain clock time over
an Ethernet network. The T60 acts as an SNTP client to receive time values from an SNTP/NTP server, usually a dedicated
product using a GPS receiver to provide an accurate time. Both unicast and broadcast SNTP are supported.
If SNTP functionality is enabled at the same time as IRIG-B, the IRIG-B signal provides the time value to the T60 clock for
as long as a valid signal is present. If the IRIG-B signal is removed, the time obtained from the SNTP server is used. If
either SNTP or IRIG-B is enabled, the T60 clock value cannot be changed using the front panel keypad.
To use SNTP in unicast mode, SNTP SERVER IP ADDR must be set to the SNTP/NTP server IP address. Once this address is
set and SNTP FUNCTION is “Enabled”, the T60 attempts to obtain time values from the SNTP/NTP server. Since many time
values are obtained and averaged, it generally takes three to four minutes until the T60 clock is closely synchronized with
the SNTP/NTP server. It may take up to two minutes for the T60 to signal an SNTP self-test error if the server is offline.
To use SNTP in broadcast mode, set the SNTP SERVER IP ADDR setting to “0.0.0.0” and SNTP FUNCTION to “Enabled”. The
T60 then listens to SNTP messages sent to the “all ones” broadcast address for the subnet. The T60 waits up to eighteen
minutes (>1024 seconds) without receiving an SNTP broadcast message before signaling an SNTP self-test error.
The UR does not support the multicast or anycast SNTP functionality. 5
5.2.5 MODBUS USER MAP
The Modbus User Map provides read-only access for up to 256 registers. To obtain a memory map value, enter the desired
address in the ADDRESS line (this value must be converted from hex to decimal format). The corresponding value is dis-
played in the VALUE line. A value of “0” in subsequent register ADDRESS lines automatically returns values for the previous
ADDRESS lines incremented by “1”. An address value of “0” in the initial register means “none” and values of “0” will be dis-
played for all registers. Different ADDRESS values can be entered as required in any of the register positions.
These settings can also be used with the DNP protocol. See the DNP Analog Input Points section in Appen-
dix E for details.
NOTE
REAL TIME IRIG-B SIGNAL TYPE: Range: None, DC Shift, Amplitude Modulated
CLOCK None
The date and time for the relay clock can be synchronized to other relays using an IRIG-B signal. It has the same accuracy
as an electronic watch, approximately ±1 minute per month. An IRIG-B signal may be connected to the relay to synchronize
the clock to a known time base and to other relays. If an IRIG-B signal is used, only the current year needs to be entered.
See also the COMMANDS SET DATE AND TIME menu for manually setting the relay clock.
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE FAULT REPORT USER-PROGRAMMABLE FAULT REPORT 1(2)
FAULT REPORT 1 #32: Range: Off, any actual value analog parameter
MESSAGE
Off
When enabled, this function monitors the pre-fault trigger. The pre-fault data are stored in the memory for prospective cre-
ation of the fault report on the rising edge of the pre-fault trigger. The element waits for the fault trigger as long as the pre-
fault trigger is asserted, but not shorter than 1 second. When the fault trigger occurs, the fault data is stored and the com-
plete report is created. If the fault trigger does not occur within 1 second after the pre-fault trigger drops out, the element
5 resets and no record is created.
The user programmable record contains the following information: the user-programmed relay name, detailed firmware
revision (3.4x, for example) and relay model (T60), the date and time of trigger, the name of pre-fault trigger (specific Flex-
Logic™ operand), the name of fault trigger (specific FlexLogic™ operand), the active setting group at pre-fault trigger, the
active setting group at fault trigger, pre-fault values of all programmed analog channels (one cycle before pre-fault trigger),
and fault values of all programmed analog channels (at the fault trigger).
Each fault report is stored as a file to a maximum capacity of ten files. An eleventh trigger overwrites the oldest file. The
EnerVista UR Setup software is required to view all captured data.
The relay includes two user-programmable fault reports to enable capture of two types of trips (for example, trip from ther-
mal protection with the report configured to include temperatures, and short-circuit trip with the report configured to include
voltages and currents). Both reports feed the same report file queue.
The last record is available as individual data items via communications protocols.
• PRE-FAULT 1 TRIGGER: Specifies the FlexLogic™ operand to capture the pre-fault data. The rising edge of this
operand stores one cycle-old data for subsequent reporting. The element waits for the fault trigger to actually create a
record as long as the operand selected as PRE-FAULT TRIGGER is “On”. If the operand remains “Off” for 1 second, the
element resets and no record is created.
• FAULT 1 TRIGGER: Specifies the FlexLogic™ operand to capture the fault data. The rising edge of this operand
stores the data as fault data and results in a new report. The trigger (not the pre-fault trigger) controls the date and time
of the report.
• FAULT REPORT 1 #1 to #32: These settings specify an actual value such as voltage or current magnitude, true RMS,
phase angle, frequency, temperature, etc., to be stored should the report be created. Up to 32 channels can be config-
ured. Two reports are configurable to cope with variety of trip conditions and items of interest.
5.2.8 OSCILLOGRAPHY
OSCILLOGRAPHY
↓
ANALOG CHANNEL 16: Range: Off, any FlexAnalog parameter
Off See Appendix A: FlexAnalog Parameters for complete list.
Oscillography records contain waveforms captured at the sampling rate as well as other relay data at the point of trigger.
Oscillography records are triggered by a programmable FlexLogic™ operand. Multiple oscillography records may be cap-
tured simultaneously.
The NUMBER OF RECORDS is selectable, but the number of cycles captured in a single record varies considerably based on
other factors such as sample rate and the number of operational CT/VT modules. There is a fixed amount of data storage
for oscillography; the more data captured, the less the number of cycles captured per record. See the ACTUAL VALUES
RECORDS OSCILLOGRAPHY menu to view the number of cycles captured per record. The following table provides exam-
ple configurations with corresponding cycles/record.
As mentioned above, the cycles/record values shown in the table below are dependent on a number of fac-
tors, including the number of modules and which relay features are enabled. The cyles/record values below
NOTE
are for illustration purposes only – the actual values displayed may differ significantly.
A new record may automatically overwrite an older record if TRIGGER MODE is set to “Automatic Overwrite”.
The TRIGGER POSITION is programmable as a percent of the total buffer size (e.g. 10%, 50%, 75%, etc.). A trigger position
of 25% consists of 25% pre- and 75% post-trigger data.
The TRIGGER SOURCE is always captured in oscillography and may be any FlexLogic™ parameter (element state, contact
input, virtual output, etc.). The relay sampling rate is 64 samples per cycle.
The AC INPUT WAVEFORMS setting determines the sampling rate at which AC input signals (i.e. current and voltage) are
stored. Reducing the sampling rate allows longer records to be stored. This setting has no effect on the internal sampling
rate of the relay which is always 64 samples per cycle, i.e. it has no effect on the fundamental calculations of the device.
5 An ANALOG CHANNEL setting selects the metering actual value recorded in an oscillography trace. The length of each oscil-
lography trace depends in part on the number of parameters selected here. Parameters set to ‘Off’ are ignored. The param-
eters available in a given relay are dependent on: (a) the type of relay, (b) the type and number of CT/VT hardware modules
installed, and (c) the type and number of Analog Input hardware modules installed. Upon startup, the relay will automati-
cally prepare the parameter list. A list of all possible analog metering actual value parameters is presented in Appendix A:
FlexAnalog Parameters. The parameter index number shown in any of the tables is used to expedite the selection of the
parameter on the relay display. It can be quite time-consuming to scan through the list of parameters via the relay keypad/
display - entering this number via the relay keypad will cause the corresponding parameter to be displayed.
All eight CT/VT module channels are stored in the oscillography file. The CT/VT module channels are named as follows:
<slot_letter><terminal_number>—<I or V><phase A, B, or C, or 4th input>
The fourth current input in a bank is called IG, and the fourth voltage input in a bank is called VX. For example, F2-IB desig-
nates the IB signal on Terminal 2 of the CT/VT module in slot F. If there are no CT/VT modules and Analog Input modules,
no analog traces will appear in the file; only the digital traces will appear.
The source harmonic indices appear as oscillography analog channels numbered from 0 to 23. These correspond
directly to the to the 2nd to 25th harmonics in the relay as follows:
NOTE
Analog channel 0 ↔ 2nd Harmonic
Analog channel 1 ↔ 3rd Harmonic
...
Analog channel 23 ↔ 25th Harmonic
When the NUMBER OF RECORDS setting is altered, all oscillography records will be CLEARED.
WARNING
DATA LOGGER DATA LOGGER RATE: Range: 1 sec; 1 min, 5 min, 10 min, 15 min, 20 min, 30
1 min min, 60 min
DATA LOGGER CHNL 1: Range: Off, any FlexAnalog parameter. See Appendix A:
MESSAGE FlexAnalog Parameters for complete list.
Off
DATA LOGGER CHNL 2: Range: Off, any FlexAnalog parameter. See Appendix A:
MESSAGE FlexAnalog Parameters for complete list.
Off
↓
DATA LOGGER CHNL 16: Range: Off, any FlexAnalog parameter. See Appendix A:
MESSAGE FlexAnalog Parameters for complete list.
Off
DATA LOGGER CONFIG: Range: Not applicable - shows computed data only
MESSAGE
0 CHNL x 0.0 DAYS
The data logger samples and records up to 16 analog parameters at a user-defined sampling rate. This recorded data may
be downloaded to the EnerVista UR Setup software and displayed with ‘parameters’ on the vertical axis and ‘time’ on the
horizontal axis. All data is stored in non-volatile memory, meaning that the information is retained when power to the relay is
lost.
For a fixed sampling rate, the data logger can be configured with a few channels over a long period or a larger number of
channels for a shorter period. The relay automatically partitions the available memory between the channels in use.
Changing any setting affecting Data Logger operation will clear any data that is currently in the log. 5
NOTE
• DATA LOGGER RATE: This setting selects the time interval at which the actual value data will be recorded.
• DATA LOGGER CHNL 1(16): This setting selects the metering actual value that is to be recorded in Channel 1(16) of
the data log. The parameters available in a given relay are dependent on: the type of relay, the type and number of CT/
VT hardware modules installed, and the type and number of Analog Input hardware modules installed. Upon startup,
the relay will automatically prepare the parameter list. A list of all possible analog metering actual value parameters is
shown in Appendix A: FlexAnalog Parameters. The parameter index number shown in any of the tables is used to
expedite the selection of the parameter on the relay display. It can be quite time-consuming to scan through the list of
parameters via the relay keypad/display – entering this number via the relay keypad will cause the corresponding
parameter to be displayed.
• DATA LOGGER CONFIG: This display presents the total amount of time the Data Logger can record the channels not
selected to “Off” without over-writing old data.
5.2.10 DEMAND
The relay measures current demand on each phase, and three-phase demand for real, reactive, and apparent power. Cur-
rent and Power methods can be chosen separately for the convenience of the user. Settings are provided to allow the user
to emulate some common electrical utility demand measuring techniques, for statistical or control purposes. If the CRNT
DEMAND METHOD is set to "Block Interval" and the DEMAND TRIGGER is set to “Off”, Method 2 is used (see below). If
DEMAND TRIGGER is assigned to any other FlexLogic™ operand, Method 2a is used (see below).
The relay can be set to calculate demand by any of three methods as described below:
CALCULATION METHOD 1: THERMAL EXPONENTIAL
This method emulates the action of an analog peak recording thermal demand meter. The relay measures the quantity
(RMS current, real power, reactive power, or apparent power) on each phase every second, and assumes the circuit quan-
tity remains at this value until updated by the next measurement. It calculates the 'thermal demand equivalent' based on the
following equation:
– kt
d(t) = D(1 – e ) (EQ 5.6)
where: d = demand value after applying input quantity for time t (in minutes)
D = input quantity (constant)
k = 2.3 / thermal 90% response time.
The 90% thermal response time characteristic of 15 minutes is illustrated below. A setpoint establishes the time to reach
90% of a steady-state value, just as the response time of an analog instrument. A steady state value applied for twice the
response time will indicate 99% of the value.
100
80
Demand (%)
60
5 40
20
0
0 3 6 9 12 15 18 21 24 27 30
Time (min)
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS
USER-PROGRAMMABLE
MESSAGE
LED48
b) LED TEST
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS LED TEST
MESSAGE
LED TEST CONTROL: Range: FlexLogic™ operand 5
Off
When enabled, the LED Test can be initiated from any digital input or user-programmable condition such as user-program-
mable pushbutton. The control operand is configured under the LED TEST CONTROL setting. The test covers all LEDs,
including the LEDs of the optional user-programmable pushbuttons.
The test consists of three stages.
Stage 1: All 62 LEDs on the relay are illuminated. This is a quick test to verify if any of the LEDs is “burned”. This stage
lasts as long as the control input is on, up to a maximum of 1 minute. After 1 minute, the test will end.
Stage 2: All the LEDs are turned off, and then one LED at a time turns on for 1 second, then back off. The test routine
starts at the top left panel, moving from the top to bottom of each LED column. This test checks for hardware failures
that lead to more than one LED being turned on from a single logic point. This stage can be interrupted at any time.
Stage 3: All the LEDs are turned on. One LED at a time turns off for 1 second, then back on. The test routine starts at
the top left panel moving from top to bottom of each column of the LEDs. This test checks for hardware failures that
lead to more than one LED being turned off from a single logic point. This stage can be interrupted at any time.
When testing is in progress, the LEDs are controlled by the test sequence, rather than the protection, control, and monitor-
ing features. However, the LED control mechanism accepts all the changes to LED states generated by the relay and
stores the actual LED states (On or Off) in memory. When the test completes, the LEDs reflect the actual state resulting
from relay response during testing. The Reset pushbutton will not clear any targets when the LED Test is in progress.
A dedicated FlexLogic™ operand, LED TEST IN PROGRESS, is set for the duration of the test. When the test sequence is ini-
tiated, the LED Test Initiated event is stored in the Event Recorder.
The entire test procedure is user-controlled. In particular, Stage 1 can last as long as necessary, and Stages 2 and 3 can be
interrupted. The test responds to the position and rising edges of the control input defined by the LED TEST CONTROL set-
ting. The control pulses must last at least 250 ms to take effect. The following diagram explains how the test is executed.
READY TO TEST
Reset the
LED TEST IN PROGRESS
rising edge of the
operand
control input
Set the
LED TEST IN PROGRESS
operand
control input is on
STAGE 1 time-out
(all LEDs on) (1 minute)
5 Wait 1 second
rising edge of the
control input
rising edge
STAGE 3
of the control
(one LED off at a time) input
842011A1.CDR
Configure the LED test to recognize User-Programmable Pushbutton 1 by making the following entries in the SETTINGS
PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE LEDS LED TEST menu:
APPLICATION EXAMPLE 2:
Assume one needs to check if any LEDs are “burned” as well as exercise one LED at a time to check for other failures. This
is to be performed via User-Programmable Pushbutton 1.
After applying the settings in Application Example 1, hold down the pushbutton as long as necessary to test all LEDs. Next,
release the pushbutton to automatically start Stage 2. Once Stage 2 has started, the pushbutton can be released. When
Stage 2 is completed, Stage 3 will automatically start. The test may be aborted at any time by pressing the pushbutton.
TRIP & ALARM LEDS TRIP LED INPUT: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
Off
ALARM LED INPUT: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
The Trip and Alarm LEDs are on LED Panel 1. Each indicator can be programmed to become illuminated when the
selected FlexLogic™ operand is in the Logic 1 state.
There are 48 amber LEDs across the relay faceplate LED panels. Each of these indicators can be programmed to illumi-
nate when the selected FlexLogic™ operand is in the Logic 1 state.
• LEDs 1 through 24 inclusive are on LED Panel 2; LEDs 25 through 48 inclusive are on LED Panel 3.
Refer to the LED Indicators section in Chapter 4 for the locations of these indexed LEDs. This menu selects the operands
to control these LEDs. Support for applying user-customized labels to these LEDs is provided. If the LED X TYPE setting is
“Self-Reset” (default setting), the LED illumination will track the state of the selected LED operand. If the LED X TYPE setting 5
is ‘Latched’, the LED, once lit, remains so until reset by the faceplate RESET button, from a remote device via a communi-
cations channel, or from any programmed operand, even if the LED operand state de-asserts.
Refer to the Control of Setting Groups example in the Control Elements section of this chapter for group activation.
All major self-test alarms are reported automatically with their corresponding FlexLogic™ operands, events, and targets.
5 Most of the Minor Alarms can be disabled if desired.
When in the “Disabled” mode, minor alarms will not assert a FlexLogic™ operand, write to the event recorder, display target
messages. Moreover, they will not trigger the ANY MINOR ALARM or ANY SELF-TEST messages. When in the “Enabled” mode,
minor alarms continue to function along with other major and minor alarms. Refer to the Relay Self-Tests section in Chapter
7 for additional information on major and minor self-test alarms.
The three standard pushbuttons located on the top left panel of the faceplate are user-programmable and can be used for
various applications such as performing an LED test, switching setting groups, and invoking and scrolling though user-pro-
grammable displays, etc. The location of the control pushbuttons in shown below.
USER 4
842733A2.CDR
{
1 FUNCTION:
Enabled=1
SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP/
BREAKERS/BREAKER 1/
BREAKER 1 PUSHBUTTON
CONTROL:
When applicable
AND RUN
Enabled=1
OFF TIMER
SYSTEM SETUP/ FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
BREAKERS/BREAKER 2/ ON 0 CONTROL PUSHBTN 1 ON
BREAKER 2 PUSHBUTTON 100 msec
CONTROL:
842010A2.CDR
Enabled=1
The T60 has 12 optional user-programmable pushbuttons available, each configured via 12 identical menus. The pushbut-
tons provide an easy and error-free method of manually entering digital information (On, Off) into FlexLogic™ equations as
well as protection and control elements. Typical applications include breaker control, autorecloser blocking, ground protec-
5 tion blocking, and setting groups changes.
The user-configurable pushbuttons are shown below. They can be custom labeled with a factory-provided template, avail-
able online at http://www.GEindustrial.com/multilin.
1 3 5 7 9 11
USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL
2 4 6 8 10 12
USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL USER LABEL
• PUSHBTN 1 ID TEXT: This setting specifies the top 20-character line of the user-programmable message and is
intended to provide ID information of the pushbutton. Refer to the User-Definable Displays section for instructions on
how to enter alphanumeric characters from the keypad.
• PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT: This setting specifies the bottom 20-character line of the user-programmable message and is
displayed when the pushbutton is in the “on” position. Refer to the User-Definable Displays section for instructions on
entering alphanumeric characters from the keypad.
• PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT: This setting specifies the bottom 20-character line of the user-programmable message and is
displayed when the pushbutton is activated from the On to the Off position and the PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION is
“Latched”. This message is not displayed when the PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION is “Self-reset” as the pushbutton operand
status is implied to be “Off” upon its release. All user text messaging durations for the pushbuttons are configured with
the PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting.
• PUSHBTN 1 DROP-OUT TIME: This setting specifies a drop-out time delay for a pushbutton in the self-reset mode. A
typical applications for this setting is providing a select-before-operate functionality. The selecting pushbutton should
have the drop-out time set to a desired value. The operating pushbutton should be logically ANDed with the selecting
pushbutton in FlexLogic™. The selecting pushbutton LED remains on for the duration of the drop-out time, signaling
the time window for the intended operation.
For example, consider a relay with the following settings: PUSHBTN 1 ID TEXT: “AUTORECLOSER”, PUSHBTN 1 ON TEXT:
“DISABLED - CALL 2199", and PUSHBTN 1 OFF TEXT: “ENABLED”. When Pushbutton 1 changes its state to the “On” posi-
tion, the following AUTOCLOSER DISABLED – Call 2199 message is displayed: When Pushbutton 1 changes its state to the
“Off” position, the message will change to AUTORECLOSER ENABLED.
User-programmable pushbuttons require a type HP relay faceplate. If an HP-type faceplate was ordered sepa-
rately, the relay order code must be changed to indicate the HP faceplate option. This can be done via EnerVista
NOTE
UR Setup with the Maintenance > Enable Pushbutton command.
This feature provides a mechanism where any of 256 selected FlexLogic™ operand states can be used for efficient moni-
toring. The feature allows user-customized access to the FlexLogic™ operand states in the relay. The state bits are packed
so that 16 states may be read out in a single Modbus register. The state bits can be configured so that all of the states
which are of interest to the user are available in a minimum number of Modbus registers.
The state bits may be read out in the "Flex States" register array beginning at Modbus address 900 hex. 16 states are
packed into each register, with the lowest-numbered state in the lowest-order bit. There are 16 registers in total to accom-
modate the 256 state bits.
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-DEFINABLE DISPLAYS
This menu provides a mechanism for manually creating up to 16 user-defined information displays in a convenient viewing
sequence in the USER DISPLAYS menu (between the TARGETS and ACTUAL VALUES top-level menus). The sub-menus facili-
tate text entry and Modbus Register data pointer options for defining the User Display content.
Once programmed, the user-definable displays can be viewed in two ways.
• KEYPAD: Use the Menu key to select the USER DISPLAYS menu item to access the first user-definable display (note
that only the programmed screens are displayed). The screens can be scrolled using the Up and Down keys. The dis-
play disappears after the default message time-out period specified by the PRODUCT SETUP DISPLAY PROPERTIES
DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT setting.
• USER-PROGRAMMABLE CONTROL INPUT: The user-definable displays also respond to the INVOKE AND SCROLL
setting. Any FlexLogic™ operand (in particular, the user-programmable pushbutton operands), can be used to navi-
5 gate the programmed displays.
On the rising edge of the configured operand (such as when the pushbutton is pressed), the displays are invoked by
showing the last user-definable display shown during the previous activity. From this moment onward, the operand
acts exactly as the Down key and allows scrolling through the configured displays. The last display wraps up to the first
one. The INVOKE AND SCROLL input and the Down keypad key operate concurrently.
When the default timer expires (set by the DEFAULT MESSAGE TIMEOUT setting), the relay will start to cycle through the
user displays. The next activity of the INVOKE AND SCROLL input stops the cycling at the currently displayed user dis-
play, not at the first user-defined display. The INVOKE AND SCROLL pulses must last for at least 250 ms to take effect.
Any existing system display can be automatically copied into an available User Display by selecting the existing display and
pressing the key. The display will then prompt ADD TO USER DISPLAY LIST?. After selecting “Yes”, a message indi-
cates that the selected display has been added to the user display list. When this type of entry occurs, the sub-menus are
automatically configured with the proper content – this content may subsequently be edited.
This menu is used to enter user-defined text and/or user-selected Modbus-registered data fields into the particular User
Display. Each User Display consists of two 20-character lines (top and bottom). The Tilde (~) character is used to mark the
start of a data field - the length of the data field needs to be accounted for. Up to 5 separate data fields (ITEM 1(5)) can be
entered in a User Display - the nth Tilde (~) refers to the nth item.
A User Display may be entered from the faceplate keypad or the EnerVista UR Setup interface (preferred for convenience).
The following procedure shows how to enter text characters in the top and bottom lines from the faceplate keypad:
1. Select the line to be edited.
2. Press the key to enter text edit mode.
3. Use either Value key to scroll through the characters. A space is selected like a character.
4. Press the key to advance the cursor to the next position.
5. Repeat step 3 and continue entering characters until the desired text is displayed.
6. The key may be pressed at any time for context sensitive help information.
7. Press the key to store the new settings.
To enter a numerical value for any of the 5 items (the decimal form of the selected Modbus address) from the faceplate key-
pad, use the number keypad. Use the value of ‘0’ for any items not being used. Use the key at any selected system
display (Setting, Actual Value, or Command) which has a Modbus address, to view the hexadecimal form of the Modbus
address, then manually convert it to decimal form before entering it (EnerVista UR Setup usage conveniently facilitates this
conversion). 5
Use the key to go to the User Displays menu to view the user-defined content. The current user displays will show
in sequence, changing every 4 seconds. While viewing a User Display, press the key and then select the ‘Yes”
option to remove the display from the user display list. Use the key again to exit the User Displays menu.
An example User Display setup and result is shown below:
USER DISPLAY 1 DISP 1 TOP LINE: Shows user-defined text with first Tilde marker.
Current X ~ A
DISP 1 BOTTOM LINE: Shows user-defined text with second Tilde marker.
MESSAGE
Current Y ~ A
DISP 1 ITEM 1: Shows decimal form of user-selected Modbus Register
MESSAGE Address, corresponding to first Tilde marker.
6016
DISP 1 ITEM 2: Shows decimal form of user-selected Modbus
MESSAGE Register Address, corresponding to 2nd Tilde marker.
6357
DISP 1 ITEM 3: This item is not being used - there is no corresponding
MESSAGE Tilde marker in Top or Bottom lines.
0
DISP 1 ITEM 4: This item is not being used - there is no corresponding
MESSAGE Tilde marker in Top or Bottom lines.
0
DISP 1 ITEM 5: This item is not being used - there is no corresponding
MESSAGE
0 Tilde marker in Top or Bottom lines.
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP DIRECT I/O
UNRETURNED
MESSAGE See page 5–37.
MESSAGES ALARM CH1
5 MESSAGE
UNRETURNED
MESSAGES ALARM CH2
See page 5–37.
Direct I/Os are intended for exchange of status information (inputs and outputs) between UR relays connected directly via
Type-7 UR digital communications cards. The mechanism is very similar to UCA GOOSE, except that communications
takes place over a non-switchable isolated network and is optimized for speed. On Type 7 cards that support two channels,
Direct Output messages are sent from both channels simultaneously. This effectively sends Direct Output messages both
ways around a ring configuration. On Type 7 cards that support one channel, Direct Output messages are sent only in one
direction. Messages will be resent (forwarded) when it is determined that the message did not originate at the receiver.
Direct Output message timing is similar to GOOSE message timing. Integrity messages (with no state changes) are sent at
least every 1000 ms. Messages with state changes are sent within the main pass scanning the inputs and asserting the
outputs unless the communication channel bandwidth has been exceeded. Two Self-Tests are performed and signaled by
the following FlexLogic™ operands:
1. DIRECT RING BREAK (Direct I/O Ring Break). This FlexLogic™ operand indicates that Direct Output messages sent
from a UR are not being received back by the UR.
2. DIRECT DEVICE 1(16) OFF (Direct Device Offline). This FlexLogic™ operand indicates that Direct Output messages
from at least one Direct Device are not being received.
Direct I/O settings are similar to Remote I/O settings. The equivalent of the Remote Device name strings for Direct I/O, is
the Direct Output Device ID.
The DIRECT OUTPUT DEVICE ID identifies this UR in all Direct Output messages. All UR IEDs in a ring should have unique
numbers assigned. The IED ID is used to identify the sender of the Direct I/O message.
If the Direct I/O scheme is configured to operate in a ring (DIRECT I/O RING CONFIGURATION: "Yes"), all Direct Output mes-
sages should be received back. If not, the Direct I/O Ring Break Self Test is triggered. The self-test error is signaled by the
DIRECT RING BREAK FlexLogic™ operand.
Select the DIRECT I/O DATA RATE to match the data capabilities of the communications channel. Back-to-back connections of
the local relays configured with the 7A, 7B, 7C, 7D, 7H, 7I, 7J, 7K, 72 and 73 fiber optic communication cards may be set to
128 kbps. For local relays configured with all other communication cards (i.e. 7E, 7F, 7G, 7L, 7M, 7N, 7P, 7R, 7S, 7T, 7W,
74, 75, 76 and 77), the baud rate will be set to 64 kbps. All IEDs communicating over direct inputs/outputs must be set to
the same data rate. UR-series IEDs equipped with dual-channel communications cards apply the same data rate to both
channels. Delivery time for direct input/output messages is approximately 0.2 of a power system cycle at 128 kbps and 0.4
of a power system cycle at 64 kbps, per each ‘bridge’.
The DIRECT I/O CHANNEL CROSSOVER setting applies to T60s with dual-channel communication cards and allows crossing
over messages from Channel 1 to Channel 2. This places all UR IEDs into one Direct I/O network regardless of the physical
media of the two communication channels.
The following application examples illustrate the basic concepts for Direct I/O configuration. Please refer to the Inputs/Out-
puts section later in this chapter for information on configuring FlexLogic™ operands (flags, bits) to be exchanged.
EXAMPLE 1: EXTENDING THE I/O CAPABILITIES OF A UR RELAY
Consider an application that requires additional quantities of digital inputs and/or output contacts and/or lines of program-
mable logic that exceed the capabilities of a single UR chassis. The problem is solved by adding an extra UR IED, such as
the C30, to satisfy the additional I/Os and programmable logic requirements. The two IEDs are connected via single-chan-
nel digital communication cards as shown in the figure below.
TX1
UR IED 1
RX1
TX1
UR IED 2
RX1
842711A1.CDR
The message delivery time is about 0.2 of power cycle in both ways (at 128 kbps); i.e., from Device 1 to Device 2, and from
Device 2 to Device 1. Different communications cards can be selected by the user for this back-to-back connection (fiber,
G.703, or RS422).
EXAMPLE 2: INTERLOCKING BUSBAR PROTECTION
A simple interlocking busbar protection scheme could be accomplished by sending a blocking signal from downstream
devices, say 2, 3, and 4, to the upstream device that monitors a single incomer of the busbar, as shown below.
UR IED 1 BLOCK
842712A1.CDR
TX1 RX1
UR IED 1
RX2 TX2
TX2 RX2
UR IED 3
RX1 TX1
842716A1.CDR
UR IED 1 UR IED 2
UR IED 3
842713A1.CDR
RX1
UR IED 3
TX1
842714A1.CDR
TX1 RX1
UR IED 3
RX2 TX2
842715A1.CDR
The T60 checks integrity of the incoming Direct I/O messages using a 32-bit CRC. The CRC Alarm function is available for
monitoring the communication medium noise by tracking the rate of messages failing the CRC check. The monitoring func-
tion counts all incoming messages, including messages that failed the CRC check. A separate counter adds up messages
that failed the CRC check. When the failed CRC counter reaches the user-defined level specified by the CRC ALARM CH1
THRESHOLD setting within the user-defined message count CRC ALARM 1 CH1 COUNT, the DIR IO CH1 CRC ALARM Flex-
Logic™ operand is set.
When the total message counter reaches the user-defined maximum specified by the CRC ALARM CH1 MESSAGE COUNT set-
ting, both the counters reset and the monitoring process is restarted.
The operand shall be configured to drive an output contact, user-programmable LED, or selected communication-based
output. Latching and acknowledging conditions - if required - should be programmed accordingly.
The CRC Alarm function is available on a per-channel basis. The total number of Direct I/O messages that failed the CRC
5 check is available as the ACTUAL VALUES STATUS DIRECT INPUTS CRC FAIL COUNT CH1(2) actual value.
The T60 checks integrity of the Direct I/O communication ring by counting unreturned messages. In the ring configuration,
all messages originating at a given device should return within a pre-defined period of time. The Unreturned Messages
Alarm function is available for monitoring the integrity of the communication ring by tracking the rate of unreturned mes-
sages. This function counts all the outgoing messages and a separate counter adds the messages have failed to return.
When the unreturned messages counter reaches the user-definable level specified by the UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 THRESH-
OLD setting and within the user-defined message count UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 COUNT, the DIR IO CH1 UNRET ALM Flex-
Logic™ operand is set.
When the total message counter reaches the user-defined maximum specified by the UNRET MSGS ALARM CH1 MESSAGE
COUNT setting, both the counters reset and the monitoring process is restarted.
The operand shall be configured to drive an output contact, user-programmable LED, or selected communication-based
output. Latching and acknowledging conditions, if required, should be programmed accordingly.
The Unreturned Messages Alarm function is available on a per-channel basis and is active only in the ring configuration. 5
The total number of unreturned Direct I/O messages is available as the ACTUAL VALUES STATUS DIRECT INPUTS
UNRETURNED MSG COUNT CH1(2) actual value.
5.2.18 INSTALLATION
To safeguard against the installation of a relay without any entered settings, the unit will not allow signaling of any output
relay until RELAY SETTINGS is set to "Programmed". This setting is defaulted to "Not Programmed" when at the factory. The
UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED self-test error message is displayed until the relay is put into the "Programmed" state.
The RELAY NAME setting allows the user to uniquely identify a relay. This name will appear on generated reports. This name
is also used to identify specific devices which are engaged in automatically sending/receiving data over the Ethernet com-
munications channel using the UCA2/MMS protocol.
a) CURRENT BANKS
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS CURRENT BANK F1(M5)
Four banks of phase/ground CTs can be set, where the current banks are denoted in the following format (X represents the
module slot position letter):
Xa, where X = {F, M} and a = {1, 5}.
See the Introduction to AC Sources section at the beginning of this chapter for additional details.
These settings are critical for all features that have settings dependent on current measurements. When the relay is
ordered, the CT module must be specified to include a standard or sensitive ground input. As the phase CTs are connected
in Wye (star), the calculated phasor sum of the three phase currents (IA + IB + IC = Neutral Current = 3Io) is used as the
input for the neutral overcurrent elements. In addition, a zero-sequence (core balance) CT which senses current in all of the
circuit primary conductors, or a CT in a neutral grounding conductor may also be used. For this configuration, the ground
5 CT primary rating must be entered. To detect low level ground fault currents, the sensitive ground input may be used. In this
case, the sensitive ground CT primary rating must be entered. Refer to Chapter 3 for more details on CT connections.
Enter the rated CT primary current values. For both 1000:5 and 1000:1 CTs, the entry would be 1000. For correct opera-
tion, the CT secondary rating must match the setting (which must also correspond to the specific CT connections used).
The following example illustrates how multiple CT inputs (current banks) are summed as one source current. Given If the
following current banks:
F1: CT bank with 500:1 ratio; F5: CT bank with 1000: ratio; M1: CT bank with 800:1 ratio
The following rule applies:
SRC 1 = F1 + F5 + M1 (EQ 5.7)
1 pu is the highest primary current. In this case, 1000 is entered and the secondary current from the 500:1 ratio CT will be
adjusted to that created by a 1000:1 CT before summation. If a protection element is set up to act on SRC 1 currents, then
a pickup level of 1 pu will operate on 1000 A primary.
The same rule applies for current sums from CTs with different secondary taps (5 A and 1 A).
b) VOLTAGE BANKS
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE BANK F5(M5)
Two banks of phase/auxiliary VTs can be set, where voltage banks are denoted in the following format (X represents the
module slot position letter):
Xa, where X = {F, M} and a = {5}.
See the Introduction to AC Sources section at the beginning of this chapter for additional details.
With VTs installed, the relay can perform voltage measurements as well as power calculations. Enter the PHASE VT F5 CON-
NECTION made to the system as “Wye” or “Delta”. An open-delta source VT connection would be entered as “Delta”. See
the Typical Wiring Diagram in Chapter 3 for details.
5
The nominal PHASE VT F5 SECONDARY voltage setting is the voltage across the relay input terminals when nominal
voltage is applied to the VT primary.
NOTE
For example, on a system with a 13.8 kV nominal primary voltage and with a 14400:120 volt VT in a Delta connec-
tion, the secondary voltage would be 115, i.e. (13800 / 14400) × 120. For a Wye connection, the voltage value
entered must be the phase to neutral voltage which would be 115 / 3 = 66.4.
5.3.2 On a 14.4 kV system with a Delta connection and a VT primary to secondary turns ratio of 14400:120, the voltage
value entered would be 120, i.e. 14400 / 120.POWER SYSTEM
The power system NOMINAL FREQUENCY value is used as a default to set the digital sampling rate if the system frequency
cannot be measured from available signals. This may happen if the signals are not present or are heavily distorted. Before
reverting to the nominal frequency, the frequency tracking algorithm holds the last valid frequency measurement for a safe
period of time while waiting for the signals to reappear or for the distortions to decay.
The phase sequence of the power system is required to properly calculate sequence components and power parameters.
The PHASE ROTATION setting matches the power system phase sequence. Note that this setting informs the relay of the
actual system phase sequence, either ABC or ACB. CT and VT inputs on the relay, labeled as A, B, and C, must be con-
nected to system phases A, B, and C for correct operation.
The FREQUENCY AND PHASE REFERENCE setting determines which signal source is used (and hence which AC signal) for
5 phase angle reference. The AC signal used is prioritized based on the AC inputs that are configured for the signal source:
phase voltages takes precedence, followed by auxiliary voltage, then phase currents, and finally ground current.
For three phase selection, phase A is used for angle referencing ( V ANGLE REF = V A ), while Clarke transformation of the
phase signals is used for frequency metering and tracking ( V FREQUENCY = ( 2V A – V B – V C ) ⁄ 3 ) for better performance dur-
ing fault, open pole, and VT and CT fail conditions.
The phase reference and frequency tracking AC signals are selected based upon the Source configuration, regardless of
whether or not a particular signal is actually applied to the relay.
Phase angle of the reference signal will always display zero degrees and all other phase angles will be relative to this sig-
nal. If the pre-selected reference signal is not measurable at a given time, the phase angles are not referenced.
The phase angle referencing is done via a phase locked loop, which can synchronize independent UR-series relays if they
have the same AC signal reference. These results in very precise correlation of time tagging in the event recorder between
different UR relays provided the relays have an IRIG-B connection.
FREQUENCY TRACKING should only be set to "Disabled" in very unusual circumstances; consult the factory for spe-
cial variable-frequency applications.
NOTE
Systems with a phase sequence of ACB require special consideration described in the Phase Relation-
ships of Three-phase Transformers section.
NOTE
Four identical Source menus are available. The "SRC 1" text can be replaced by with a user-defined name appropriate for
the associated source.
“F” and “M” represent the module slot position. The number directly following these letters represents either the first bank of
four channels (1, 2, 3, 4) called “1” or the second bank of four channels (5, 6, 7, 8) called “5” in a particular CT/VT module.
Refer to the Introduction to AC Sources section at the beginning of this chapter for additional details on this concept.
It is possible to select the sum of up to five (5) CTs. The first channel displayed is the CT to which all others will be referred.
For example, the selection “F1+F5” indicates the sum of each phase from channels “F1” and “F5”, scaled to whichever CT
has the higher ratio. Selecting “None” hides the associated actual values.
The approach used to configure the AC Sources consists of several steps; first step is to specify the information about each
5
CT and VT input. For CT inputs, this is the nominal primary and secondary current. For VTs, this is the connection type,
ratio and nominal secondary voltage. Once the inputs have been specified, the configuration for each Source is entered,
including specifying which CTs will be summed together.
User Selection of AC Parameters for Comparator Elements:
CT/VT modules automatically calculate all current and voltage parameters from the available inputs. Users must select the
specific input parameters to be measured by every element in the relevant settings menu. The internal design of the ele-
ment specifies which type of parameter to use and provides a setting for Source selection. In elements where the parame-
ter may be either fundamental or RMS magnitude, such as phase time overcurrent, two settings are provided. One setting
specifies the Source, the second setting selects between fundamental phasor and RMS.
AC Input Actual Values:
The calculated parameters associated with the configured voltage and current inputs are displayed in the current and volt-
age sections of Actual Values. Only the phasor quantities associated with the actual AC physical input channels will be dis-
played here. All parameters contained within a configured Source are displayed in the Sources section of Actual Values.
Disturbance Detectors (Internal):
The 50DD element is a sensitive current disturbance detector that detects any disturbance on the protected system. 50DD
is intended for use in conjunction with measuring elements, blocking of current based elements (to prevent maloperation as
a result of the wrong settings), and starting oscillography data capture. A disturbance detector is provided for each Source.
The 50DD function responds to the changes in magnitude of the sequence currents. The disturbance detector scheme
logic is as follows:
SETTING
ACTUAL
PRODUCT SETUP/DISPLAY
SOURCE 1 PROPERTIES/CURRENT
CURRENT PHASOR CUT-OFF LEVEL
I_1 I_1 - I_1’ >2*CUT-OFF FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
I_2 I_2 - I_2’ >2*CUT-OFF OR SRC 1 50DD OP
I_0 I_0 - I_0’ >2*CUT-OFF
Where I’ is 2 cycles old
SETTING
ACTUAL
PRODUCT SETUP/DISPLAY
SOURCE 2 PROPERTIES/CURRENT
CURRENT PHASOR CUT-OFF LEVEL
I_1 I_1 - I_1’ >2*CUT-OFF FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
I_2 I_2 - I_2’ >2*CUT-OFF OR SRC 2 50DD OP
I_0 I_0 - I_0’ >2*CUT-OFF
Where I’ is 2 cycles old
SETTING
ACTUAL
PRODUCT SETUP/DISPLAY
SOURCE 6 PROPERTIES/CURRENT
CURRENT PHASOR CUT-OFF LEVEL
I_1 I_1 - I_1’ >2*CUT-OFF FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
I_2 I_2 - I_2’ >2*CUT-OFF OR SRC 6 50DD OP
I_0 I_0 - I_0’ >2*CUT-OFF
Where I’ is 2 cycles old 827092A3.CDR
5 accordingly.
Example Use of Sources:
An example of the use of Sources, with a relay with two CT/VT modules, is shown in the diagram below. A relay could have
the following hardware configuration:
INCREASING SLOT POSITION LETTER -->
CT/VT MODULE 1 CT/VT MODULE 2 CT/VT MODULE 3
CTs VTs not applicable
This configuration could be used on a two winding transformer, with one winding connected into a breaker-and-a-half sys-
tem. The following figure shows the arrangement of Sources used to provide the functions required in this application, and
the CT/VT inputs that are used to provide the data.
F1 DSP Bank
F5
Source 1 Source 2
Amps Amps
Source 3
51BF-1 51BF-2
U1 Volts Amps
A W Var 87T
A W Var 51P
Volts Amps
M1
M1 Source 4
UR Relay
M5
5.3.4 TRANSFORMER
TRANSFORMER
GENERAL
RATED WINDING TEMP Range: 55°C (oil), 65°C (oil), 80°C (dry), 115°C (dry), 150°C (dry)
MESSAGE
RISE: 65°C (oil)
WINDING 1
WINDING ~ ANGLE WRT Range: –359.9 to 0.0° in steps of 0.1, (‘~’ > 1)
MESSAGE (displayed when viewed Winding is not WINDING 1)
WINDING 1: 0.0°
WINDING 2
WINDING 4
The T60 Transformer Management Relay has been designed to provide primary protection for medium to high voltage
power transformers. It is able to perform this function on 2 to 4 winding transformers in a variety of system configurations.
Transformer differential protection uses the following calculated quantities (per phase): fundamental, 2nd harmonic, and 5th
harmonic differential current phasors, and restraint current phasors. This information is extracted from the current trans-
formers (CTs) connected to the relay by correcting the magnitude and phase relationships of the currents for each winding,
so as to obtain zero (or near zero) differential currents under normal operating conditions. Traditionally, these corrections
were accomplished by interposing CTs and tapped relay windings with some combination of CT connections.
The T60 simplifies these configuration issues. All CTs at the transformer are connected Wye (polarity markings pointing
away from the transformer). User-entered settings in the relay characterizing the transformer being protected and allow the
relay to automatically perform all necessary magnitude, phase angle, and zero sequence compensation.
This section describes the algorithms in the relay that perform this compensation and produce the required calculated
quantities for transformer differential protection, by means of the following example of a Δ-Y connected power transformer
with the following data:
A B C N
IA IB IC
Ia Ib Ic
5
l l l
Ia = Ia - Ic
l l Ib = Ib - Ia l l Ic = Ic - I b
l l
a b c
828716A1.CDR
IA
Ia
Ia l
–I b l
– Ic l
Ic
Ic l
Ib l
IC IB
–Ia l
Ib
Figure 5–16: PHASORS FOR ABC SEQUENCE
Note that the delta winding currents lag the wye winding currents by 30° (in agreement with the transformer nameplate).
Now assume that a source, with a sequence of ACB is connected to transformer terminals A, C, and B, respectively. The
currents present for a balanced load are shown in the Phasors for ACB Phase Sequence diagram.
IA
Ia
Ial
– Ic
l – Ib l
Ic
Ib l Ic
l
IB IC
– Ia l
Ib 828718A1.CDR
d) MAGNITUDE COMPENSATION
Transformer protection presents problems in the application of current transformers. CTs should be matched to the current
rating of each transformer winding, so that normal current through the power transformer is equal on the secondary side of
the CT on different windings. However, because only standard CT ratios are available, this matching may not be exact.
In our example, the transformer has a voltage ratio of 220 kV / 69 kV (i.e. about 3.188 to 1) and a compensating CT ratio is
500 A to 1500 A (i.e. 1 to 3). Historically, this would have resulted in a steady state current at the differential relay. Interpos-
ing CTs or tapped relay windings were used to minimize this error.
The T60 automatically corrects for CT mismatch errors. All currents are magnitude compensated to be in units of the CTs of
one winding before the calculation of differential and restraint quantities.
The reference winding (Wref) is the winding to which all currents are referred. This means that the differential and restraint
currents will be in per unit of nominal of the CTs on the reference winding. This is important to know, because the settings of
the operate characteristic of the percent differential element (pickup, breakpoint 1/2) are entered in terms of the same per
unit of nominal. The reference winding is chosen by the relay to be the winding which has the smallest margin of CT pri-
mary current with respect to winding rated current, meaning that the CTs on the reference winding will most likely begin to
saturate before those on other windings with heavy through currents. The characteristics of the reference winding CTs
determine how the percent differential element operate characteristic should be set.
The T60 determines the reference winding as follows:
1. Calculate the rated current (Irated) for each winding: Irated[w] = Prated[w] / (√3 ⋅ Vnominal[w]), w = 1, 2,... Wtotal
Note: Enter the self-cooled MVA rating for the Prated setting
2. Calculate the CT margin (Imargin) for each winding: Imargin[w] = CTprimary[w] / Irated[w], w = 1, 2,... Wtotal
3. Choose the winding with the lowest CT margin:
In our example, the reference winding is chosen as follows:
1. Irated[1] = 100 MVA / (√3 ⋅ 220 kV) = 262.4 A; Irated[2] = 100 MVA / (√3 ⋅ 69 kV) = 836.7 A
2. Imargin[1] = 500 A / 262.4 A = 1.91; Imargin[2] = 1500 A / 836.7 A = 1.79
3. Wref = 2
The reference winding is shown in METERING TRANSFORMER DIFFERENTIAL AND RESTRAINT REFERENCE WINDING.
The unit for calculation of the differential and restraint currents and base for the differential restraint settings is the CT pri-
mary associated with the reference winding. In this example, the unit CT is 1500:5 on Winding 2.
Magnitude compensation factors (M) are the scaling values by which each winding current is multiplied to refer it to the ref-
erence winding. The T60 calculates magnitude compensation factors for each winding as follows:
M[w] = (Iprimary[w] ⋅ Vnominal[w]) / (Iprimary[Wref] ⋅ Vnominal[Wref]), w = 1, 2,... Wtotal
In our example, the magnitude compensation factors are calculated as follows:
M[1] = (500 A ⋅ 220 kV) / (1500 A ⋅ 69 kV) = 1.0628
M[2] = (1500 A ⋅ 69 kV) / (1500 A ⋅ 69 kV) = 1.0000
The maximum allowed magnitude compensation factor (and hence the maximum allowed CT ratio mismatch) is 32.
Table 5–4: PHASE AND ZERO SEQUENCE COMPENSATION FOR TYPICAL VALUES OF Φcomp
Φcomp[w] Grounding[w] = “Not within zone” Grounding[w] = “Within zone”
0° p 2 1 1
p I A [ w ] = --- I A [ w ] – --- I B [ w ] – --- I C [ w ]
IA [ w ] = IA [ w ] 3 3 3
p 2 1 1
p
IB [ w ] = IB [ w ] I B [ w ] = --- I B [ w ] – --- I A [ w ] – --- I C [ w ]
3 3 3
p
IC [ w ] = IC [ w ] p 2 1 1
I C [ w ] = --- I C [ w ] – --- I A [ w ] – --- I B [ w ]
3 3 3
30° lag p 1 1 p 1 1
I A [ w ] = ------- I A [ w ] – ------- I C [ w ] I A [ w ] = ------- I A [ w ] – ------- I C [ w ]
3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1
I B [ w ] = ------- I B [ w ] – ------- I A [ w ] I B [ w ] = ------- I B [ w ] – ------- I A [ w ]
3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1
IC [ w ] = ------- IC [ w ] – - IB [ w ]
------ IC [ w ] = ------- IC [ w ] – - IB [ w ]
------
3 3 3 3
60° lag p 2 1 1
p I A [ w ] = – --- I C [ w ] + --- I A [ w ] + --- I B [ w ]
IA [ w ] = –IC [ w ] , 3 3 3
p 2 1 1
p
IB [ w ] = –IA [ w ] , I B [ w ] = – --- I A [ w ] + --- I B [ w ] + --- I C [ w ]
3 3 3
p
IC [ w ] = –IB [ w ] p 2 1 1
I C [ w ] = – --- I B [ w ] + --- I A [ w ] + --- I C [ w ]
3 3 3
90° lag p 1 1 p 1 1
I A [ w ] = ------- I B [ w ] – ------- I C [ w ] I A [ w ] = ------- I B [ w ] – ------- I C [ w ]
3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1
I B [ w ] = ------- I C [ w ] – ------- I A [ w ] I B [ w ] = ------- I C [ w ] – ------- I A [ w ]
5 p 1
3
1
3
p 1
3
1
3
I C [ w ] = ------- I A [ w ] – ------- I B [ w ] I C [ w ] = ------- I A [ w ] – ------- I B [ w ]
3 3 3 3
120° lag p 2 1 1
p I A [ w ] = --- I B [ w ] – --- I A [ w ] – --- I C [ w ]
IA [ w ] = IB [ w ] 3 3 3
p 2 1 1
p
IB [ w ] = IC [ w ] I B [ w ] = --- I C [ w ] – --- I A [ w ] – --- I B [ w ]
3 3 3
p
IC [ w ] = IA [ w ] p 2 1 1
I C [ w ] = --- I A [ w ] – --- I B [ w ] – --- I C [ w ]
3 3 3
150° lag p 1 1 p 1 1
I A [ w ] = ------- I B [ w ] – ------- I A [ w ] I A [ w ] = ------- I B [ w ] – ------- I A [ w ]
3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1
I B [ w ] = ------- I C [ w ] – ------- I B [ w ] I B [ w ] = ------- I C [ w ] – ------- I B [ w ]
3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1
I C [ w ] = ------- I A [ w ] – ------- I C [ w ] I C [ w ] = ------- I A [ w ] – ------- I C [ w ]
3 3 3 3
180° lag p 2 1 1
p I A [ w ] = – --- I A [ w ] + --- I B [ w ] + --- I C [ w ]
IA [ w ] = –IA [ w ] 3 3 3
p 2 1 1
p
IB [ w ] = –IB [ w ] I B [ w ] = – --- I B [ w ] + --- I A [ w ] + --- I C [ w ]
3 3 3
p
IC [ w ] = –IC [ w ] p 2 1 1
I C [ w ] = – --- I C [ w ] + --- I A [ w ] + --- I B [ w ]
3 3 3
210° lag p 1 1 p 1 1
I A [ w ] = ------- I C [ w ] – ------- I A [ w ] I A [ w ] = ------- I C [ w ] – ------- I A [ w ]
3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1
I B [ w ] = ------- I A [ w ] – ------- I B [ w ] I B [ w ] = ------- I A [ w ] – ------- I B [ w ]
3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1
I C [ w ] = ------- I B [ w ] – ------- I C [ w ] I C [ w ] = ------- I B [ w ] – ------- I C [ w ]
3 3 3 3
Table 5–4: PHASE AND ZERO SEQUENCE COMPENSATION FOR TYPICAL VALUES OF Φcomp
Φcomp[w] Grounding[w] = “Not within zone” Grounding[w] = “Within zone”
240° lag p 2 1 1
p I A [ w ] = --- I C [ w ] – --- I A [ w ] – --- I B [ w ]
IA [ w ] = IC [ w ] 3 3 3
p 2 1 1
p
IB [ w ] = IA [ w ] I B [ w ] = --- I A [ w ] – --- I B [ w ] – --- I C [ w ]
3 3 3
p
IC [ w ] = IB [ w ] p 2 1 1
I C [ w ] = --- I B [ w ] – --- I A [ w ] – --- I C [ w ]
3 3 3
270° lag p 1 1 p 1 1
I A [ w ] = ------- I C [ w ] – ------- I B [ w ] I A [ w ] = ------- I C [ w ] – ------- I B [ w ]
3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1
IB [ w ] = ------- IA [ w ] – - IC [ w ]
------ IB [ w ] = ------- IA [ w ] – - IC [ w ]
------
3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1
I C [ w ] = ------- I B [ w ] – ------- I A [ w ] I C [ w ] = ------- I B [ w ] – ------- I A [ w ]
3 3 3 3
300° lag p 2 1 1
p I A [ w ] = – --- I B [ w ] + --- I A [ w ] + --- I C [ w ]
IA [ w ] = –IB [ w ] 3 3 3
p 2 1 1
p
IB [ w ] = –IC [ w ] I B [ w ] = – --- I C [ w ] + --- I A [ w ] + --- I B [ w ]
3 3 3
p
IC [ w ] = –IA [ w ] p 2 1 1
IC [ w ] = – IA [ w ] + IB [ w ] + - IC [ w ]
--- --- --
3 3 3
330° lag p 1 1 p 1 1
I A [ w ] = ------- I A [ w ] – ------- I B [ w ] I A [ w ] = ------- I A [ w ] – ------- I B [ w ]
3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1
I B [ w ] = ------- I B [ w ] – ------- I C [ w ] I B [ w ] = ------- I B [ w ] – ------- I C [ w ]
3 3 3 3
p 1 1
I C [ w ] = ------- I C [ w ] – ------- I A [ w ]
p 1 1
I C [ w ] = ------- I C [ w ] – ------- I A [ w ]
5
3 3 3 3
In our example, the following phase and zero-sequence compensation equations would be used:
p 2 1 1 p 2 1 1 p 2 1 1
Winding 1: I A [ 1 ] = --- I A [ 1 ] – --- I B [ 1 ] – --- I C [ 1 ] ; I B [ 1 ] = --- I B [ 1 ] – --- I A [ 1 ] – --- I C [ 1 ] ; I C [ 1 ] = --- I C [ 1 ] – --- I A [ 1 ] – --- I B [ 1 ]
3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3
p 1 1 p 1 1 p 1 1
Winding 2: I A [ w ] = ------- I A [ 2 ] – ------- I B [ 2 ] ; I B [ w ] = ------- I B [ 2 ] – ------- I C [ 2 ] ; I C [ w ] = ------- I C [ 2 ] – ------- I A [ 2 ]
3 3 3 3 3 3
f) MAGNITUDE, PHASE ANGLE, AND ZERO SEQUENCE COMPENSATION
Complete magnitude, phase angle, and zero sequence compensation is as follows:
c p
I A [ w ] = M [ w ] × I A [ w ] , where w = 1, 2, …, w total
c p
I B [ w ] = M [ w ] × I B [ w ] , where w = 1, 2, …, w total
c p
I C [ w ] = M [ w ] × I C [ w ] , where w = 1, 2, …, w total
c
where: I A [ w ] = magnitude, phase and zero sequence compensated winding “w” phase A current
M [ w ] = magnitude compensation factor for winding w (as calculated in section 2)
p
I A [ w ] = phase and zero sequence compensated winding w phase A current (as calculated in section 3)
c c c c c c
Ir A = max ( I A [1 ] , I A [ 2 ] , …, I A [ w total ] ) ; Ir B = max ( I B [1 ] , I B [ 2 ] , …, I B [ w total ] ) ;
c c c
Ir C = max ( I C [1 ] , I C [ 2 ] , …, I C [ w total ] )
where Id A is the phase A differential current and Ir A is the phase A restraint current (likewise for phases B and C).
When the relay is to protect a transformer with windings connected between two breakers, such as in a ring bus or breaker-
and-a-half station configuration, one of the methods for configuring currents into the relay presented below should be used
(see the Breaker-and-a-Half Scheme diagram in the Overview section of this chapter).
For this example it is assumed that winding 1 is connected between two breakers and winding 2 is connected to a single
breaker. The CTs associated with winding 1 are CTX, at 1200/5 A and CTY, at 1000/5 A. CTX is connected to current input
channels 1 through 3 inclusive and CTY is connected to current input channels 5 through 7 inclusive on a type 8C CT/VT
module in relay slot “F.” The CT2 on winding 2 is 5000/5 A and is connected to current input channels 1 through 4 inclusive
on a type 8A CT/VT module in relay slot “M.”
2. Configure Source n (Source 1 for this example) as the current from CTX in Winding 1 in the SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL
SOURCES SOURCE n settings menu.
3. Configure Source n (Source 2 for this example) as the current from CTY in Winding 1 in the SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL
SOURCES SOURCE n settings menu.
4. Configure Source n (Source 3 for this example) to be used as the current in Winding 2 in the SYSTEM SETUP SIG-
NAL SOURCES SOURCE n settings menu.
5. Configure the Source setting of the transformer windings in the SYSTEM SETUP TRANSFORMER WINDING n set-
tings menu.
WINDING 1 SOURCE: “WDG 1X”
WINDING 2 SOURCE: “WDG 1Y”
WINDING 3 SOURCE: “WDG 2"
3. Configure Source n (Source 2 for this example) to be used as the Winding 2 current in the SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL
SOURCES SOURCE n settings menu.
5.3.6 FLEXCURVES™
a) SETTINGS
PATH: SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP FLEXCURVES FLEXCURVE A(D)
FlexCurves™ A through D have settings for entering times to Reset/Operate at the following pickup levels: 0.00 to 0.98 /
1.03 to 20.00. This data is converted into 2 continuous curves by linear interpolation between data points. To enter a cus-
tom FlexCurve™, enter the Reset/Operate time (using the VALUE keys) for each selected pickup point (using the
MESSAGE keys) for the desired protection curve (A, B, C, or D).
The relay using a given FlexCurve™ applies linear approximation for times between the user-entered
points. Special care must be applied when setting the two points that are close to the multiple of pickup of
NOTE
1, i.e. 0.98 pu and 1.03 pu. It is recommended to set the two times to a similar value; otherwise, the linear
approximation may result in undesired behavior for the operating quantity that is close to 1.00 pu.
Addr: Adds the time specified in this field (in ms) to each
curve operating time value.
d) EXAMPLE
A composite curve can be created from the GE_111 standard with MRT = 200 ms and HCT initially disabled and then
enabled at 8 times pickup with an operating time of 30 ms. At approximately 4 times pickup, the curve operating time is
equal to the MRT and from then onwards the operating time remains at 200 ms (see below).
842719A1.CDR
842720A1.CDR
1 GE106
0.5
0.2
TIME (sec)
GE103
GE104 GE105
0.1
0.05
GE101 GE102
0.02
0.01
1 1.2 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 15 20
CURRENT (multiple of pickup) 842723A1.CDR
5
Figure 5–21: RECLOSER CURVES GE101 TO GE106
50
20 GE142
10
5
GE138
TIME (sec)
1 GE120
GE113
0.5
0.2
0.1
0.05
1 1.2 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 15 20
CURRENT (multiple of pickup) 842725A1.CDR
50
20
10
GE201
TIME (sec)
GE151
2
GE134 GE140
1
GE137
0.5
50
GE152
20
TIME (sec)
GE141
10
GE131
5
GE200
2
1 1.2 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 15 20
CURRENT (multiple of pickup) 842728A1.CDR
50
20
GE164
10
2
TIME (sec)
GE162
1
0.5
GE133
0.2
GE165
0.1
0.05
GE161
0.02 GE163
0.01
1 1.2 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 15 20
CURRENT (multiple of pickup) 842729A1.CDR
Figure 5–25: RECLOSER CURVES GE133, GE161, GE162, GE163, GE164 AND GE165 5
20
GE132
10
1
TIME (sec)
0.5 GE139
0.2
GE136
0.1
GE116
0.05
GE118 GE117
0.02
0.01
1 1.2 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 15 20
CURRENT (multiple of pickup) 842726A1.CDR
Figure 5–26: RECLOSER CURVES GE116, GE117, GE118, GE132, GE136, AND GE139
20
10
5
GE122
2
1
TIME (sec)
0.5
GE114
0.2
GE111
GE121
0.1
0.02
0.01
1 1.2 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 15 20
CURRENT (multiple of pickup) 842724A1.CDR
5 Figure 5–27: RECLOSER CURVES GE107, GE111, GE112, GE114, GE115, GE121, AND GE122
50
20
GE202
10
TIME (sec)
GE135
2 GE119
0.5
0.2
1 1.2 1.5 2 2.5 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 15 20
CURRENT (multiple of pickup) 842727A1.CDR
To provide maximum flexibility to the user, the arrangement of internal digital logic combines fixed and user-programmed
parameters. Logic upon which individual features are designed is fixed, and all other logic, from digital input signals through
elements or combinations of elements to digital outputs, is variable. The user has complete control of all variable logic
through FlexLogic™. In general, the system receives analog and digital inputs which it uses to produce analog and digital
outputs. The major sub-systems of a generic UR relay involved in this process are shown below.
The logic that determines the interaction of inputs, elements, schemes and outputs is field programmable through the use
of logic equations that are sequentially processed. The use of virtual inputs and outputs in addition to hardware is available
internally and on the communication ports for other relays to use (distributed FlexLogic™).
FlexLogic™ allows users to customize the relay through a series of equations that consist of operators and operands. The
operands are the states of inputs, elements, schemes and outputs. The operators are logic gates, timers and latches (with
set and reset inputs). A system of sequential operations allows any combination of specified operands to be assigned as
inputs to specified operators to create an output. The final output of an equation is a numbered register called a virtual out-
put. Virtual outputs can be used as an input operand in any equation, including the equation that generates the output, as a
seal-in or other type of feedback.
A FlexLogic™ equation consists of parameters that are either operands or operators. Operands have a logic state of 1 or 0.
Operators provide a defined function, such as an AND gate or a Timer. Each equation defines the combinations of parame-
ters to be used to set a Virtual Output flag. Evaluation of an equation results in either a 1 (=ON, i.e. flag set) or 0 (=OFF, i.e.
flag not set). Each equation is evaluated at least 4 times every power system cycle.
Some types of operands are present in the relay in multiple instances; e.g. contact and remote inputs. These types of oper-
ands are grouped together (for presentation purposes only) on the faceplate display. The characteristics of the different
types of operands are listed in the table below.
only) Voltage Off Cont Op 1 VOff Voltage does not exists across the contact.
Current On Cont Op 1 IOn Current is flowing through the contact.
Current Off Cont Op 1 IOff Current is not flowing through the contact.
Direct Input On DIRECT INPUT 1 On The direct input is presently in the ON state.
Element Pickup PHASE TOC1 PKP The tested parameter is presently above the pickup setting
(Analog) of an element which responds to rising values or below the
pickup setting of an element which responds to falling
values.
Dropout PHASE TOC1 DPO This operand is the logical inverse of the above PKP
operand.
Operate PHASE TOC1 OP The tested parameter has been above/below the pickup
setting of the element for the programmed delay time, or
has been at logic 1 and is now at logic 0 but the reset timer
has not finished timing.
Block PH DIR1 BLK The output of the comparator is set to the block function.
Element Pickup Dig Element 1 PKP The input operand is at logic 1.
(Digital)
Dropout Dig Element 1 DPO This operand is the logical inverse of the above PKP
operand.
Operate Dig Element 1 OP The input operand has been at logic 1 for the programmed
pickup delay time, or has been at logic 1 for this period and
is now at logic 0 but the reset timer has not finished timing.
Element Higher than Counter 1 HI The number of pulses counted is above the set number.
(Digital Counter)
Equal to Counter 1 EQL The number of pulses counted is equal to the set number.
Lower than Counter 1 LO The number of pulses counted is below the set number.
Fixed On On Logic 1
Off Off Logic 0
Remote Input On REMOTE INPUT 1 On The remote input is presently in the ON state.
Virtual Input On Virt Ip 1 On The virtual input is presently in the ON state.
Virtual Output On Virt Op 1 On The virtual output is presently in the set state (i.e.
evaluation of the equation which produces this virtual
output results in a "1").
The operands available for this relay are listed alphabetically by types in the following table.
Table 5–7: T60 FLEXLOGIC™ OPERANDS (Sheet 1 of 4)
OPERAND TYPE OPERAND SYNTAX OPERAND DESCRIPTION
CONTROL CONTROL PUSHBTN n ON Control Pushbutton n (n = 1 to 7) is being pressed.
PUSHBUTTONS
DIRECT DEVICES DIRECT DEVICE 1 On Flag is set, logic=1
↓ ↓
DIRECT DEVICE 16 On Flag is set, logic=1
DIRECT DEVICE 1 Off Flag is set, logic=1
↓ ↓
DIRECT DEVICE 16 Off Flag is set, logic=1
DIRECT I/O DIR IO CH1(2) CRC ALARM The rate of Direct Input messages received on Channel 1(2) and failing the
CHANNEL CRC exceeded the user-specified level.
MONITORING DIR IO CRC ALARM The rate of Direct Input messages failing the CRC exceeded the user-
specified level on Channel 1 or 2.
DIR IO CH1(2) UNRET ALM The rate of returned Direct I/O messages on Channel 1(2) exceeded the
user-specified level (ring configurations only).
DIR IO UNRET ALM The rate of returned Direct I/O messages exceeded the user-specified level
on Channel 1 or 2 (ring configurations only).
ELEMENT: AUX OV1 PKP Auxiliary Overvoltage element has picked up
Auxiliary OV AUX OV1 DPO Auxiliary Overvoltage element has dropped out
AUX OV1 OP Auxiliary Overvoltage element has operated
ELEMENT: AUX UV1 PKP Auxiliary Undervoltage element has picked up
Auxiliary UV AUX UV1 DPO Auxiliary Undervoltage element has dropped out
AUX UV1 OP Auxiliary Undervoltage element has operated
ELEMENT: Counter 1 HI Digital Counter 1 output is ‘more than’ comparison value
Digital Counter Counter 1 EQL Digital Counter 1 output is ‘equal to’ comparison value
Counter 1 LO Digital Counter 1 output is ‘less than’ comparison value
↓ ↓
Counter 8 HI Digital Counter 8 output is ‘more than’ comparison value
Counter 8 EQL
Counter 8 LO
Digital Counter 8 output is ‘equal to’ comparison value
Digital Counter 8 output is ‘less than’ comparison value
5
ELEMENT: Dig Element 1 PKP Digital Element 1 is picked up
Digital Element Dig Element 1 OP Digital Element 1 is operated
Dig Element 1 DPO Digital Element 1 is dropped out
↓ ↓
Dig Element 16 PKP Digital Element 16 is picked up
Dig Element 16 OP Digital Element 16 is operated
Dig Element 16 DPO Digital Element 16 is dropped out
ELEMENT: FxE 1 PKP FlexElement™ 1 has picked up
FlexElements™ FxE 1 OP FlexElement™ 1 has operated
FxE 1 DPO FlexElement™ 1 has dropped out
↓ ↓
FxE 16 PKP FlexElement™ 16 has picked up
FxE 16 OP FlexElement™ 16 has operated
FxE 16 DPO FlexElement™ 16 has dropped out
ELEMENT: GROUND IOC1 PKP Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 has picked up
Ground IOC GROUND IOC1 OP Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 has operated
GROUND IOC1 DPO Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 has dropped out
GROUND IOC2 to IOC8 Same set of operands as shown for GROUND IOC 1
ELEMENT: GROUND TOC1 PKP Ground Time Overcurrent 1 has picked up
Ground TOC GROUND TOC1 OP Ground Time Overcurrent 1 has operated
GROUND TOC1 DPO Ground Time Overcurrent 1 has dropped out
GROUND TOC2 to TOC6 Same set of operands as shown for GROUND TOC1
ELEMENT LATCH 1 ON Non-Volatile Latch 1 is ON (Logic = 1)
Non-Volatile LATCH 1 OFF Non-Voltage Latch 1 is OFF (Logic = 0)
Latches ↓ ↓
LATCH 16 ON Non-Volatile Latch 16 is ON (Logic = 1)
LATCH 16 OFF Non-Voltage Latch 16 is OFF (Logic = 0)
ELEMENT: NEUTRAL IOC1 PKP Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 has picked up
Neutral IOC NEUTRAL IOC1 OP Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 has operated
NEUTRAL IOC1 DPO Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 has dropped out
NEUTRAL IOC2 to IOC8 Same set of operands as shown for NEUTRAL IOC1
ELEMENT: NEUTRAL OV1 PKP Neutral Overvoltage element has picked up
Neutral OV NEUTRAL OV1 DPO Neutral Overvoltage element has dropped out
NEUTRAL OV1 OP Neutral Overvoltage element has operated
Some operands can be re-named by the user. These are the names of the breakers in the breaker control feature, the ID
(identification) of contact inputs, the ID of virtual inputs, and the ID of virtual outputs. If the user changes the default name/
ID of any of these operands, the assigned name will appear in the relay list of operands. The default names are shown in
the FlexLogic™ Operands table above.
The characteristics of the logic gates are tabulated below, and the operators available in FlexLogic™ are listed in the Flex-
Logic™ Operators table.
When forming a FlexLogic™ equation, the sequence in the linear array of parameters must follow these general rules:
1. Operands must precede the operator which uses the operands as inputs.
2. Operators have only one output. The output of an operator must be used to create a virtual output if it is to be used as
an input to two or more operators.
3. Assigning the output of an operator to a Virtual Output terminates the equation.
4. A timer operator (e.g. "TIMER 1") or virtual output assignment (e.g. " = Virt Op 1") may only be used once. If this rule is
broken, a syntax error will be declared.
Each equation is evaluated in the order in which the parameters have been entered.
FlexLogic™ provides latches which by definition have a memory action, remaining in the set state after the
set input has been asserted. However, they are volatile; i.e. they reset on the re-application of control
CAUTION
power.
When making changes to settings, all FlexLogic™ equations are re-compiled whenever any new setting
value is entered, so all latches are automatically reset. If it is necessary to re-initialize FlexLogic™ during
testing, for example, it is suggested to power the unit down and then back up.
This section provides an example of implementing logic for a typical application. The sequence of the steps is quite impor-
tant as it should minimize the work necessary to develop the relay settings. Note that the example presented in the figure
below is intended to demonstrate the procedure, not to solve a specific application situation.
In the example below, it is assumed that logic has already been programmed to produce Virtual Outputs 1 and 2, and is
only a part of the full set of equations used. When using FlexLogic™, it is important to make a note of each Virtual Output
used – a Virtual Output designation (1 to 64) can only be properly assigned once.
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1
State=ON
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 2
Set
State=ON
LATCH
OR #1 Reset
5 VIRTUAL INPUT 1
State=ON
XOR
Timer 2
Time Delay Operate Output
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 OR #2
on Dropout Relay H1
State=Pickup
(200 ms)
Therefore, the required logic can be implemented with two FlexLogic™ equations with outputs of Virtual Output 3 and
Virtual Output 4 as shown below.
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1
State=ON
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 2
Set
State=ON
LATCH
VIRTUAL INPUT 1 OR #1 Reset
State=ON Timer 2
XOR Time Delay
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 OR #2 VIRTUAL OUTPUT 4
on Dropout
State=Pickup (200 ms)
827026A2.VSD
DIGITAL ELEMENT 2
State=Operated
827027A2.VSD
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1
State=ON
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 2
Set
State=ON
LATCH
VIRTUAL INPUT 1 OR #1 Reset
State=ON Timer 2
XOR Time Delay VIRTUAL
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 OR #2
on Dropout OUTPUT 4
State=Pickup
(200 ms)
Timer 1
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 3 Time Delay
State=ON on Pickup
(800 ms)
CONTACT INPUT H1c
State=Closed 827028A2.VSD
01
02
03
04
05
.....
97
98
99
827029A1.VSD
97: The operator preceding Timer 2 is OR #2, a 3-input OR, which is parameter “OR(3)”.
96: The lowest input to OR #2 is operand “Cont Ip H1c On”.
95: The center input to OR #2 is operand “TIMER 1".
94: The input to Timer 1 is operand “Virt Op 3 On".
93: The upper input to OR #2 is operand “LATCH (S,R)”.
92: There are two inputs to a latch, and the input immediately preceding the latch reset is OR #1, a 4-input OR, which
is parameter “OR(4)”.
91: The lowest input to OR #1 is operand “Virt Op 3 On".
90: The input just above the lowest input to OR #1 is operand “XOR(2)”.
89: The lower input to the XOR is operand “DIG ELEM 1 PKP”.
88: The upper input to the XOR is operand “Virt Ip 1 On".
87: The input just below the upper input to OR #1 is operand “Virt Op 2 On".
86: The upper input to OR #1 is operand “Virt Op 1 On".
85: The last parameter is used to set the latch, and is operand “Virt Op 4 On".
The equation for VIRTUAL OUTPUT 4 is:
[85] Virt Op 4 On
[86] Virt Op 1 On
[87] Virt Op 2 On
[88] Virt Ip 1 On
[89]
[90]
DIG ELEM 1 PKP
XOR(2)
5
[91] Virt Op 3 On
[92] OR(4)
[93] LATCH (S,R)
[94] Virt Op 3 On
[95] TIMER 1
[96] Cont Ip H1c On
[97] OR(3)
[98] TIMER 2
[99] = Virt Op 4
It is now possible to check that the selection of parameters will produce the required logic by converting the set of parame-
ters into a logic diagram. The result of this process is shown below, which is compared to the Logic for Virtual Output 4 dia-
gram as a check.
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
85 Virt Op 4 On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
86 Virt Op 1 On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
87 Virt Op 2 On
Set
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
88 Virt Ip 1 On
LATCH
XOR OR Reset
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
89 DIG ELEM 1 PKP
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
90 XOR
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
91 Virt Op 3 On VIRTUAL
OR T2 OUTPUT 4
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
92 OR (4)
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
93 LATCH (S,R)
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
94 Virt Op 3 On T1
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
95 TIMER 1
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
96 Cont Ip H1c On
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
97 OR (3)
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
98 TIMER 2
FLEXLOGIC ENTRY n:
99 =Virt Op 4 827031A2.VSD
8. The logic should always be tested after it is loaded into the relay, in the same fashion as has been used in the past.
Testing can be simplified by placing an "END" operator within the overall set of FlexLogic™ equations. The equations
will then only be evaluated up to the first "END" operator.
The "On" and "Off" operands can be placed in an equation to establish a known set of conditions for test purposes, and
the "INSERT" and "DELETE" commands can be used to modify equations.
There are 512 FlexLogic™ entries available, numbered from 1 to 512, with default ‘END’ entry settings. If a "Disabled" Ele-
ment is selected as a FlexLogic™ entry, the associated state flag will never be set to ‘1’. The ‘+/–‘ key may be used when
editing FlexLogic™ equations from the keypad to quickly scan through the major parameter types.
There are 32 identical FlexLogic™ timers available. These timers can be used as operators for FlexLogic™ equations.
• TIMER 1 TYPE: This setting is used to select the time measuring unit.
• TIMER 1 PICKUP DELAY: Sets the time delay to pickup. If a pickup delay is not required, set this function to "0".
• TIMER 1 DROPOUT DELAY: Sets the time delay to dropout. If a dropout delay is not required, set this function to "0".
5.4.7 FLEXELEMENTS™
5 MESSAGE
HYSTERESIS: 3.0%
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt Range: milliseconds, seconds, minutes
MESSAGE
UNIT: milliseconds
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt: Range: 20 to 86400 in steps of 1
MESSAGE
20
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
MESSAGE
DELAY: 0.000 s
FLEXELEMENT 1 RST Range: 0.000 to 65.535 s in steps of 0.001
MESSAGE
DELAY: 0.000 s
FLEXELEMENT 1 Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
BLOCK: Off
FLEXELEMENT 1 Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
MESSAGE
TARGET: Self-reset
FLEXELEMENT 1 Range: Disabled, Enabled
MESSAGE
EVENTS: Disabled
A FlexElement™ is a universal comparator that can be used to monitor any analog actual value calculated by the relay or a
net difference of any two analog actual values of the same type. The effective operating signal could be treated as a signed
number or its absolute value could be used as per user's choice.
The element can be programmed to respond either to a signal level or to a rate-of-change (delta) over a pre-defined period
of time. The output operand is asserted when the operating signal is higher than a threshold or lower than a threshold as
per user's choice.
SETTING
SETTINGS
FLEXELEMENT 1
FUNCTION: FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT
MODE:
Enabled = 1
FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP
MODE:
Disabled = 0
FLEXELEMENT 1
DIRECTION:
SETTING
FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP:
FLEXELEMENT 1 BLK:
FLEXELEMENT 1 INPUT
AND HYSTERESIS:
Off = 0
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt UNIT: SETTINGS
SETTINGS FLEXELEMENT 1
FLEXELEMENT 1 dt: PICKUP DELAY:
FLEXELEMENT 1 +IN: FLEXELEMENT 1
RUN RESET DELAY:
Actual Value FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
+ tPKP
FLEXELEMENT 1 -IN: FxE 1 OP
- tRST
Actual Value FxE 1 DPO
FxE 1 PKP
ACTUAL VALUE
The FLEXELEMENT 1 DIRECTION setting enables the relay to respond to either high or low values of the operating signal. The
following figure explains the application of the FLEXELEMENT 1 DIRECTION, FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP and FLEXELEMENT 1 HYS-
TERESIS settings.
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Over
HYSTERESIS = % of PICKUP
FlexElement 1 OpSig
PICKUP
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Under
HYSTERESIS = % of PICKUP
FlexElement 1 OpSig
PICKUP
842705A1.CDR
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
5 FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Over;
FLEXELEMENT COMP
MODE = Signed;
FlexElement 1 OpSig
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Over;
FLEXELEMENT COMP
MODE = Absolute;
FlexElement 1 OpSig
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Under;
FLEXELEMENT COMP
MODE = Signed;
FlexElement 1 OpSig
FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP
FLEXELEMENT
DIRECTION = Under;
FLEXELEMENT COMP
MODE = Absolute;
FlexElement 1 OpSig
842706A1.CDR
The FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP setting specifies the operating threshold for the effective operating signal of the element. If set
to “Over”, the element picks up when the operating signal exceeds the FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP value. If set to “Under”, the
element picks up when the operating signal falls below the FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP value.
The FLEXELEMENT 1 HYSTERESIS setting controls the element dropout. It should be noticed that both the operating signal
and the pickup threshold can be negative facilitating applications such as reverse power alarm protection. The FlexEle-
ment™ can be programmed to work with all analog actual values measured by the relay. The FLEXELEMENT 1 PICKUP set-
ting is entered in pu values using the following definitions of the base units:
The FLEXELEMENT 1 HYSTERESIS setting defines the pickup–dropout relation of the element by specifying the width of the
hysteresis loop as a percentage of the pickup value as shown in the FlexElement™ Direction, Pickup, and Hysteresis dia-
gram.
The FLEXELEMENT 1 DT UNIT setting specifies the time unit for the setting FLEXELEMENT 1 dt. This setting is applicable only if
FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE is set to “Delta”. The FLEXELEMENT 1 DT setting specifies duration of the time interval for the
rate of change mode of operation. This setting is applicable only if FLEXELEMENT 1 COMP MODE is set to “Delta”.
This FLEXELEMENT 1 PKP DELAY setting specifies the pickup delay of the element. The FLEXELEMENT 1 RST DELAY setting
specifies the reset delay of the element.
The non-volatile latches provide a permanent logical flag that is stored safely and will not reset upon reboot after the relay
is powered down. Typical applications include sustaining operator commands or permanently block relay functions, such as
Autorecloser, until a deliberate HMI action resets the latch. The settings, logic, and element operation are described below:
• LATCH 1 TYPE: This setting characterizes Latch 1 to be Set- or Reset-dominant.
• LATCH 1 SET: If asserted, the specified FlexLogic™ operands 'sets' Latch 1.
5 • LATCH 1 RESET: If asserted, the specified FlexLogic™ operand 'resets' Latch 1.
SETTING
SETTING
LATCH N LATCH N LATCH N LATCH N LATCH N LATCH 1 FUNCTION:
TYPE SET RESET ON OFF
LATCH 1 TYPE:
Reset ON OFF ON OFF Disabled=0
Dominant Enabled=1 RUN
OFF OFF Previous Previous
State State
ON ON OFF ON SETTING
Figure 5–40: NON-VOLATILE LATCH OPERATION TABLE (N=1 to 16) AND LOGIC
Each protection element can be assigned up to six different sets of settings according to Setting Group designations 1 to 6.
The performance of these elements is defined by the active Setting Group at a given time. Multiple setting groups allow the
user to conveniently change protection settings for different operating situations (e.g. altered power system configuration,
season of the year). The active setting group can be preset or selected via the SETTING GROUPS menu (see the Control Ele-
ments section later in this chapter). See also the Introduction to Elements section at the beginning of this chapter.
PHASE CURRENT
MESSAGE See page 5–83.
NEUTRAL CURRENT
MESSAGE See page 5–93.
GROUND CURRENT
MESSAGE See page 5–100.
VOLTAGE ELEMENTS
MESSAGE See page 5–107.
Each of the six Setting Group menus is identical. Setting Group 1 (the default active group) automatically becomes active if
no other group is active (see the Control Elements section in this chapter for additional details).
5
5.5.3 TRANSFORMER ELEMENTS
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) TRANSFORMER
TRANSFORMER PERCENT
See page 5–78.
DIFFERENTIAL
INSTANTANEOUS
MESSAGE See page 5–81.
DIFFERENTIAL
b) PERCENT DIFFERENTIAL
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) TRANSFORMER PERCENT DIFFERENTIAL
The calculation of differential (Id) and restraint (Ir) currents for the purposes of the percent differential element is described
by the following block diagram, where “Σ” has as its output the vector sum of inputs, and “max” has as its output the input of
maximum magnitude; these calculations are performed for each phase.
The differential current is calculated as a vector sum of currents from all windings after magnitude and angle compensation.
The restraint current is calculated as a maximum of the same internally compensated currents.
∑ MAX
5
Differential Restraint
phasor phasor
828714A1.CDR
BREAK 2
Transition Region
(cubic spline) SLOPE 2
Id (Ir)
Region
BREAK 1
PICKUP
Ir
• PERCENT DIFFERENTIAL PICKUP: This setting defines the minimum differential current required for operation. It is
chosen, based on the amount of differential current that might be seen under normal operating conditions. Two factors
may create differential current during the normal transformer operation: errors due to CT inaccuracies and current vari-
ation due to onload tap changer operation.
A setting of 0.1 to 0.3 is generally recommended (the factory default is 0.1 pu).
• PERCENT DIFFERENTIAL SLOPE 1: This setting defines the differential restraint during normal operating conditions
to assure sensitivity to internal faults. The setting must be high enough, however, to cope with CT saturation errors dur-
ing saturation under small current magnitudes but significant and long lasting DC components (such as during distant
external faults in vicinity of generators).
• PERCENT DIFFERENTIAL BREAK 1 and BREAK 2: The settings for Break 1 and Break 2 depend very much on the
capability of CTs to correctly transform primary into secondary currents during external faults. Break 2 should be set
below the fault current that is most likely to saturate some CTs due to an AC component alone. Break 1 should be set
below a current that would cause CT saturation due to DC components and/or residual magnetism. The latter may be
as high as 80% of the nominal flux, effectively reducing the CT capabilities by the factor of 5.
• PERCENT DIFFERENTIAL SLOPE 2: The Slope 2 setting ensures stability during heavy through fault conditions,
where CT saturation results in high differential current. Slope 2 should be set high to cater for the worst case where
one set of CTs saturates but the other set doesn't. In such a case the ratio of the differential current to restraint current
can be as high as 95 to 98%.
• INRUSH INHIBIT FUNCTION: This setting provides a choice for 2nd harmonic differential protection blocking during
magnetizing inrush conditions. Two choices are available: “Adapt. 2nd” – adaptive 2nd harmonic, and “Trad. 2nd” – tra-
ditional 2nd harmonic blocking. The adaptive 2nd harmonic restraint responds to both magnitudes and phase angles of
the 2nd harmonic and the fundamental frequency component. The traditional 2nd harmonic restraint responds to the
ratio of magnitudes of the 2nd harmonic and fundamental frequency components. If low second harmonic ratios during
5 •
magnetizing inrush conditions are not expected, the relay should be set to traditional way of restraining.
INRUSH INHIBIT MODE: This setting specifies mode of blocking on magnetizing inrush conditions. Modern transform-
ers may produce small 2nd harmonic ratios during inrush conditions. This may result undesired tripping of the pro-
tected transformer. Reducing the 2nd harmonic inhibit threshold may jeopardize dependability and speed of protection.
The 2nd harmonic ratio, if low, causes problems in one phase only. This may be utilized as a mean to ensure security
by applying cross-phase blocking rather than lowering the inrush inhibit threshold.
If set to “Per phase”, the relay performs inrush inhibit individually in each phase. If used on modern transformers, this
setting should be combined with adaptive 2nd harmonic function.
If set to “2-out-of-3”, the relay checks 2nd harmonic level in all three phases individually. If any two phases establish a
blocking condition, the remaining phase is restrained automatically.
If set to “Average”, the relay first calculates the average 2nd harmonic ratio, then applies the inrush threshold to the
calculated average. This mode works only in conjunction with the traditional 2nd harmonic function.
• INRUSH INHIBIT LEVEL: This setting specifies the level of 2nd harmonic component in the transformer magnetizing
inrush current above which the percent differential element will be inhibited from operating. The value of the INRUSH
INHIBIT MODE setting must be taken into account when programming this value. The INRUSH INHIBIT LEVEL is typically
set to 20%.
• OVEREXCITATION INHIBIT MODE: An overexcitation condition resulting from an increased V/Hz ratio poses a dan-
ger to the protected transformer, hence the V/Hz protection. A given transformer can, however, tolerate an overfluxing
condition for a limited time, as the danger is associated with thermal processes in the core. Instantaneous tripping of
the transformer from the differential protection is not desirable. The relay uses a traditional 5th harmonic ratio for inhib-
iting its differential function during overexcitation conditions.
• OVEREXCITATION INHIBIT LEVEL: This setting is provided to block the differential protection during overexcitation.
When the 5th harmonic level exceeds the specified setting (5th harmonic ratio) the differential element is blocked. The
overexcitation inhibit works on a per-phase basis.
The relay produces three FlexLogic™ operands that may be used for testing or for special applications such as building
custom logic (1-out-of-3) or supervising some protection functions (ground time overcurrent, for example) from the 2nd har-
monic inhibit.
SETTING SETTING
INRUSH INHIBIT INRUSH INHIBIT LEVEL
FUNCTION: FUNCTION & MODE: FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Disabled = 0 RUN
SETTING
OVEREXC ITN INHIBIT SETTING
FUNCTION: OVEREXC ITN INHIBIT
Disabled = 0 LEVEL: FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
5th = 1 RUN
Iad5 > LEVEL XFMR PCNT DIFF 5TH A
c) INSTANTANEOUS DIFFERENTIAL
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) TRANSFORMER INSTANTANEOUS DIFFERENTIAL
The Instantaneous Differential element acts as an instantaneous overcurrent element responding to the measured differen-
tial current magnitude (filtered fundamental frequency component) and applying a user-selectable pickup threshold. The
pickup threshold should be set greater than the maximum spurious differential current that could be encountered under
non-internal fault conditions (typically magnetizing inrush current or an external fault with extremely severe CT saturation).
SETTING
INST DIFFERENTIAL
FUNCTION:
Disabled=0 FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETTING
Enabled=1 XFMR INST DIFF OP A
INST DIFFERENTIAL
XFMR INST DIFF OP B
PICKUP:
SETTING XFMR INST DIFF OP C
AND RUN
Iad > PICKUP
INST DIFF BLOCK:
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
RUN
Off=0 Ibd > PICKUP OR XFMR INST DIFF OP
RUN
ACTUAL VALUE Icd > PICKUP
828000A1.CDR
DIFF PHASOR
Iad
Ibd
Icd
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) PHASE CURRENT
PHASE TOC6
MESSAGE
PHASE IOC1
MESSAGE See page 5–90.
PHASE IOC8
MESSAGE
PHASE
MESSAGE See page 5–91.
DIRECTIONAL 1
The Phase Current elements can be used for tripping, alarming, or other functions. The actual number of elements
depends on the number of current banks.
A time dial multiplier setting allows selection of a multiple of the base curve shape (where the time dial multiplier = 1) with
the curve shape (CURVE) setting. Unlike the electromechanical time dial equivalent, operate times are directly proportional
to the time multiplier (TD MULTIPLIER) setting value. For example, all times for a multiplier of 10 are 10 times the multiplier 1
or base curve values. Setting the multiplier to zero results in an instantaneous response to all current levels above pickup.
Time overcurrent time calculations are made with an internal “energy capacity” memory variable. When this variable indi-
cates that the energy capacity has reached 100%, a time overcurrent element will operate. If less than 100% energy capac-
ity is accumulated in this variable and the current falls below the dropout threshold of 97 to 98% of the pickup value, the
variable must be reduced. Two methods of this resetting operation are available: “Instantaneous” and “Timed”. The Instan-
taneous selection is intended for applications with other relays, such as most static relays, which set the energy capacity
directly to zero when the current falls below the reset threshold. The Timed selection can be used where the relay must
coordinate with electromechanical relays.
IEEE CURVES:
The IEEE time overcurrent curve shapes conform to industry standards and the IEEE C37.112-1996 curve classifications
for extremely, very, and moderately inverse. The IEEE curves are derived from the formulae:
A tr
---------------------------------- + B ---------------------------------
-
T = TDM × ⎛ ---------------
I -⎞ p T TDM × 2
1 – ⎛ ----------------⎞
, = I (EQ 5.10)
⎝ I pickup⎠ – 1
RESET
⎝ I pickup⎠
where: T = operate time (in seconds), TDM = Multiplier setting, I = input current, Ipickup = Pickup Current setting
A, B, p = constants, TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET is “Timed”),
tr = characteristic constant
5 0.5
1.0
11.341
22.682
4.761
9.522
1.823
3.647
1.001
2.002
0.648
1.297
0.464
0.927
0.355
0.709
0.285
0.569
0.237
0.474
0.203
0.407
2.0 45.363 19.043 7.293 4.003 2.593 1.855 1.418 1.139 0.948 0.813
4.0 90.727 38.087 14.587 8.007 5.187 3.710 2.837 2.277 1.897 1.626
6.0 136.090 57.130 21.880 12.010 7.780 5.564 4.255 3.416 2.845 2.439
8.0 181.454 76.174 29.174 16.014 10.374 7.419 5.674 4.555 3.794 3.252
10.0 226.817 95.217 36.467 20.017 12.967 9.274 7.092 5.693 4.742 4.065
IEEE VERY INVERSE
0.5 8.090 3.514 1.471 0.899 0.654 0.526 0.450 0.401 0.368 0.345
1.0 16.179 7.028 2.942 1.798 1.308 1.051 0.900 0.802 0.736 0.689
2.0 32.358 14.055 5.885 3.597 2.616 2.103 1.799 1.605 1.472 1.378
4.0 64.716 28.111 11.769 7.193 5.232 4.205 3.598 3.209 2.945 2.756
6.0 97.074 42.166 17.654 10.790 7.849 6.308 5.397 4.814 4.417 4.134
8.0 129.432 56.221 23.538 14.387 10.465 8.410 7.196 6.418 5.889 5.513
10.0 161.790 70.277 29.423 17.983 13.081 10.513 8.995 8.023 7.361 6.891
IEEE MODERATELY INVERSE
0.5 3.220 1.902 1.216 0.973 0.844 0.763 0.706 0.663 0.630 0.603
1.0 6.439 3.803 2.432 1.946 1.688 1.526 1.412 1.327 1.260 1.207
2.0 12.878 7.606 4.864 3.892 3.377 3.051 2.823 2.653 2.521 2.414
4.0 25.756 15.213 9.729 7.783 6.753 6.102 5.647 5.307 5.041 4.827
6.0 38.634 22.819 14.593 11.675 10.130 9.153 8.470 7.960 7.562 7.241
8.0 51.512 30.426 19.458 15.567 13.507 12.204 11.294 10.614 10.083 9.654
10.0 64.390 38.032 24.322 19.458 16.883 15.255 14.117 13.267 12.604 12.068
IEC CURVES
For European applications, the relay offers three standard curves defined in IEC 255-4 and British standard BS142. These
are defined as IEC Curve A, IEC Curve B, and IEC Curve C. The formulae for these curves are:
K tr
--------------------------------------- --------------------------------------
-
T = TDM × ( I ⁄ I pickup ) E – 1 , T RESET = TDM × 1 – ( I ⁄ I 2 (EQ 5.11)
pickup )
where: T = operate time (in seconds), TDM = Multiplier setting, I = input current, Ipickup = Pickup Current setting, K, E =
constants, tr = characteristic constant, and TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100%
and RESET is “Timed”)
IAC CURVES:
The curves for the General Electric type IAC relay family are derived from the formulae:
⎛ B D E ⎞ tr
T = TDM × ⎜ A + ------------------------------ + -------------------------------------2- + -------------------------------------3-⎟ , T RESET = TDM × -------------------------------
- (EQ 5.12)
⎝ ( I ⁄ I ) – C ( ( I ⁄ I ) – C ) ( ( I ⁄ I ) – C ) ⎠ 2
pkp pkp pkp 1 – ( I ⁄ I pkp )
where: T = operate time (in seconds), TDM = Multiplier setting, I = Input current, Ipkp = Pickup Current setting, A to E =
constants, tr = characteristic constant, and TRESET = reset time in seconds (assuming energy capacity is 100%
and RESET is “Timed”)
5 1.0
2.0
3.398
6.796
1.498
2.997
0.606
1.212
0.356
0.711
0.246
0.491
0.186
0.372
0.149
0.298
0.124
0.248
0.106
0.212
0.093
0.185
4.0 13.591 5.993 2.423 1.422 0.983 0.744 0.595 0.495 0.424 0.370
6.0 20.387 8.990 3.635 2.133 1.474 1.115 0.893 0.743 0.636 0.556
8.0 27.183 11.987 4.846 2.844 1.966 1.487 1.191 0.991 0.848 0.741
10.0 33.979 14.983 6.058 3.555 2.457 1.859 1.488 1.239 1.060 0.926
IAC VERY INVERSE
0.5 1.451 0.656 0.269 0.172 0.133 0.113 0.101 0.093 0.087 0.083
1.0 2.901 1.312 0.537 0.343 0.266 0.227 0.202 0.186 0.174 0.165
2.0 5.802 2.624 1.075 0.687 0.533 0.453 0.405 0.372 0.349 0.331
4.0 11.605 5.248 2.150 1.374 1.065 0.906 0.810 0.745 0.698 0.662
6.0 17.407 7.872 3.225 2.061 1.598 1.359 1.215 1.117 1.046 0.992
8.0 23.209 10.497 4.299 2.747 2.131 1.813 1.620 1.490 1.395 1.323
10.0 29.012 13.121 5.374 3.434 2.663 2.266 2.025 1.862 1.744 1.654
IAC INVERSE
0.5 0.578 0.375 0.266 0.221 0.196 0.180 0.168 0.160 0.154 0.148
1.0 1.155 0.749 0.532 0.443 0.392 0.360 0.337 0.320 0.307 0.297
2.0 2.310 1.499 1.064 0.885 0.784 0.719 0.674 0.640 0.614 0.594
4.0 4.621 2.997 2.128 1.770 1.569 1.439 1.348 1.280 1.229 1.188
6.0 6.931 4.496 3.192 2.656 2.353 2.158 2.022 1.921 1.843 1.781
8.0 9.242 5.995 4.256 3.541 3.138 2.878 2.695 2.561 2.457 2.375
10.0 11.552 7.494 5.320 4.426 3.922 3.597 3.369 3.201 3.072 2.969
IAC SHORT INVERSE
0.5 0.072 0.047 0.035 0.031 0.028 0.027 0.026 0.026 0.025 0.025
1.0 0.143 0.095 0.070 0.061 0.057 0.054 0.052 0.051 0.050 0.049
2.0 0.286 0.190 0.140 0.123 0.114 0.108 0.105 0.102 0.100 0.099
4.0 0.573 0.379 0.279 0.245 0.228 0.217 0.210 0.204 0.200 0.197
6.0 0.859 0.569 0.419 0.368 0.341 0.325 0.314 0.307 0.301 0.296
8.0 1.145 0.759 0.559 0.490 0.455 0.434 0.419 0.409 0.401 0.394
10.0 1.431 0.948 0.699 0.613 0.569 0.542 0.524 0.511 0.501 0.493
I2t CURVES:
The curves for the I2t are derived from the formulae:
100 100
-------------------------- ----------------------------
T = TDM × ⎛ ---------------
I ⎞ 2 , T RESET = TDM × ⎛ I ⎞ – 2
- ---------------- (EQ 5.13)
⎝ I pickup ⎠ ⎝ I pickup ⎠
where: T = Operate Time (sec.); TDM = Multiplier Setting; I = Input Current; Ipickup = Pickup Current Setting;
TRESET = Reset Time in sec. (assuming energy capacity is 100% and RESET: Timed)
FLEXCURVES™:
The custom FlexCurves™ are described in detail in the FlexCurves™ section of this chapter. The curve shapes for the
FlexCurves™ are derived from the formulae:
5
T = TDM × FlexCurve Time at ⎛⎝ ----------------⎞⎠ when ⎛⎝ ----------------⎞⎠ ≥ 1.00
I I
(EQ 5.14)
I pickup I pickup
The phase time overcurrent element can provide a desired time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied current or
be used as a simple Definite Time element. The phase current input quantities may be programmed as fundamental phasor
magnitude or total waveform RMS magnitude as required by the application.
Two methods of resetting operation are available: “Timed” and “Instantaneous” (refer to the Inverse TOC Curves Character-
istic sub-section earlier for details on curve setup, trip times and reset operation). When the element is blocked, the time
accumulator will reset according to the reset characteristic. For example, if the element reset characteristic is set to “Instan-
taneous” and the element is blocked, the time accumulator will be cleared immediately.
The PHASE TOC1 PICKUP setting can be dynamically reduced by a voltage restraint feature (when enabled). This is accom-
plished via the multipliers (Mvr) corresponding to the phase-phase voltages of the voltage restraint characteristic curve (see
the figure below); the pickup level is calculated as ‘Mvr’ times the PHASE TOC1 PICKUP setting. If the voltage restraint feature
is disabled, the pickup level always remains at the setting value.
0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1.0
Phase-Phase Voltage ÷ VT Nominal Phase-phase Voltage
818784A4.CDR
SETTING
PHASE TOC1
FUNCTION:
Disabled=0
Enabled=1
SETTING
PHASE TOC1
BLOCK-A :
Off=0
SETTING
PHASE TOC1
BLOCK-B:
5
Off=0
SETTING
SETTING
PHASE TOC1
PHASE TOC1 INPUT:
BLOCK-C:
PHASE TOC1
Off=0 PICKUP:
PHASE TOC1
SETTING CURVE:
PHASE TOC1 PHASE TOC1
SOURCE: TD MULTIPLIER:
IA
PHASE TOC1
IB RESET: FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
IC AND RUN PHASE TOC1 A PKP
IA PICKUP
Seq=ABC Seq=ACB PHASE TOC1 A DPO
MULTIPLY INPUTS
RUN
t PHASE TOC1 A OP
VAB VAC Set
Calculate Multiplier Set Pickup AND RUN PHASE TOC1 B PKP
RUN
Multiplier-Phase A IB PICKUP
Set PHASE TOC1 B DPO
VBC VBA Set Pickup
Calculate Multiplier t PHASE TOC1 B OP
RUN
Multiplier-Phase B
Set AND RUN PHASE TOC1 C PKP
VCA VCB IC PICKUP
Calculate Multiplier Set Pickup PHASE TOC1 C DPO
Multiplier-Phase C
t PHASE TOC1 C OP
SETTING OR PHASE TOC1 PKP
PHASE TOC1 VOLT
RESTRAINT: OR PHASE TOC1 OP
Enabled
827072A4.CDR
SETTING
827033A6.VSD
PHASE IOC1
BLOCK-C:
Off = 0
Phase Directional 1 target messages not used with the current version of the T60 relay. As a result, the Tar-
get settings, for phase directional only, are not applicable.
NOTE 5
The phase directional elements (one for each of phases A, B, and C) determine the phase current flow direction for steady
state and fault conditions and can be used to control the operation of the phase overcurrent elements via the BLOCK inputs
of these elements.
S
UT 0
TP
OU
–90°
VPol
VAG(Faulted) IA
ECA
set at 30°
VBC
VBC
VCG VBG +90°
This element is intended to apply a block signal to an overcurrent element to prevent an operation when current is flowing
in a particular direction. The direction of current flow is determined by measuring the phase angle between the current from
the phase CTs and the line-line voltage from the VTs, based on the 90° or "quadrature" connection. If there is a requirement
to supervise overcurrent elements for flows in opposite directions, such as can happen through a bus-tie breaker, two
phase directional elements should be programmed with opposite ECA settings.
To increase security for three phase faults very close to the VTs used to measure the polarizing voltage, a ‘voltage memory’
feature is incorporated. This feature stores the polarizing voltage the moment before the voltage collapses, and uses it to
determine direction. The voltage memory remains valid for one second after the voltage has collapsed.
The main component of the phase directional element is the phase angle comparator with two inputs: the operating signal
(phase current) and the polarizing signal (the line voltage, shifted in the leading direction by the characteristic angle, ECA).
The following table shows the operating and polarizing signals used for phase directional control:
PHASE OPERATING POLARIZING SIGNAL Vpol
SIGNAL
ABC PHASE SEQUENCE ACB PHASE SEQUENCE
A Angle of IA Angle of VBC × (1∠ECA) Angle of VCB × (1∠ECA)
B Angle of IB Angle of VCA × (1∠ECA) Angle of VAC × 1∠ECA)
C Angle of IC Angle of VAB × (1∠ECA) Angle of VBA × (1∠ECA)
MODE OF OPERATION:
• When the function is "Disabled", or the operating current is below 5% × CT Nominal, the element output is "0".
• When the function is "Enabled", the operating current is above 5% × CT Nominal, and the polarizing voltage is above
the set threshold, the element output is dependent on the phase angle between the operating and polarizing signals:
– The element output is logic “0” when the operating current is within polarizing voltage ±90°.
5 – For all other angles, the element output is logic “1”.
• Once the voltage memory has expired, the phase overcurrent elements under directional control can be set to block or
trip on overcurrent as follows: when BLOCK WHEN V MEM EXP is set to “Yes”, the directional element will block the oper-
ation of any phase overcurrent element under directional control when voltage memory expires. When set to “No”, the
directional element allows tripping of Phase OC elements under directional control when voltage memory expires.
In all cases, directional blocking will be permitted to resume when the polarizing voltage becomes greater than the "polariz-
ing voltage threshold".
SETTINGS:
• PHASE DIR 1 SIGNAL SOURCE: This setting is used to select the source for the operating and polarizing signals.
The operating current for the phase directional element is the phase current for the selected current source. The polar-
izing voltage is the line voltage from the phase VTs, based on the 90° or “quadrature” connection and shifted in the
leading direction by the Element Characteristic Angle (ECA).
• PHASE DIR 1 ECA: This setting is used to select the Element Characteristic Angle, i.e. the angle by which the polariz-
ing voltage is shifted in the leading direction to achieve dependable operation. In the design of UR elements, a block is
applied to an element by asserting logic 1 at the blocking input. This element should be programmed via the ECA set-
ting so that the output is logic 1 for current in the non-tripping direction.
• PHASE DIR 1 POL V THRESHOLD: This setting is used to establish the minimum level of voltage for which the phase
angle measurement is reliable. The setting is based on VT accuracy. The default value is "0.700 pu".
• PHASE DIR 1 BLOCK WHEN V MEM EXP: This setting is used to select the required operation upon expiration of
voltage memory. When set to "Yes", the directional element blocks the operation of any phase overcurrent element
under directional control, when voltage memory expires; when set to "No", the directional element allows tripping of
phase overcurrent elements under directional control.
The Phase Directional element responds to the forward load current. In the case of a following reverse
fault, the element needs some time – in the order of 8 msec – to establish a blocking signal. Some protec-
NOTE
tion elements such as instantaneous overcurrent may respond to reverse faults before the blocking signal
is established. Therefore, a coordination time of at least 10 msec must be added to all the instantaneous
protection elements under the supervision of the Phase Directional element. If current reversal is of a con-
cern, a longer delay – in the order of 20 msec – may be needed.
SETTING
PHASE DIR 1
FUNCTION:
Disabled=0
Enabled=1
SETTING
AND
PHASE DIR 1
BLOCK:
Off=0
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PHASE B LOGIC SIMILAR TO PHASE A PH DIR1 BLK B
5
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
PHASE C LOGIC SIMILAR TO PHASE A PH DIR1 BLK C
827078A6.CDR
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) NEUTRAL CURRENT
NEUTRAL TOC6
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL IOC1
MESSAGE See page 5–95.
NEUTRAL IOC8
MESSAGE
NEUTRAL
MESSAGE See page 5–96.
DIRECTIONAL OC1
The T60 relay contains six Neutral Time Overcurrent elements, eight Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent elements, and one
Neutral Directional Overcurrent element. For additional information on the Neutral Time Overcurrent curves, refer to
Inverse TOC Characteristics on page 5–83.
The Neutral Time Overcurrent element can provide a desired time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied current
or be used as a simple Definite Time element. The neutral current input value is a quantity calculated as 3Io from the phase
currents and may be programmed as fundamental phasor magnitude or total waveform RMS magnitude as required by the
application.
Two methods of resetting operation are available: “Timed” and “Instantaneous” (refer to the Inverse TOC Curve Character-
istics section for details on curve setup, trip times and reset operation). When the element is blocked, the time accumulator
will reset according to the reset characteristic. For example, if the element reset characteristic is set to “Instantaneous” and
the element is blocked, the time accumulator will be cleared immediately.
SETTINGS
NEUTRAL TOC1
SETTING INPUT:
NEUTRAL TOC1 NEUTRAL TOC1
FUNCTION: PICKUP:
Disabled = 0 NEUTRAL TOC1
Enabled = 1 CURVE:
NEUTRAL TOC1
TD MULTIPLIER:
NEUTRAL TOC 1 FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETTING
RESET: NEUTRAL TOC1 PKP
NEUTRAL TOC1
AND RUN IN ≥ PICKUP NEUTRAL TOC1 DPO
SOURCE:
NEUTRAL TOC1 OP
IN t
I
SETTING
NEUTRAL TOC1
BLOCK:
Off = 0 827034A3.VSD
The Neutral Instantaneous Overcurrent element may be used as an instantaneous function with no intentional delay or as a
Definite Time function. The element essentially responds to the magnitude of a neutral current fundamental frequency pha-
sor calculated from the phase currents. A “positive-sequence restraint” is applied for better performance. A small portion 5
(6.25%) of the positive-sequence current magnitude is subtracted from the zero-sequence current magnitude when forming
the operating quantity of the element as follows:
I op = 3 × ( I_0 – K ⋅ I_1 ) where K = 1 ⁄ 16 (EQ 5.18)
The positive-sequence restraint allows for more sensitive settings by counterbalancing spurious zero-sequence currents
resulting from:
• system unbalances under heavy load conditions
• transformation errors of current transformers (CTs) during double-line and three-phase faults
• switch-off transients during double-line and three-phase faults
The positive-sequence restraint must be considered when testing for pickup accuracy and response time (multiple of
pickup). The operating quantity depends on how test currents are injected into the relay (single-phase injection:
I op = 0.9375 ⋅ I injected ; three-phase pure zero-sequence injection: I op = 3 × I injected ).
SETTING
Off=0
SETTING
There are two Neutral Directional Overcurrent protection elements available. The element provides both forward and
reverse fault direction indications the NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD and NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV operands, respectively. The output
operand is asserted if the magnitude of the operating current is above a pickup level (overcurrent unit) and the fault direc-
tion is seen as “forward or “reverse”, respectively (directional unit).
The overcurrent unit responds to the magnitude of a fundamental frequency phasor of the either the neutral current calcu-
lated from the phase currents or the ground current. There are two separate pickup settings for the forward- and reverse-
looking functions, respectively. If set to use the calculated 3I_0, the element applies a “positive-sequence restraint” for bet-
ter performance: a small portion (6.25%) of the positive–sequence current magnitude is subtracted from the zero-sequence
current magnitude when forming the operating quantity.
I op = 3 × ( I_0 – K × I_1 ) where K = 1 ⁄ 16 (EQ 5.19)
The positive-sequence restraint allows for more sensitive settings by counterbalancing spurious zero-sequence currents
resulting from:
• System unbalances under heavy load conditions.
• Transformation errors of Current Transformers (CTs) during double-line and three-phase faults.
• Switch-off transients during double-line and three-phase faults.
The positive-sequence restraint must be considered when testing for pickup accuracy and response time (multiple of
pickup). The operating quantity depends on the way the test currents are injected into the relay (single-phase injection:
Iop = 0.9375 × Iinjected ; three-phase pure zero-sequence injection: Iop = 3 × Iinjected).
The positive-sequence restraint is removed for low currents. If the positive-sequence current is below 0.8 pu, the restraint is
removed by changing the constant K to zero. This facilitates better response to high-resistance faults when the unbalance
is very small and there is no danger of excessive CT errors as the current is low.
The directional unit uses the zero-sequence current (I_0) or ground current (IG) for fault direction discrimination and may
be programmed to use either zero-sequence voltage ("Calculated V0" or "Measured VX"), ground current (IG), or both for
polarizing. The following tables define the Neutral Directional Overcurrent element.
Table 5–19: QUANTITIES FOR "CALCULATED 3I0" CONFIGURATION
DIRECTIONAL UNIT
OVERCURRENT UNIT
POLARIZING MODE DIRECTION COMPARED PHASORS
Forward –V_0 + Z_offset × I_0 I_0 × 1∠ECA
Voltage
Reverse –V_0 + Z_offset × I_0 –I_0 × 1∠ECA
Forward IG I_0
Current
Reverse IG –I_0
–V_0 + Z_offset × I_0 I_0 × 1∠ECA Iop = 3 × (|I_0| – K × |I_1|) if |I1| > 0.8 pu
Forward or Iop = 3 × (|I_0|) if |I1| ≤ 0.8 pu
IG I_0
Dual
–V_0 + Z_offset × I_0 –I_0 × 1∠ECA
Reverse or
IG –I_0
1
where: V_0 = --- ( VAG + VBG + VCG ) = zero sequence voltage ,
3
1 1
I_0 = --- IN = --- ( IA + IB + IC ) = zero sequence current ,
3 3
ECA = element characteristic angle and IG = ground current
When NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POL VOLT is set to “Measured VX”, one-third of this voltage is used in place of V_0. The following
figure explains the usage of the voltage polarized directional unit of the element.
The figure below shows the voltage-polarized phase angle comparator characteristics for a Phase A to ground fault, with:
ECA = 90° (Element Characteristic Angle = centerline of operating characteristic)
FWD LA = 80° (Forward Limit Angle = the ± angular limit with the ECA for operation)
REV LA = 80° (Reverse Limit Angle = the ± angular limit with the ECA for operation)
The element incorporates a current reversal logic: if the reverse direction is indicated for at least 1.25 of a power system
cycle, the prospective forward indication will be delayed by 1.5 of a power system cycle. The element is designed to emu-
late an electromechanical directional device. Larger operating and polarizing signals will result in faster directional discrimi-
nation bringing more security to the element operation.
The forward-looking function is designed to be more secure as compared to the reverse-looking function, and therefore,
should be used for the tripping direction. The reverse-looking function is designed to be faster as compared to the forward-
looking function and should be used for the blocking direction. This allows for better protection coordination.
The above bias should be taken into account when using the Neutral Directional Overcurrent element to directionalize other
protection elements.
REV LA FWD LA
line –3V_0 line line
VAG
(reference)
LA
LA
3I_0 line
ECA
ECA line
–ECA line
–3I_0 line LA
VCG LA
VBG
FWD LA
REV LA line
3V_0 line
line 827805A1.CDR
5 – If “Voltage” polarizing is selected, the element uses the zero-sequence voltage angle for polarization. The user
can use either the zero-sequence voltage V_0 calculated from the phase voltages, or the zero-sequence voltage
supplied externally as the auxiliary voltage Vx, both from the NEUTRAL DIR OC1 SOURCE.
The calculated V_0 can be used as polarizing voltage only if the voltage transformers are connected in Wye. The
auxiliary voltage can be used as the polarizing voltage provided SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE BANK
AUXILIARY VT CONNECTION is set to "Vn" and the auxiliary voltage is connected to a zero-sequence voltage
source (such as open delta connected secondary of VTs).
The zero-sequence (V_0) or auxiliary voltage (Vx), accordingly, must be higher than 0.02 pu nominal voltage to be
validated as a polarizing signal. If the polarizing signal is invalid, neither forward nor reverse indication is given.
– If “Current” polarizing is selected, the element uses the ground current angle connected externally and configured
under NEUTRAL OC1 SOURCE for polarization. The Ground CT must be connected between the ground and neutral
point of an adequate local source of ground current. The ground current must be higher than 0.05 pu to be vali-
dated as a polarizing signal. If the polarizing signal is not valid, neither forward nor reverse indication is given.
For a choice of current polarizing, it is recommended that the polarizing signal be analyzed to ensure that a known
direction is maintained irrespective of the fault location. For example, if using an autotransformer neutral current
as a polarizing source, it should be ensured that a reversal of the ground current does not occur for a high-side
fault. The low-side system impedance should be assumed minimal when checking for this condition. A similar sit-
uation arises for a Wye/Delta/Wye transformer, where current in one transformer winding neutral may reverse
when faults on both sides of the transformer are considered.
– If "Dual" polarizing is selected, the element performs both directional comparisons as described above. A given
direction is confirmed if either voltage or current comparators indicate so. If a conflicting (simultaneous forward
and reverse) indication occurs, the forward direction overrides the reverse direction.
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POL VOLT: Selects the polarizing voltage used by the directional unit when "Voltage" or "Dual"
polarizing mode is set. The polarizing voltage can be programmed to be either the zero-sequence voltage calculated
from the phase voltages ("Calculated V0") or supplied externally as an auxiliary voltage ("Measured VX").
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 OP CURR: This setting indicates whether the 3I_0 current calculated from the phase currents, or
the ground current shall be used by this protection. This setting acts as a switch between the neutral and ground
modes of operation (67N and 67G). If set to “Calculated 3I0” the element uses the phase currents and applies the pos-
itive-sequence restraint; if set to “Measured IG” the element uses ground current supplied to the ground CT of the CT
bank configured as NEUTRAL DIR OC1 SOURCE. If this setting is “Measured IG”, then the NEUTRAL DIR OC1 POLARIZING
setting must be “Voltage”, as it is not possible to use the ground current as an operating and polarizing signal simulta-
neously.
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 OFFSET: This setting specifies the offset impedance used by this protection. The primary appli-
cation for the offset impedance is to guarantee correct identification of fault direction on series compensated lines. See
the Chapter 9 for information on how to calculate this setting. In regular applications, the offset impedance ensures
proper operation even if the zero-sequence voltage at the relaying point is very small. If this is the intent, the offset
impedance shall not be larger than the zero-sequence impedance of the protected circuit. Practically, it shall be several
times smaller. See Chapter 8 for additional details. The offset impedance shall be entered in secondary ohms.
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD ECA: This setting defines the characteristic angle (ECA) for the forward direction in the
"Voltage" polarizing mode. The "Current" polarizing mode uses a fixed ECA of 0°. The ECA in the reverse direction is
the angle set for the forward direction shifted by 180°.
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD LIMIT ANGLE: This setting defines a symmetrical (in both directions from the ECA) limit
angle for the forward direction.
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD PICKUP: This setting defines the pickup level for the overcurrent unit of the element in the
forward direction. When selecting this setting it must be kept in mind that the design uses a "positive-sequence
restraint" technique for the "Calculated 3I0" mode of operation.
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV LIMIT ANGLE: This setting defines a symmetrical (in both directions from the ECA) limit
angle for the reverse direction.
• NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV PICKUP: This setting defines the pickup level for the overcurrent unit of the element in the
reverse direction. When selecting this setting it must be kept in mind that the design uses a "positive-sequence
restraint" technique for the "Calculated 3I0" mode of operation.
SETTING
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD
PICKUP: 5
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 OP
CURR:
SETTING
RUN
NEUTRAL DIR OC1
FUNCTION: 3( I_0 - K I_1 ) PICKUP
Disabled=0 OR
Enabled=1 IG PICKUP AND
SETTING
AND SETTINGS
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 BLK: AND
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD
ECA:
Off=0
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
LIMIT ANGLE:
SETTING AND NEUTRAL DIR OC1 FWD
NEUTRAL DIR OC1 NEUTRAL DIR OC1 REV
SOURCE: LIMIT ANGLE:
}
Measured VX OR
Calculated V_0 FWD
1.25 cy
}
-3V_0 AND
Zero Seq Crt (I_0) 1.5 cy
Ground Crt (IG) REV
3I_0 REV
Voltage Polarization
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) GROUND CURRENT
GROUND TOC2
MESSAGE
GROUND TOC6
MESSAGE
GROUND IOC1
MESSAGE See page 5–102.
GROUND IOC2
MESSAGE
GROUND IOC8
MESSAGE
RESTRICTED GROUND
MESSAGE See page 5–103.
FAULT 1
5 MESSAGE
RESTRICTED GROUND
See page 5–103.
FAULT 2
RESTRICTED GROUND
MESSAGE See page 5–103.
FAULT 3
RESTRICTED GROUND
MESSAGE See page 5–103.
FAULT 4
The T60 relay contains six Ground Time Overcurrent elements, eight Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent elements, and
four Restricted Ground Fault elements. For additional information on the Ground Time Overcurrent curves, refer to Inverse
TOC Characteristics on page 5–83.
This element can provide a desired time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied current or be used as a simple
Definite Time element. The ground current input value is the quantity measured by the ground input CT and is the funda-
mental phasor or RMS magnitude. Two methods of resetting operation are available; “Timed” and “Instantaneous” (refer to
the Inverse TOC Characteristics section for details). When the element is blocked, the time accumulator will reset accord-
ing to the reset characteristic. For example, if the element reset characteristic is set to “Instantaneous” and the element is
blocked, the time accumulator will be cleared immediately.
These elements measure the current that is connected to the ground channel of a CT/VT module. This channel
may be equipped with a standard or sensitive input. The conversion range of a standard channel is from 0.02 to 46
NOTE
times the CT rating. The conversion range of a sensitive channel is from 0.002 to 4.6 times the CT rating.
SETTINGS
GROUND TOC1
SETTING INPUT:
GROUND TOC1 GROUND TOC1
FUNCTION: PICKUP:
Disabled = 0 GROUND TOC1
Enabled = 1 CURVE:
GROUND TOC1
TD MULTIPLIER:
GROUND TOC 1 FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETTING
RESET: GROUND TOC1 PKP
GROUND TOC1
AND RUN IG ≥ PICKUP GROUND TOC1 DPO
SOURCE:
GROUND TOC1 OP
IG t
I
SETTING
GROUND TOC1
BLOCK:
827036A3.VSD
Off = 0
The Ground IOC element may be used as an instantaneous element with no intentional delay or as a Definite Time ele-
ment. The ground current input is the quantity measured by the ground input CT and is the fundamental phasor magnitude.
5 FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETTING GROUND IOC1 PKP
GROUND IOC1
GROUND IOIC DPO
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0 SETTINGS GROUND IOC1 OP
WINDING
35%
842731A1.CDR
This protection is often applied to transformers having impedance-grounded Wye windings. The element may also be
applied to the stator winding of a generator having the neutral point grounded with a CT installed in the grounding path, or
the ground current obtained by external summation of the neutral-side stator CTs. The Typical Applications of RGF Protec-
tion diagram explains the basic application and wiring rules.
IB IB
IC IC
IG IG
IB
5 IB
IC
IC
IG IA IB IC
IG
2 2 2
842732A1.CDR
The relay automatically matches the CT ratios between the phase and ground CTs by re-scaling the ground CT to the
phase CT level. The restraining signal ensures stability of protection during CT saturation conditions and is produced as a
maximum value between three components related to zero, negative, and positive-sequence currents of the three phase
CTs as follows:
Irest = max ( IR0, IR1, IR2 ) (EQ 5.21)
The zero-sequence component of the restraining signal (IR0) is meant to provide maximum restraint during external ground
faults, and therefore is calculated as a vectorial difference of the ground and neutral currents:
The equation above brings an advantage of generating the restraining signal of twice the external ground fault current,
while reducing the restraint below the internal ground fault current. The negative-sequence component of the restraining
signal (IR2) is meant to provide maximum restraint during external phase-to-phase faults and is calculated as follows:
IR2 = I_2 or IR2 = 3 × I_2 (EQ 5.23)
The multiplier of 1 is used by the relay for first two cycles following complete de-energization of the winding (all three phase
currents below 5% of nominal for at least five cycles). The multiplier of 3 is used during normal operation; that is, two cycles
after the winding has been energized. The lower multiplier is used to ensure better sensitivity when energizing a faulty
winding.
The positive-sequence component of the restraining signal (IR1) is meant to provide restraint during symmetrical condi-
tions, either symmetrical faults or load, and is calculated according to the following algorithm:
1 If I_1 > 1.5 pu of phase CT, then
2 If I_1 > I_0 , then IR1 = 3 × ( I_1 – I_0 )
3 else IR1 = 0
4 else IR1 = I_1 ⁄ 8
Under load-level currents (below 150% of nominal), the positive-sequence restraint is set to 1/8th of the positive-sequence
current (Line 4). This is to ensure maximum sensitivity during low-current faults under full load conditions. Under fault-level
currents (above 150% of nominal), the positive-sequence restraint is removed if the zero-sequence component is greater
than the positive-sequence (Line 3), or set at the net difference of the two (Line 2).
The raw restraining signal (Irest) is further post-filtered for better performance during external faults with heavy CT satura-
tion and for better switch-off transient control:
Igr ( k ) = max ( Irest ( k ), α × Igr ( k – 1 ) ) (EQ 5.24) 5
where k represents a present sample, k – 1 represents the previous sample, and α is a factory constant (α < 1). The equa-
tion above introduces a decaying memory to the restraining signal. Should the raw restraining signal (Irest) disappear or
drop significantly, such as when an external fault gets cleared or a CT saturates heavily, the actual restraining signal (Igr(k))
will not reduce instantly but will keep decaying decreasing its value by 50% each 15.5 power system cycles.
Having the differential and restraining signals developed, the element applies a single slope differential characteristic with a
minimum pickup as shown in the Restricted Ground Fault Scheme Logic diagram.
SETTING
RESTD GND FT1
FUNCTION:
Disabled=0
SETTING
Enabled=1
RESTD GND FT1
PICKUP: SETTINGS
SETTING
AND RUN RESTD GND FT1 PICKUP
RESTD GND FT1 Igd > PICKUP DELAY:
BLOCK: FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
RESTD GND FT1 RESET
Off=0 RESTD GND FT1 PKP
DELAY:
SETTING RESTD GND FT1 DPO
t PKP
SETTING AND t RST RESTD GND FT1 OP
RESTD GND FT1
RESTD GND FT1 SLOPE:
SOURCE: RUN
IG
IN Differential Igd > SLOPE * Igr
and
I_0
Restraining
I_1 Currents
I_2
ACTUAL VALUES
RGF 1 Igd Mag
RGF 1 Igr Mag 828002A2.CDR
The following examples explain how the restraining signal is created for maximum sensitivity and security. These examples
clarify the operating principle and provide guidance for testing of the element.
EXAMPLE 1: EXTERNAL SINGLE-LINE-TO-GROUND FAULT
Given the following inputs: IA = 1 pu ∠0°, IB = 0, IC = 0, and IG = 1 pu ∠180°
The relay calculates the following values:
1⁄3
Igd = 0, IR0 = abs ⎛ 3 × --- – ( – 1 )⎞ = 2 pu , IR2 = 3 × --- = 1 pu , IR1 = ---------- = 0.042 pu , and Igr = 2 pu
1 1
⎝ 3 ⎠ 3 8
The restraining signal is twice the fault current. This gives extra margin should the phase or neutral CT saturate.
EXAMPLE 2: EXTERNAL HIGH-CURRENT SLG FAULT
Given the following inputs: IA = 10 pu ∠0°, IB = 0, IC = 0, and IG = 10 pu ∠–180°
The relay calculates the following values:
Igd = 0, IR0 = abs ⎛ 3 × --- – ( – 10 )⎞ = 20 pu , IR2 = 3 × ------ = 10 pu , IR1 = 3 × ⎛ 10 ------⎞⎠ = 0 , and Igr = 20 pu.
1 10
- – 10
⎝ 3 ⎠ 3 ⎝ -----
3 3
a) MAIN MENU
PATH: SETTINGS GROUPED ELEMENTS SETTING GROUP 1(6) VOLTAGE ELEMENTS
AUXILIARY UV1
MESSAGE See page 5–111.
AUXILIARY OV1
MESSAGE See page 5–112.
VOLTS/HZ 1
MESSAGE See page 5–113.
VOLTS/HZ 2
MESSAGE See page 5–113.
These protection elements can be used for a variety of applications such as: 5
Undervoltage Protection: For voltage sensitive loads, such as induction motors, a drop in voltage increases the drawn
current which may cause dangerous overheating in the motor. The undervoltage protection feature can be used to either
cause a trip or generate an alarm when the voltage drops below a specified voltage setting for a specified time delay.
Permissive Functions: The undervoltage feature may be used to block the functioning of external devices by operating an
output relay when the voltage falls below the specified voltage setting. The undervoltage feature may also be used to block
the functioning of other elements through the block feature of those elements.
Source Transfer Schemes: In the event of an undervoltage, a transfer signal may be generated to transfer a load from its
normal source to a standby or emergency power source.
The undervoltage elements can be programmed to have a Definite Time delay characteristic. The Definite Time curve oper-
ates when the voltage drops below the pickup level for a specified period of time. The time delay is adjustable from 0 to
600.00 seconds in steps of 10 ms. The undervoltage elements can also be programmed to have an inverse time delay
characteristic. The undervoltage delay setting defines the family of curves shown below.
D=5.0 2.0 1.0
D 20.0
T = ---------------------------------
-
⎛ 1 – ------------------
V ⎞ 18.0
⎝ V pickup⎠ 16.0
14.0
Time (seconds)
This element may be used to give a desired time-delay operating characteristic versus the applied fundamental voltage
(phase-to-ground or phase-to-phase for Wye VT connection, or phase-to-phase for Delta VT connection) or as a Definite
Time element. The element resets instantaneously if the applied voltage exceeds the dropout voltage. The delay setting
selects the minimum operating time of the phase undervoltage. The minimum voltage setting selects the operating voltage
below which the element is blocked (a setting of “0” will allow a dead source to be considered a fault condition).
SETTING SETTING
PHASE UV1 PHASE UV1
FUNCTION: PICKUP:
Disabled = 0 PHASE UV1
Enabled = 1 CURVE:
PHASE UV1
SETTING DELAY: FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
AND
PHASE UV1 AND RUN VAG or VAB < PICKUP PHASE UV1 A PKP
BLOCK: t PHASE UV1 A DPO
Off = 0 PHASE UV1 A OP
V
SETTING
SETTING AND RUN VBG or VBC< PICKUP PHASE UV1 B PKP
}
PHASE UV1
t PHASE UV1 B DPO
PHASE UV1 SOURCE: MINIMUM VOLTAGE:
PHASE UV1 B OP
VAG or VAB < Minimum
Source VT = Delta V
VBG or VBC < Minimum
VAB AND RUN VCG or VCA < PICKUP PHASE UV1 C PKP
VCG or VCA < Minimum
VBC t PHASE UV1 C DPO
VCA PHASE UV1 C OP
Source VT = Wye V
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
SETTING OR PHASE UV1 PKP
827039AB.CDR
The phase overvoltage element may be used as an instantaneous element with no intentional time delay or as a Definite
Time element. The input voltage is the phase-to-phase voltage, either measured directly from Delta-connected VTs or as
calculated from phase-to-ground (Wye) connected VTs. The specific voltages to be used for each phase are shown below. 5
SETTING
PHASE OV1
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
Enabled = 1
SETTING SETTING
PHASE OV1 PHASE OV1
BLOCK: PICKUP:
Off = 0 PHASE OV1
CURVE:
PHASE OV1
DELAY:
RUN VAG or VAB < PICKUP
AND t
V
RUN VBG or VBC < PICKUP
t
}
SETTING RUN VCG or VCA < PICKUP
t
PHASE OV1 SOURCE:
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Source VT = Delta V PHASE OV1 A PKP
VAB PHASE OV1 A DPO
VBC PHASE OV1 A OP
VCA
Source VT = Wye PHASE OV1 B PKP
PHASE OV1 B DPO
PHASE OV1 B OP
SETTING
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
OR PHASE OV1 OP
FLEXLOGIC OPERAND
AND PHASE OV1 DPO
827066A5.CDR
The Neutral Overvoltage element can be used to detect asymmetrical system voltage condition due to a ground fault or to
the loss of one or two phases of the source. The element responds to the system neutral voltage (3V_0), calculated from
5 the phase voltages. The nominal secondary voltage of the phase voltage channels entered under SETTINGS SYSTEM
SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE BANK PHASE VT SECONDARY is the p.u. base used when setting the pickup level.
VT errors and normal voltage unbalance must be considered when setting this element. This function requires the VTs to
be Wye connected.
SETTING
NEUTRAL OV1
FUNCTION:
Disabled=0
SETTING
Enabled=1
NEUTRAL OV1 PICKUP: SETTING
SETTING
AND RUN NEUTRAL OV1 PICKUP
DELAY :
NEUTRAL OV1 BLOCK:
NEUTRAL OV1 RESET
Off=0 DELAY :
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
3V_0 < Pickup tPKP
SETTING tRST NEUTRAL OV1 OP
NEUTRAL OV1 DPO
NEUTRAL OV1 SIGNAL
SOURCE: NEUTRAL OV1 PKP
ZERO SEQ VOLT (V_0)
827848A1.CDR
SETTING
AUX UV1
FUNCTION: SETTING
Disabled=0
AUX UV1 PICKUP:
Enabled=1
827849A2.CDR
This element is intended for monitoring overvoltage conditions of the auxiliary voltage. A typical application for this element
is monitoring the zero-sequence voltage (3V_0) supplied from an open-corner-delta VT connection. The nominal secondary
5 voltage of the auxiliary voltage channel entered under SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE BANK X5 AUXILIARY VT
X5 SECONDARY is the p.u. base used when setting the pickup level.
SETTING
AUX OV1
FUNCTION:
Disabled=0
SETTING
Enabled=1
AUX OV1 PICKUP: SETTING
SETTING
AND RUN AUX OV1 PICKUP
DELAY :
AUX OV1 BLOCK:
AUX OV1 RESET
Off=0 DELAY :
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
Vx < Pickup tPKP
SETTING tRST AUX OV1 OP
AUX OV1 DPO
AUX OV1 SIGNAL
SOURCE: AUX OV1 PKP
AUXILIARY VOLT (Vx)
827836A2.CDR
2. When the auxiliary voltage Vx is used (regarding the condition for “None” phase voltage setting mentioned above),
then the 1 pu value is the SYSTEM SETUP AC INPUTS VOLTAGE BANK N AUXILIARY VT N SECONDARY setting
divided by the SYSTEM SETUP POWER SYSTEM NOMINAL FREQUENCY setting.
3. If V/Hz source is configured with both phase and auxiliary voltages, the maximum phase among the three voltage
channels at any given point in time is the input voltage signal for element operation, and therefore the per-unit value
will be calculated as described in Step 1 above. If the measured voltage of all three phase voltages is 0, than the per-
unit value becomes automatically 0 regardless of the presence of auxiliary voltage.
SETTINGS
VOLTS / HZ 1
PICKUP:
SETTING
VOLTS / HZ 1
VOLTS/HZ 1 CURVE:
FUNCTION:
VOLTS / HZ 1
Disabled = 0
TD MULTIPLIER:
Enabled = 1
VOLTS / HZ 1
FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
T-RESET:
SETTING
AND RUN VOLTS PER HERTZ 1 PKP
VOLTS/HZ 1 BLOCK:
t VOLTS PER HERTZ 1 DPO
Off = 0
The element has a linear reset characteristic. The reset time can be programmed to match the cooling characteristics of the
protected equipment. The element will fully reset from the trip threshold in VOLTS/HZ T-RESET seconds. The V/Hz element
may be used as an instantaneous element with no intentional time delay or as a Definite or Inverse timed element.
The characteristics of the inverse curves are shown below.
• DEFINITE TIME: T(sec.) = TD Multiplier. For example, setting the TD Multiplier set to 20 means a time delay of 20 sec-
onds to operate, when above the Volts/Hz pickup setting. Instantaneous operation can be obtained the same way by
setting the TD Multiplier to “0”.
• INVERSE CURVE A: 1000
TDM
- when V
---- > Pickup
⎛ ----⎞ ⁄ Pickup – 1
V F 10
Delay
Setting
⎝ F⎠ 10
0.01
1.00 1.20 1.40 1.60 1.80 2.00
Multiples of Volts/Hertz Pickup
• INVERSE CURVE B:
TDM V
T = ---------------------------------------------- when ---- > Pickup
100
(EQ 5.26)
F
Time To Trip (seconds)
⎛V ⎞ Time
⎝ F⎠ ⁄ Pickup – 1
---- Delay
Setting
10 10
where: T = Operating Time
TDM = Time Delay Multiplier (delay in sec.) 3
0.1
0.1
1.00 1.20 1.40 1.60 1.80 2.00
Multiples of Volts/Hertz Pickup
• INVERSE CURVE C:
10000
The curve for the Volts/Hertz Inverse Curve C shape is
derived from the formula:
1000
TDM - when V
---- > Pickup
T = ----------------------------------------------------
0.5
(EQ 5.27)
⎛V ⎞ F
---- ⁄ Pickup
Time To Trip (seconds)
–1
⎝ F⎠ 100
Time
Delay
Setting
0.1
0.1
1.00 1.20 1.40 1.60 1.80 2.00
Multiples of Voltz/Hertz Pickup
Control elements are generally used for control rather than protection. See the Introduction to Elements section at the
beginning of this chapter for further information.
The Setting Groups menu controls the activation/deactivation of up to six possible groups of settings in the GROUPED ELE-
settings menu. The faceplate ‘Settings in Use’ LEDs indicate which active group (with a non-flashing energized
MENTS
LED) is in service. 5
The SETTING GROUPS BLK setting prevents the active setting group from changing when the FlexLogic™ parameter is set to
"On". This can be useful in applications where it is undesirable to change the settings under certain conditions, such as the
breaker being open.
Each GROUP n ACTIVATE ON setting selects a FlexLogic™ operand which, when set, will make the particular setting group
active for use by any grouped element. A priority scheme ensures that only one group is active at a given time – the high-
est-numbered group which is activated by its GROUP n ACTIVATE ON parameter takes priority over the lower-numbered
groups. There is no “activate on” setting for Group 1 (the default active group), because Group 1 automatically becomes
active if no other group is active.
The relay can be set up via a FlexLogic™ equation to receive requests to activate or de-activate a particular non-default
settings group. The following FlexLogic™ equation (see the figure below) illustrates requests via remote communications
(e.g. VIRTUAL INPUT 1) or from a local contact input (e.g. H7a) to initiate the use of a particular settings group, and requests
from several overcurrent pickup measuring elements to inhibit the use of the particular settings group. The assigned VIR-
TUAL OUTPUT 1 operand is used to control the “On” state of a particular settings group.
5 MESSAGE
Off
SELECTOR 1 3BIT Range: Time-out, Acknowledge
MESSAGE
MODE: Time-out
SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK: Range: FlexLogic™ operand
MESSAGE
Off
SELECTOR 1 POWER-UP Range: Restore, Synchronize, Synch/Restore
MESSAGE
MODE: Restore
SELECTOR 1 TARGETS: Range: Self-reset, Latched, Disabled
MESSAGE
Self-reset
SELECTOR 1 EVENTS: Range: Disabled, Enabled
MESSAGE
Disabled
The Selector Switch element is intended to replace a mechanical selector switch. Typical applications include setting group
control or control of multiple logic sub-circuits in user-programmable logic.
The element provides for two control inputs. The step-up control allows stepping through selector position one step at a
time with each pulse of the control input, such as a user-programmable pushbutton. The 3-bit control input allows setting
the selector to the position defined by a 3-bit word.
The element allows pre-selecting a new position without applying it. The pre-selected position gets applied either after time-
out or upon acknowledgement via separate inputs (user setting). The selector position is stored in non-volatile memory.
Upon power-up, either the previous position is restored or the relay synchronizes to the current 3-bit word (user setting).
Basic alarm functionality alerts the user under abnormal conditions; e.g. the 3-bit control input being out of range.
• SELECTOR 1 FULL RANGE: This setting defines the upper position of the selector. When stepping up through avail-
able positions of the selector, the upper position wraps up to the lower position (Position 1). When using a direct 3-bit
control word for programming the selector to a desired position, the change would take place only if the control word is
within the range of 1 to the SELECTOR FULL RANGE. If the control word is outside the range, an alarm is established by
setting the SELECTOR ALARM FlexLogic™ operand for 3 seconds.
• SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT: This setting defines the time-out period for the selector. This value is used by the relay in
the following two ways. When the SELECTOR STEP-UP MODE is “Time-out”, the setting specifies the required period of
inactivity of the control input after which the pre-selected position is automatically applied. When the SELECTOR STEP-
UP MODE is “Acknowledge”, the setting specifies the period of time for the acknowledging input to appear. The timer is
re-started by any activity of the control input. The acknowledging input must come before the SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT
timer expires; otherwise, the change will not take place and an alarm will be set.
• SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP: This setting specifies a control input for the selector switch. The switch is shifted to a new
position at each rising edge of this signal. The position changes incrementally, wrapping up from the last (SELECTOR 1
FULL RANGE) to the first (Position 1). Consecutive pulses of this control operand must not occur faster than every
50 ms. After each rising edge of the assigned operand, the time-out timer is restarted and the SELECTOR SWITCH 1:
POS Z CHNG INITIATED target message is displayed, where Z the pre-selected position. The message is displayed for
the time specified by the FLASH MESSAGE TIME setting. The pre-selected position is applied after the selector times out
(“Time-out” mode), or when the acknowledging signal appears before the element times out (“Acknowledge” mode).
When the new position is applied, the relay displays the SELECTOR SWITCH 1: POSITION Z IN USE message. Typically,
a user-programmable pushbutton is configured as the stepping up control input.
• SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP MODE: This setting defines the selector mode of operation. When set to “Time-out”, the
selector will change its position after a pre-defined period of inactivity at the control input. The change is automatic and
does not require any explicit confirmation of the intent to change the selector's position. When set to “Acknowledge”,
the selector will change its position only after the intent is confirmed through a separate acknowledging signal. If the
acknowledging signal does not appear within a pre-defined period of time, the selector does not accept the change
and an alarm is established by setting the SELECTOR STP ALARM output FlexLogic™ operand for 3 seconds.
• SELECTOR 1 ACK: This setting specifies an acknowledging input for the stepping up control input. The pre-selected
position is applied on the rising edge of the assigned operand. This setting is active only under “Acknowledge” mode of
operation. The acknowledging signal must appear within the time defined by the SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT setting after the
last activity of the control input. A user-programmable pushbutton is typically configured as the acknowledging input.
• SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0, A1, and A2: These settings specify a 3-bit control input of the selector. The 3-bit control word
pre-selects the position using the following encoding convention: 5
A2 A1 A0 POSITION
0 0 0 rest
0 0 1 1
0 1 0 2
0 1 1 3
1 0 0 4
1 0 1 5
1 1 0 6
1 1 1 7
The “rest” position (0, 0, 0) does not generate an action and is intended for situations when the device generating the
3-bit control word is having a problem. When SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE is “Time-out”, the pre-selected position is applied
in SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT seconds after the last activity of the 3-bit input. When SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE is “Acknowl-
edge”, the pre-selected position is applied on the rising edge of the SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK acknowledging input.
The stepping up control input (SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP) and the 3-bit control inputs (SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0 through A2) lock-
out mutually: once the stepping up sequence is initiated, the 3-bit control input is inactive; once the 3-bit control
sequence is initiated, the stepping up input is inactive.
• SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE: This setting defines the selector mode of operation. When set to “Time-out”, the selector
changes its position after a pre-defined period of inactivity at the control input. The change is automatic and does not
require explicit confirmation to change the selector position. When set to “Acknowledge”, the selector changes its posi-
tion only after confirmation via a separate acknowledging signal. If the acknowledging signal does not appear within a
pre-defined period of time, the selector rejects the change and an alarm established by invoking the SELECTOR BIT
ALARM FlexLogic™ operand for 3 seconds.
• SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK: This setting specifies an acknowledging input for the 3-bit control input. The pre-selected
position is applied on the rising edge of the assigned FlexLogic™ operand. This setting is active only under the
“Acknowledge” mode of operation. The acknowledging signal must appear within the time defined by the SELECTOR
TIME-OUT setting after the last activity of the 3-bit control inputs. Note that the stepping up control input and 3-bit control
input have independent acknowledging signals (SELECTOR 1 ACK and SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK, accordingly).
• SELECTOR 1 POWER-UP MODE: This setting specifies the element behavior on power up of the relay.
When set to “Restore”, the last position of the selector (stored in the non-volatile memory) is restored after powering up
the relay. If the position restored from memory is out of range, position 0 (no output operand selected) is applied and
an alarm is set (SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM).
When set to “Synchronize” selector switch acts as follows. For two power cycles, the selector applies position 0 to the
switch and activates SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM. After two power cycles expire, the selector synchronizes to the position
dictated by the 3-bit control input. This operation does not wait for time-out or the acknowledging input. When the syn-
chronization attempt is unsuccessful (i.e., the 3-bit input is not available (0,0,0) or out of range) then the selector switch
output is set to position 0 (no output operand selected) and an alarm is established (SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM).
The operation of “Synch/Restore” mode is similar to the “Synchronize” mode. The only difference is that after an
unsuccessful synchronization attempt, the switch will attempt to restore the position stored in the relay memory. The
“Synch/Restore” mode is useful for applications where the selector switch is employed to change the setting group in
redundant (two relay) protection schemes.
• SELECTOR 1 EVENTS: If enabled, the following events are logged:
The following figures illustrate the operation of the Selector Switch. In these diagrams, “T” represents a time-out setting.
STEP-UP
T T
3BIT A0
3BIT A1
3BIT A2
T T
POS 1
POS 2
POS 3
POS 4
POS 5
POS 6 5
POS 7
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
STP ALARM
BIT ALARM
ALARM
842737A1.CDR
STEP-UP
ACK
3BIT A0
3BIT A1
3BIT A2
3BIT ACK
POS 1
POS 2
POS 3
POS 4
POS 5
POS 6
5 POS 7
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
STP ALARM
BIT ALARM
ALARM
842736A1.CDR
APPLICATION EXAMPLE
Consider an application where the selector switch is used to control Setting Groups 1 through 4 in the relay. The setting
groups are to be controlled from both User-Programmable Pushbutton 1 and from an external device via Contact Inputs 1
through 3. The active setting group shall be available as an encoded 3-bit word to the external device and SCADA via out-
put contacts 1 through 3. The pre-selected setting group shall be applied automatically after 5 seconds of inactivity of the
control inputs. When the relay powers up, it should synchronize the setting group to the 3-bit control input.
Make the following changes to Setting Group Control in the SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS SETTING GROUPS menu:
SETTING GROUPS FUNCTION: “Enabled” GROUP 4 ACTIVATE ON: “SELECTOR 1 POS 4"
SETTING GROUPS BLK: “Off” GROUP 5 ACTIVATE ON: “Off”
GROUP 2 ACTIVATE ON: “SELECTOR 1 POS 2" GROUP 6 ACTIVATE ON: “Off”
GROUP 3 ACTIVATE ON: “SELECTOR 1 POS 3"
Make the following changes to Selector Switch element in the SETTINGS CONTROL ELEMENTS SELECTOR SWITCH
SELECTOR SWITCH 1 menu to assign control to User Programmable Pushbutton 1 and Contact Inputs 1 through 3:
SELECTOR 1 FUNCTION: “Enabled” SELECTOR 1 3BIT A0: “CONT IP 1 ON”
SELECTOR 1 FULL-RANGE: “4” SELECTOR 1 3BIT A1: “CONT IP 2 ON”
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP MODE: “Time-out” SELECTOR 1 3BIT A2: “CONT IP 3 ON”
SELECTOR 1 TIME-OUT: “5.0 s” SELECTOR 1 3BIT MODE: “Time-out”
SELECTOR 1 STEP-UP: “PUSHBUTTON 1 ON” SELECTOR 1 3BIT ACK: “Off”
SELECTOR 1 ACK: “Off” SELECTOR 1 POWER-UP MODE: “Synchronize”
Now, assign the contact output operation (assume the H6E module) to the Selector Switch element by making the following
changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS menu:
SETTINGS
SELECTOR 1 FULL RANGE:
SELECTOR 1 ALARM
SELECTOR 1 PWR ALARM
SELECTOR 1 BIT 0
SELECTOR 1 BIT 1
SELECTOR 1 BIT 2
842012A1.CDR
5.6.4 UNDERFREQUENCY
5 MESSAGE
Disabled
UNDERFREQ 1 FUNCTION:
Disabled=0
Enabled=1
5.6.5 OVERFREQUENCY
SETTING
OVERFREQ 1 FUNCTION:
Disabled=0
SETTING
Enabled=1
OVERFREQ 1 PICKUP : SETTING
SETTING
AND RUN OVERFREQ 1 PICKUP
DELAY :
OVERFREQ 1 BLOCK: FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
OVERFREQ 1 RESET
Off OVERFREQ 1 PKP
DELAY :
OVERFREQ 1 DPO
tPKP
SETTING tRST OVERFREQ 1 OP
f < PICKUP
OVERFREQ 1 SOURCE:
SRC1
Frequency 827832A3.CDR
There are 16 identical Digital Elements available, numbered 1 to 16. A Digital Element can monitor any FlexLogic™ oper-
5 and and present a target message and/or enable events recording depending on the output operand state. The digital ele-
ment settings include a ‘name’ which will be referenced in any target message, a blocking input from any selected
FlexLogic™ operand, and a timer for pickup and reset delays for the output operand.
• DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 INPUT: Selects a FlexLogic™ operand to be monitored by the Digital Element.
• DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 PICKUP DELAY: Sets the time delay to pickup. If a pickup delay is not required, set to "0".
• DIGITAL ELEMENT 1 RESET DELAY: Sets the time delay to reset. If a reset delay is not required, set to “0”.
SETTING
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0 SETTINGS
Enabled = 1 DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
SETTING PICKUP DELAY:
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01 DIGITAL ELEMENT 01 FLEXLOGIC OPERANDS
SETTING
NAME: RESET DELAY:
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01 DIG ELEM 01 DPO
AND RUN tPKP
INPUT: DIG ELEM 01 PKP
Off = 0 DIG ELEM 01 OP
INPUT = 1 tRST
SETTING
DIGITAL ELEMENT 01
BLOCK:
827042A1.VSD
Off = 0
DC+
UR Relay - Form-A
H1a
I = Current Monitor I
H1b
V = Voltage Monitor V
H1c
52a
Trip
Coil
5
827073A1.vsd
DC–
Figure 5–73: TRIP CIRCUIT EXAMPLE 1
Assume the output contact H1 is a trip contact. Using the contact output settings, this output will be given an ID name, e.g.
“Cont Op 1". Assume a 52a breaker auxiliary contact is connected to contact input H7a to monitor breaker status. Using the
contact input settings, this input will be given an ID name, e.g. “Cont Ip 1" and will be set “ON” when the breaker is closed.
Using Digital Element 1 to monitor the breaker trip circuit, the settings will be:
The PICKUP DELAY setting should be greater than the operating time of the breaker to avoid nuisance
alarms.
NOTE
DC+
Table 5–21: VALUES OF RESISTOR ‘R’
UR Relay - Form-A
POWER RESISTANCE POWER
H1a SUPPLY (V DC) (OHMS) (WATTS)
I = Current Monitor I
24 1000 2
H1b
30 5000 2
V = Voltage Monitor V
H1c 48 10000 2
110 25000 5
52a By-pass
R 125 25000 5
Resistor
250 50000 5
Trip
Coil
827074A1.vsd
DC–
Figure 5–74: TRIP CIRCUIT EXAMPLE 2
There are 8 identical digital counters, numbered from 1 to 8. A digital counter counts the number of state transitions from
Logic 0 to Logic 1. The counter is used to count operations such as the pickups of an element, the changes of state of an
external contact (e.g. breaker auxiliary switch), or pulses from a watt-hour meter.
• COUNTER 1 UNITS: Assigns a label to identify the unit of measure pertaining to the digital transitions to be counted.
The units label will appear in the corresponding Actual Values status.
• COUNTER 1 PRESET: Sets the count to a required preset value before counting operations begin, as in the case
where a substitute relay is to be installed in place of an in-service relay, or while the counter is running.
• COUNTER 1 COMPARE: Sets the value to which the accumulated count value is compared. Three FlexLogic™ output
operands are provided to indicate if the present value is ‘more than (HI)’, ‘equal to (EQL)’, or ‘less than (LO)’ the set
value.
• COUNTER 1 UP: Selects the FlexLogic™ operand for incrementing the counter. If an enabled UP input is received
when the accumulated value is at the limit of +2,147,483,647 counts, the counter will rollover to –2,147,483,648.
• COUNTER 1 DOWN: Selects the FlexLogic™ operand for decrementing the counter. If an enabled DOWN input is
received when the accumulated value is at the limit of –2,147,483,648 counts, the counter will rollover to
+2,147,483,647.
• COUNTER 1 BLOCK: Selects the FlexLogic™ operand for blocking the counting operation. All counter operands are
blocked.
• CNT1 SET TO PRESET: Selects the FlexLogic™ operand used to set the count to the preset value. The counter will
be set to the preset value in the following situations:
1. When the counter is enabled and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the value 1 (when the counter is enabled
and CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand is 0, the counter will be set to 0).
2. When the counter is running and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand changes the state from 0 to 1 (CNT1 SET TO
PRESET changing from 1 to 0 while the counter is running has no effect on the count).
3. When a reset or reset/freeze command is sent to the counter and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the value
1 (when a reset or reset/freeze command is sent to the counter and the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand has the
value 0, the counter will be set to 0).
• COUNTER 1 RESET: Selects the FlexLogic™ operand for setting the count to either “0” or the preset value depending
on the state of the CNT1 SET TO PRESET operand.
• COUNTER 1 FREEZE/RESET: Selects the FlexLogic™ operand for capturing (freezing) the accumulated count value
into a separate register with the date and time of the operation, and resetting the count to “0”.
• COUNTER 1 FREEZE/COUNT: Selects the FlexLogic™ operand for capturing (freezing) the accumulated count value
into a separate register with the date and time of the operation, and continuing counting. The present accumulated
value and captured frozen value with the associated date/time stamp are available as actual values. If control power is
interrupted, the accumulated and frozen values are saved into non-volatile memory during the power down operation.
SETTING
COUNTER 1 FUNCTION:
Disabled = 0
SETTINGS
Enabled = 1
COUNTER 1 NAME:
5 SETTING
COUNTER 1 UP:
AND COUNTER 1 UNITS:
COUNTER 1 PRESET:
RUN
Off = 0 SETTING
FLEXLOGIC
COUNTER 1 COMPARE: OPERANDS
SETTING
CALCULATE Count more than Comp. COUNTER 1 HI
COUNTER 1 DOWN: VALUE Count equal to Comp. COUNTER 1 EQL
Off = 0 Count less than Comp. COUNTER 1 LO
SETTING
COUNTER 1 BLOCK:
Off = 0 SET TO PRESET VALUE
CONTACT INPUTS
CONTACT INPUT
THRESHOLDS
The contact inputs menu contains configuration settings for each contact input as well as voltage thresholds for each group
of four contact inputs. Upon startup, the relay processor determines (from an assessment of the installed modules) which
contact inputs are available and then display settings for only those inputs.
An alphanumeric ID may be assigned to a contact input for diagnostic, setting, and event recording purposes. The CON-
TACT IP X On” (Logic 1) FlexLogic™ operand corresponds to contact input “X” being closed, while CONTACT IP X Off corre-
sponds to contact input “X” being open. The CONTACT INPUT DEBNCE TIME defines the time required for the contact to
overcome ‘contact bouncing’ conditions. As this time differs for different contact types and manufacturers, set it as a maxi-
mum contact debounce time (per manufacturer specifications) plus some margin to ensure proper operation. If CONTACT
INPUT EVENTS is set to “Enabled”, every change in the contact input state will trigger an event.
A raw status is scanned for all Contact Inputs synchronously at the constant rate of 0.5 ms as shown in the figure below.
The DC input voltage is compared to a user-settable threshold. A new contact input state must be maintained for a user-
settable debounce time in order for the T60 to validate the new contact state. In the figure below, the debounce time is set
at 2.5 ms; thus the 6th sample in a row validates the change of state (mark no. 1 in the diagram). Once validated (de-
bounced), the contact input asserts a corresponding FlexLogic™ operand and logs an event as per user setting.
A time stamp of the first sample in the sequence that validates the new state is used when logging the change of the con-
tact input into the Event Recorder (mark no. 2 in the diagram).
Protection and control elements, as well as FlexLogic™ equations and timers, are executed eight times in a power system
cycle. The protection pass duration is controlled by the frequency tracking mechanism. The FlexLogic™ operand reflecting
the debounced state of the contact is updated at the protection pass following the validation (marks no. 3 and 4 on the fig-
ure below). The update is performed at the beginning of the protection pass so all protection and control functions, as well
as FlexLogic™ equations, are fed with the updated states of the contact inputs.
The FlexLogic™ operand response time to the contact input change is equal to the debounce time setting plus up to one
protection pass (variable and depending on system frequency if frequency tracking enabled). If the change of state occurs
just after a protection pass, the recognition is delayed until the subsequent protection pass; that is, by the entire duration of
the protection pass. If the change occurs just prior to a protection pass, the state is recognized immediately. Statistically a
delay of half the protection pass is expected. Owing to the 0.5 ms scan rate, the time resolution for the input contact is
below 1msec.
For example, 8 protection passes per cycle on a 60 Hz system correspond to a protection pass every 2.1 ms. With a con-
tact debounce time setting of 3.0 ms, the FlexLogic™ operand-assert time limits are: 3.0 + 0.0 = 3.0 ms and 3.0 + 2.1 = 5.1
ms. These time limits depend on how soon the protection pass runs after the debouncing time.
Regardless of the contact debounce time setting, the contact input event is time-stamped with a 1 μs accuracy using the
time of the first scan corresponding to the new state (mark no. 2 below). Therefore, the time stamp reflects a change in the
DC voltage across the contact input terminals that was not accidental as it was subsequently validated using the debounce
timer. Keep in mind that the associated FlexLogic™ operand is asserted/de-asserted later, after validating the change.
The debounce algorithm is symmetrical: the same procedure and debounce time are used to filter the LOW-HIGH (marks
no.1, 2, 3, and 4 in the figure below) and HIGH-LOW (marks no. 5, 6, 7, and 8 below) transitions.
VOLTAGE
INPUT
USER-PROGRAMMABLE THRESHOLD
6
2 1 3 5
Time stamp of the first
TM
Time stamp of the first At this time, the The FlexLogic
5
scan corresponding to the
At this time, the new
scan corresponding to new (HIGH) operand is going to new validated state is
(LOW) contact state is
the new validated state is contact state is be asserted at this logged in the SOE record
validated
logged in the SOE record validated protection pass
7
RAW CONTACT
The FlexLogicTM
operand is going to be
STATE
de-asserted at this
protection pass
DEBOUNCE TIME
(user setting)
4
The FlexLogicTM operand
DEBOUNCE TIME
The FlexLogicTM operand changes reflecting the
SCAN TIME (user setting)
changes reflecting the validated contact state
FLEXLOGICTM
PROTECTION PASS
(8 times a cycle controlled by the
frequency tracking mechanism)
842709A1.cdr
Figure 5–76: INPUT CONTACT DEBOUNCING MECHANISM AND TIME-STAMPING SAMPLE TIMING
Contact inputs are isolated in groups of four to allow connection of wet contacts from different voltage sources for each
group. The CONTACT INPUT THRESHOLDS determine the minimum voltage required to detect a closed contact input. This
value should be selected according to the following criteria: 17 for 24 V sources, 33 for 48 V sources, 84 for 110 to 125 V
sources and 166 for 250 V sources.
For example, to use contact input H5a as a status input from the breaker 52b contact to seal-in the trip relay and record it in
the Event Records menu, make the following settings changes:
CONTACT INPUT H5A ID: "Breaker Closed (52b)"
CONTACT INPUT H5A EVENTS: "Enabled"
Note that the 52b contact is closed when the breaker is open and open when the breaker is closed.
VIRTUAL INPUT 2
As above for Virtual Input 1
↓ ↓
VIRTUAL INPUT 32
As above for Virtual Input 1
There are 32 virtual inputs that can be individually programmed to respond to input signals from the keypad (COMMANDS
menu) and communications protocols. All virtual input operands are defaulted to OFF = 0 unless the appropriate input sig-
5
nal is received. Virtual input states are preserved through a control power loss.
If the VIRTUAL INPUT x FUNCTION is to "Disabled", the input will be forced to 'OFF' (Logic 0) regardless of any attempt to alter
the input. If set to "Enabled", the input operates as shown on the logic diagram and generates output FlexLogic™ operands
in response to received input signals and the applied settings.
There are two types of operation: Self-Reset and Latched. If VIRTUAL INPUT x TYPE is "Self-Reset", when the input signal
transits from OFF = 0 to ON = 1, the output operand will be set to ON = 1 for only one evaluation of the FlexLogic™ equa-
tions and then return to OFF = 0. If set to "Latched", the virtual input sets the state of the output operand to the same state
as the most recent received input, ON =1 or OFF = 0.
The "Self-Reset" operating mode generates the output operand for a single evaluation of the FlexLogic™
equations. If the operand is to be used anywhere other than internally in a FlexLogic™ equation, it will
NOTE
likely have to be lengthened in time. A FlexLogic™ timer with a delayed reset can perform this function.
The Select-Before-Operate timer sets the interval from the receipt of an Operate signal to the automatic de-selection of the
virtual input, so that an input does not remain selected indefinitely (used only with the UCA Select-Before-Operate feature).
SETTING
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
FUNCTION:
Disabled=0
Enabled=1 S
AND
Latch
“Virtual Input 1 to ON = 1”
SETTING
“Virtual Input 1 to OFF = 0” R VIRTUAL INPUT 1 ID:
AND
SETTING (Flexlogic Operand)
OR
Virt Ip 1
VIRTUAL INPUT 1
TYPE:
Latched AND
Self - Reset 827080A2.CDR
a) DIGITAL OUTPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1
Upon startup of the relay, the main processor will determine from an assessment of the modules installed in the chassis
which contact outputs are available and present the settings for only these outputs.
An ID may be assigned to each contact output. The signal that can OPERATE a contact output may be any FlexLogic™
operand (virtual output, element state, contact input, or virtual input). An additional FlexLogic™ operand may be used to
SEAL-IN the relay. Any change of state of a contact output can be logged as an Event if programmed to do so.
EXAMPLE:
The trip circuit current is monitored by providing a current threshold detector in series with some Form-A contacts (see the
Trip Circuit Example in the Digital Elements section). The monitor will set a flag (see the Specifications for Form-A). The
name of the FlexLogic™ operand set by the monitor, consists of the output relay designation, followed by the name of the
5 flag; e.g. ‘Cont Op 1 IOn’ or ‘Cont Op 1 IOff’.
In most breaker control circuits, the trip coil is connected in series with a breaker auxiliary contact used to interrupt current
flow after the breaker has tripped, to prevent damage to the less robust initiating contact. This can be done by monitoring
an auxiliary contact on the breaker which opens when the breaker has tripped, but this scheme is subject to incorrect oper-
ation caused by differences in timing between breaker auxiliary contact change-of-state and interruption of current in the
trip circuit. The most dependable protection of the initiating contact is provided by directly measuring current in the tripping
circuit, and using this parameter to control resetting of the initiating relay. This scheme is often called "trip seal-in".
This can be realized in the UR using the ‘Cont Op 1 IOn’ FlexLogic™ operand to seal-in the Contact Output as follows:
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 ID: “Cont Op 1"
OUTPUT H1 OPERATE: any suitable FlexLogic™ operand
OUTPUT H1 SEAL-IN: “Cont Op 1 IOn”
CONTACT OUTPUT H1 EVENTS: “Enabled”
b) LATCHING OUTPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a
The T60 latching output contacts are mechanically bi-stable and controlled by two separate (open and close) coils. As such
they retain their position even if the relay is not powered up. The relay recognizes all latching output contact cards and pop-
ulates the setting menu accordingly. On power up, the relay reads positions of the latching contacts from the hardware
before executing any other functions of the relay (such as protection and control features or FlexLogic™).
The latching output modules, either as a part of the relay or as individual modules, are shipped from the factory with all
latching contacts opened. It is highly recommended to double-check the programming and positions of the latching con-
tacts when replacing a module.
Since the relay asserts the output contact and reads back its position, it is possible to incorporate self-monitoring capabili-
ties for the latching outputs. If any latching outputs exhibits a discrepancy, the LATCHING OUTPUT ERROR self-test error is
declared. The error is signaled by the LATCHING OUT ERROR FlexLogic™ operand, event, and target message.
• OUTPUT H1a OPERATE: This setting specifies a FlexLogic™ operand to operate the ‘close coil’ of the contact. The
relay will seal-in this input to safely close the contact. Once the contact is closed and the RESET input is logic 0 (off),
any activity of the OPERATE input, such as subsequent chattering, will not have any effect. With both the OPERATE and
RESET inputs active (logic 1), the response of the latching contact is specified by the OUTPUT H1A TYPE setting.
• OUTPUT H1a RESET: This setting specifies a FlexLogic™ operand to operate the ‘trip coil’ of the contact. The relay
will seal-in this input to safely open the contact. Once the contact is opened and the OPERATE input is logic 0 (off), any
activity of the RESET input, such as subsequent chattering, will not have any effect. With both the OPERATE and RESET
inputs active (logic 1), the response of the latching contact is specified by the OUTPUT H1A TYPE setting.
• OUTPUT H1a TYPE: This setting specifies the contact response under conflicting control inputs; that is, when both the
OPERATE and RESET signals are applied. With both control inputs applied simultaneously, the contact will close if set to
“Operate-dominant” and will open if set to “Reset-dominant”.
Application Example 1:
A latching output contact H1a is to be controlled from two user-programmable pushbuttons (buttons number 1 and 2). The 5
following settings should be applied.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUT-
PUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a menu (assuming an H4L module):
Program the pushbuttons by making the following changes in the PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE PUSHBUT-
TONS USER PUSHBUTTON 1 and USER PUSHBUTTON 2 menus:
Application Example 2:
A relay, having two latching contacts H1a and H1c, is to be programmed. The H1a contact is to be a Type-a contact, while
the H1c contact is to be a Type-b contact (Type-a means closed after exercising the operate input; Type-b means closed
after exercising the reset input). The relay is to be controlled from virtual outputs: VO1 to operate and VO2 to reset.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUT-
PUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a and CONTACT OUTPUT H1c menus (assuming an H4L module):
Since the two physical contacts in this example are mechanically separated and have individual control inputs, they will not
operate at exactly the same time. A discrepancy in the range of a fraction of a maximum operating time may occur. There-
fore, a pair of contacts programmed to be a multi-contact relay will not guarantee any specific sequence of operation (such
as make before break). If required, the sequence of operation must be programmed explicitly by delaying some of the con-
trol inputs as shown in the next application example.
Application Example 3:
A make before break functionality must be added to the preceding example. An overlap of 20 ms is required to implement
this functionality as described below:
Both timers (Timer 1 and Timer 2) should be set to 20 ms pickup and 0 ms dropout.
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUT-
PUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a and CONTACT OUTPUT H1c menus (assuming an H4L module):
Application Example 4:
A latching contact H1a is to be controlled from a single virtual output VO1. The contact should stay closed as long as VO1
is high, and should stay opened when VO1 is low. Program the relay as follows.
Write the following FlexLogic™ equation (EnerVista UR Setup example shown):
Program the Latching Outputs by making the following changes in the SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS CONTACT OUT-
PUTS CONTACT OUTPUT H1a menu (assuming an H4L module):
There are 64 virtual outputs that may be assigned via FlexLogic™. If not assigned, the output will be forced to ‘OFF’ (Logic
0). An ID may be assigned to each virtual output. Virtual outputs are resolved in each pass through the evaluation of the
FlexLogic™ equations. Any change of state of a virtual output can be logged as an event if programmed to do so.
For example, if Virtual Output 1 is the trip signal from FlexLogic™ and the trip relay is used to signal events, the settings
would be programmed as follows:
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1 ID: "Trip"
VIRTUAL OUTPUT 1 EVENTS: "Disabled"
Sixteen Remote Devices, numbered from 1 to 16, can be selected for setting purposes. A receiving relay must be pro-
grammed to capture messages from only those originating remote devices of interest. This setting is used to select specific
remote devices by entering (bottom row) the exact identification (ID) assigned to those devices.
Remote Inputs which create FlexLogic™ operands at the receiving relay, are extracted from GOOSE messages originating
in remote devices. The relay provides 32 remote inputs, each of which can be selected from a list consisting of 64 selec-
tions: DNA-1 through DNA-32 and UserSt-1 through UserSt-32. The function of DNA inputs is defined in the UCA2 specifi-
cations and is presented in the UCA2 DNA Assignments table in the Remote Outputs section. The function of UserSt inputs
is defined by the user selection of the FlexLogic™ operand whose state is represented in the GOOSE message. A user
must program a DNA point from the appropriate FlexLogic™ operand.
Remote Input 1 must be programmed to replicate the logic state of a specific signal from a specific remote device for local
use. This programming is performed via the three settings shown above.
REMOTE IN 1 DEVICE selects the number (1 to 16) of the remote device which originates the required signal, as previously
assigned to the remote device via the setting REMOTE DEVICE NN ID (see the Remote Devices section). REMOTE IN 1 BIT PAIR
5 selects the specific bits of the GOOSE message required.
The REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE setting selects the logic state for this point if the local relay has just completed startup or
the remote device sending the point is declared to be non-communicating. The following choices are available:
• Setting REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE to “On” value defaults the input to Logic 1.
• Setting REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE to “Off” value defaults the input to Logic 0.
• Setting REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE to “Latest/On” freezes the input in case of lost communications. If the latest state is
not known, such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input will default to Logic 1.
When communication resumes, the input becomes fully operational.
• Setting REMOTE IN 1 DEFAULT STATE to “Latest/Off” freezes the input in case of lost communications. If the latest state is
not known, such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input will default to Logic 0.
When communication resumes, the input becomes fully operational.
For additional information on the GOOSE specification, refer to the Remote Devices section in this chapter
and to Appendix C: UCA/MMS Communications.
NOTE
Remote Outputs (1 to 32) are FlexLogic™ operands inserted into GOOSE messages that are transmitted to remote
devices on a LAN. Each digital point in the message must be programmed to carry the state of a specific FlexLogic™ oper-
and. The above operand setting represents a specific DNA function (as shown in the following table) to be transmitted.
For more information on GOOSE specifications, see the Remote I/O Overview in the Remote Devices sec-
tion.
NOTE
Remote Outputs 1 to 32 originate as GOOSE messages to be transmitted to remote devices. Each digital point in the mes-
sage must be programmed to carry the state of a specific FlexLogic™ operand. The setting above is used to select the
operand which represents a specific UserSt function (as selected by the user) to be transmitted.
The following setting represents the time between sending GOOSE messages when there has been no change of state of
any selected digital point. This setting is located in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS UCA/MMS PROTOCOL set-
tings menu.
DEFAULT GOOSE UPDATE Range: 1 to 60 s in steps of 1
TIME: 60 s
For more information on GOOSE specifications, see the Remote I/O Overview in the Remote Devices sec-
tion.
NOTE
5.7.8 RESETTING
Some events can be programmed to latch the faceplate LED event indicators and the target message on the display. Once
set, the latching mechanism will hold all of the latched indicators or messages in the set state after the initiating condition
has cleared until a RESET command is received to return these latches (not including FlexLogic™ latches) to the reset
state. The RESET command can be sent from the faceplate Reset button, a remote device via a communications channel,
or any programmed operand.
When the RESET command is received by the relay, two FlexLogic™ operands are created. These operands, which are
stored as events, reset the latches if the initiating condition has cleared. The three sources of RESET commands each cre-
ate the RESET OP FlexLogic™ operand. Each individual source of a RESET command also creates its individual operand
RESET OP (PUSHBUTTON), RESET OP (COMMS) or RESET OP (OPERAND) to identify the source of the command. The setting
shown above selects the operand that will create the RESET OP (OPERAND) operand.
a) DIRECT INPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS DIRECT INPUTS DIRECT INPUT 1(32)
These settings specify how the Direct Input information is processed. The DIRECT INPUT DEVICE ID represents the source of
this Direct Input. The specified Direct Input is driven by the device identified here.
The DIRECT INPUT 1 BIT NUMBER is the bit number to extract the state for this Direct Input. Direct Input x is driven by the bit
identified here as DIRECT INPUT 1 BIT NUMBER. This corresponds to the Direct Output Number of the sending device.
The DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT STATE represents the state of the Direct Input when the associated Direct Device is offline. The
following choices are available:
• Setting DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT STATE to “On” value defaults the input to Logic 1.
• Setting DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT STATE to “Off” value defaults the input to Logic 0.
• Setting DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT STATE to “Latest/On” freezes the input in case of lost communications. If the latest
state is not known, such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input will default to
Logic 1. When communication resumes, the input becomes fully operational.
• Setting DIRECT INPUT 1 DEFAULT STATE to “Latest/Off” freezes the input in case of lost communications. If the latest
state is not known, such as after relay power-up but before the first communication exchange, the input will default to
Logic 0. When communication resumes, the input becomes fully operational.
b) DIRECT OUTPUTS
PATH: SETTINGS INPUTS/OUTPUTS DIRECT OUTPUTS DIRECT OUTPUT 1(32)
The DIR OUT 1 OPERAND is the FlexLogic™ operand that determines the state of this Direct Output.
c) APPLICATION EXAMPLES 5
The examples introduced in the Product Setup section for Direct I/Os are continued below to illustrate usage of the Direct
Inputs and Outputs.
EXAMPLE 1: EXTENDING I/O CAPABILITIES OF A T60 RELAY
Consider an application that requires additional quantities of digital inputs and/or output contacts and/or lines of program-
mable logic that exceed the capabilities of a single UR-series chassis. The problem is solved by adding an extra UR-series
IED, such as the C30, to satisfy the additional I/Os and programmable logic requirements. The two IEDs are connected via
single-channel digital communication cards as shown below.
TX1
UR IED 1
RX1
TX1
UR IED 2
RX1
The Cont Ip 1 On operand of UR IED 2 is now available in UR IED 1 as DIRECT INPUT 5 ON.
EXAMPLE 2: INTERLOCKING BUSBAR PROTECTION
A simple interlocking busbar protection scheme can be accomplished by sending a blocking signal from downstream
devices, say 2, 3 and 4, to the upstream device that monitors a single incomer of the busbar, as shown in the figure below.
UR IED 1 BLOCK
842712A1.CDR
UR IED 1 UR IED 2
UR IED 3
842713A1.CDR
RX1
UR IED 3
TX1
842714A1.CDR
UR IED 1 UR IED 2
DIRECT OUT 2 = HYB POTT TX1 DIRECT INPUT 5
DIRECT INPUT 5 DIRECT OUT 2 = HYB POTT TX1
DIRECT INPUT 6 DIRECT OUT 4 = DIRECT INPUT 6
DIRECT OUT 3 = DIRECT INPUT 5
DIRECT INPUT 6
842717A1.CDR
↓
↓
DCMA INPUT U8
MESSAGE
Hardware and software is provided to receive signals from external transducers and convert these signals into a digital for-
mat for use as required. The relay will accept inputs in the range of –1 to +20 mA DC, suitable for use with most common
transducer output ranges; all inputs are assumed to be linear over the complete range. Specific hardware details are con-
tained in Chapter 3.
Before the dcmA input signal can be used, the value of the signal measured by the relay must be converted to the range
and quantity of the external transducer primary input parameter, such as DC voltage or temperature. The relay simplifies
this process by internally scaling the output from the external transducer and displaying the actual primary parameter.
dcmA input channels are arranged in a manner similar to CT and VT channels. The user configures individual channels
with the settings shown here.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered from 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up,
the relay will automatically generate configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same general
manner that is used for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through 8 inclu-
sive, which is used as the channel number. The relay generates an actual value for each available input channel.
5 Settings are automatically generated for every channel available in the specific relay as shown below for the first channel of
a type 5F transducer module installed in slot M.
The function of the channel may be either “Enabled” or “Disabled.” If “Disabled”, no actual values are created for the chan-
nel. An alphanumeric “ID” is assigned to each channel; this ID will be included in the channel actual value, along with the
programmed units associated with the parameter measured by the transducer, such as Volt, °C, MegaWatts, etc. This ID is
also used to reference the channel as the input parameter to features designed to measure this type of parameter. The
DCMA INPUT XX RANGE setting specifies the mA DC range of the transducer connected to the input channel.
The DCMA INPUT XX MIN VALUE and DCMA INPUT XX MAX VALUE settings are used to program the span of the transducer in
primary units. For example, a temperature transducer might have a span from 0 to 250°C; in this case the DCMA INPUT XX
MIN VALUE value is “0” and the DCMA INPUT XX MAX VALUE value is “250”. Another example would be a Watt transducer with
a span from –20 to +180 MW; in this case the DCMA INPUT XX MIN VALUE value would be “–20” and the DCMA INPUT XX MAX
VALUE value “180”. Intermediate values between the min and max values are scaled linearly.
↓
↓
RTD INPUT U8
MESSAGE
Hardware and software is provided to receive signals from external Resistance Temperature Detectors and convert these
signals into a digital format for use as required. These channels are intended to be connected to any of the RTD types in
common use. Specific hardware details are contained in Chapter 3.
RTD input channels are arranged in a manner similar to CT and VT channels. The user configures individual channels with
the settings shown here.
The channels are arranged in sub-modules of two channels, numbered from 1 through 8 from top to bottom. On power-up,
the relay will automatically generate configuration settings for every channel, based on the order code, in the same general
manner that is used for CTs and VTs. Each channel is assigned a slot letter followed by the row number, 1 through 8 inclu-
sive, which is used as the channel number. The relay generates an actual value for each available input channel.
Settings are automatically generated for every channel available in the specific relay as shown below for the first channel of
a type 5C transducer module installed in slot M.
The function of the channel may be either “Enabled” or “Disabled.” If Disabled, there will not be an actual value created for
the channel. An alphanumeric “ID” is assigned to the channel; this ID will be included in the channel actual values. It is also
used to reference the channel as the input parameter to features designed to measure this type of parameter. Selecting the
type of RTD connected to the channel configures the channel.
Actions based on RTD overtemperature, such as trips or alarms, are done in conjunction with the FlexElements™ feature.
In FlexElements™, the operate level is scaled to a base of 100°C. For example, a trip level of 150°C is achieved by setting
the operate level at 1.5 pu. FlexElement™ operands are available to FlexLogic™ for further interlocking or to operate an
output contact directly.
The relay provides test settings to verify that functionality using simulated conditions for contact inputs and outputs. The
Test Mode is indicated on the relay faceplate by a flashing Test Mode LED indicator.
To initiate the Test mode, the TEST MODE FUNCTION setting must be “Enabled” and the TEST MODE INITIATE setting must be
set to Logic 1. In particular:
• To initiate Test Mode through relay settings, set TEST MODE INITIATE to “On”. The Test Mode starts when the TEST MODE
FUNCTION setting is changed from “Disabled” to “Enabled”.
• To initiate Test Mode through a user-programmable condition, such as FlexLogic™ operand (pushbutton, digital input,
communication-based input, or a combination of these), set TEST MODE FUNCTION to “Enabled” and set TEST MODE INI-
TIATE to the desired operand. The Test Mode starts when the selected operand assumes a Logic 1 state.
When in Test Mode, the T60 remains fully operational, allowing for various testing procedures. In particular, the protection
and control elements, FlexLogic™, and communication-based inputs and outputs function normally.
The only difference between the normal operation and the Test Mode is the behavior of the input and output contacts. The
former can be forced to report as open or closed or remain fully operational; the latter can be forced to open, close, freeze,
or remain fully operational. The response of the digital input and output contacts to the Test Mode is programmed individu-
5 ally for each input and output using the Force Contact Inputs and Force Contact Outputs test functions described in the fol-
lowing sections.
The relay digital inputs (contact inputs) could be pre-programmed to respond to the Test Mode in the following ways:
• If set to “Disabled”, the input remains fully operational. It is controlled by the voltage across its input terminals and can
be turned on and off by external circuitry. This value should be selected if a given input must be operational during the
test. This includes, for example, an input initiating the test, or being a part of a user pre-programmed test sequence.
• If set to “Open”, the input is forced to report as opened (Logic 0) for the entire duration of the Test Mode regardless of
the voltage across the input terminals.
• If set to “Closed”, the input is forced to report as closed (Logic 1) for the entire duration of the Test Mode regardless of
the voltage across the input terminals.
The Force Contact Inputs feature provides a method of performing checks on the function of all contact inputs. Once
enabled, the relay is placed into Test Mode, allowing this feature to override the normal function of contact inputs. The Test
Mode LED will be On, indicating that the relay is in Test Mode. The state of each contact input may be programmed as “Dis-
abled”, “Open”, or “Closed”. All contact input operations return to normal when all settings for this feature are disabled.
The relay contact outputs can be pre-programmed to respond to the Test Mode.
If set to “Disabled”, the contact output remains fully operational. If operates when its control operand is Logic 1 and will
resets when its control operand is Logic 0. If set to “Energize”, the output will close and remain closed for the entire duration
of the Test Mode, regardless of the status of the operand configured to control the output contact. If set to “De-energize”,
the output will open and remain opened for the entire duration of the Test Mode regardless of the status of the operand con-
figured to control the output contact. If set to “Freeze”, the output retains its position from before entering the Test Mode,
regardless of the status of the operand configured to control the output contact.
These settings are applied two ways. First, external circuits may be tested by energizing or de-energizing contacts. Sec-
ond, by controlling the output contact state, relay logic may be tested and undesirable effects on external circuits avoided.
Example 1: Initiating a Test from User-Programmable Pushbutton 1
The Test Mode should be initiated from User-Programmable Pushbutton 1. The pushbutton will be programmed as
“Latched” (pushbutton pressed to initiate the test, and pressed again to terminate the test). During the test, Digital Input 1
5
should remain operational, Digital Inputs 2 and 3 should open, and Digital Input 4 should close. Also, Contact Output 1
should freeze, Contact Output 2 should open, Contact Output 3 should close, and Contact Output 4 should remain fully
operational. The required settings are shown below.
To enable User-Programmable Pushbutton 1 to initiate the Test mode, make the following changes in the SETTINGS
TESTING TEST MODE menu:
TEST MODE FUNCTION: “Enabled” and TEST MODE INITIATE: “PUSHBUTTON 1 ON”
Make the following changes to configure the Contact I/Os. In the SETTINGS TESTING FORCE CONTACT INPUTS and
FORCE CONTACT INPUTS menus, set:
FORCE Cont Ip 1: “Disabled”, FORCE Cont Ip 2: “Open”, FORCE Cont Ip 3: “Open”, and FORCE Cont Ip 4: “Closed”
FORCE Cont Op 1: “Freeze”, FORCE Cont Op 2: “De-energized”, FORCE Cont Op 3: “Open”, and FORCE Cont Op 4: “Disabled”
Set the User Programmable Pushbutton as latching by changing SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP USER-PROGRAMMABLE
PUSHBUTTONS USER PUSHBUTTON 1 PUSHBUTTON 1 FUNCTION to “Latched”. To enable either Pushbutton 1 or Remote
Input 1 to initiate the Test mode, make the following changes in the SETTINGS TESTING TEST MODE menu:
VIRTUAL INPUTS
See page 6-3.
REMOTE INPUTS
See page 6-3.
CONTACT OUTPUTS
See page 6-4.
VIRTUAL OUTPUTS
See page 6-4.
REMOTE DEVICES
See page 6-4.
STATUS
REMOTE DEVICES
See page 6-5.
STATISTICS
DIGITAL COUNTERS
See page 6-5.
SELECTOR SWITCHES
See page 6-5.
FLEX STATES
See page 6-5.
ETHERNET
See page 6-6.
6
DIRECT INPUTS
See page 6-6.
DIRECT DEVICES
See page 6-7.
STATUS
SOURCE SRC 1
See page 6-11.
SOURCE SRC 2
SOURCE SRC 3
SOURCE SRC 4
TRACKING FREQUENCY
See page 6-15.
FLEXELEMENTS
See page 6-16.
RESTRICTED GROUND
See page 6-16.
FAULT CURRENTS
TRANSDUCER I/O
See page 6-17.
DCMA INPUTS
TRANSDUCER I/O
See page 6-17.
RTD INPUTS
EVENT RECORDS
See page 6-18.
OSCILLOGRAPHY
See page 6-18.
DATA LOGGER
See page 6-19.
6.2STATUS
For status reporting, ‘On’ represents Logic 1 and ‘Off’ represents Logic 0.
NOTE
Cont Ip xx
MESSAGE
Off
The present status of the contact inputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the contact
input. For example, ‘Cont Ip 1’ refers to the contact input in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of the
display indicates the logic state of the contact input.
Virt Ip 32
MESSAGE
Off
The present status of the 32 virtual inputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the virtual 6
input. For example, ‘Virt Ip 1’ refers to the virtual input in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of the dis-
play indicates the logic state of the virtual input.
Cont Op xx
MESSAGE
Off
The present state of the contact outputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the contact
output. For example, ‘Cont Op 1’ refers to the contact output in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of
the display indicates the logic state of the contact output.
For Form-A outputs, the state of the voltage(V) and/or current(I) detectors will show as: Off, VOff, IOff, On,
VOn, and/or IOn. For Form-C outputs, the state will show as Off or On.
NOTE
Virt Op 64
MESSAGE
Off
The present state of up to 64 virtual outputs is shown here. The first line of a message display indicates the ID of the virtual
output. For example, ‘Virt Op 1’ refers to the virtual output in terms of the default name-array index. The second line of the
display indicates the logic state of the virtual output, as calculated by the FlexLogic™ equation for that output.
6 6.2.6 REMOTE DEVICES
a) STATUS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS REMOTE DEVICES STATUS
The present state of up to 16 programmed Remote Devices is shown here. The ALL REMOTE DEVICES ONLINE message indi-
cates whether or not all programmed Remote Devices are online. If the corresponding state is "No", then at least one
required Remote Device is not online.
b) STATISTICS
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS REMOTE DEVICES STATISTICS REMOTE DEVICE 1(16)
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES STATUS DIGITAL COUNTERS DIGITAL COUNTERS Counter 1(8)
The present status of the 8 digital counters is shown here. The status of each counter, with the user-defined counter name,
includes the accumulated and frozen counts (the count units label will also appear). Also included, is the date/time stamp
for the frozen count. The Counter n MICROS value refers to the microsecond portion of the time stamp.
The display shows both the current position and the full range. The current position only (an integer from 0 through 7) is the
actual value.
There are 256 FlexState bits available. The second line value indicates the state of the given FlexState bit.
6.2.10 ETHERNET
The AVERAGE MSG RETURN TIME is the time taken for Direct Output messages to return to the sender in a Direct I/O ring
configuration (this value is not applicable for non-ring configurations). This is a rolling average calculated for the last 10
messages. There are two return times for dual-channel communications modules.
The UNRETURNED MSG COUNT values (one per communications channel) count the Direct Output messages that do not
make the trip around the communications ring. The CRC FAIL COUNT values (one per communications channel) count the
Direct Output messages that have been received but fail the CRC check. High values for either of these counts may indi-
cate on a problem with wiring, the communication channel, or the relay(s). The UNRETURNED MSG COUNT and CRC FAIL
COUNT values can be cleared using the CLEAR DIRECT I/O COUNTERS command.
The DIRECT INPUT x values represent the state of the x-th Direct Input.
DIRECT DEVICE 16
MESSAGE
STATUS: Offline
These actual values represent the state of direct devices 1 through 16.
Voltage +Q
VCG
WATTS = Positive IC
PF = Lead PF = Lag
VARS = Positive
PF = Lag IA
VAG -P +P
Current
IB IA
PF = Lag PF = Lead
UR RELAY
VBG -Q
M LOAD
- 1
Inductive Resistive S=VI
Generator
VCG
+Q
Voltage
PF = Lead PF = Lag
WATTS = Positive
IA
VARS = Negative IC
PF = Lead VAG -P +P
IA
Current
PF = Lag PF = Lead
IB
UR RELAY
VBG -Q
LOAD S=VI
6 Inductive
Resistive
Resistive
- 2
M LOAD
VCG +Q
Voltage
PF = Lead PF = Lag
IB
IA
WATTS = Negative
VAG
VARS = Negative -P +P
PF = Lag
IA
IC PF = Lag PF = Lead
Current
VBG
-Q
UR RELAY
G S=VI
- 3
Generator
Resistive
LOAD
VCG
+Q
Voltage IB
PF = Lead PF = Lag
WATTS = Negative IA
VARS = Positive VAG -P +P
PF = Lead
IC
IA
Current
PF = Lag PF = Lead
VBG -Q
UR RELAY
G 827239AC.CDR
S=VI
- 4
Generator
Figure 6–1: FLOW DIRECTION OF SIGNED VALUES FOR WATTS AND VARS
b) PHASE ANGLES
All phasors calculated by UR-series relays and used for protection, control and metering functions are rotating phasors that
maintain the correct phase angle relationships with each other at all times.
For display and oscillography purposes, all phasor angles in a given relay are referred to an AC input channel pre-selected
by the SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP POWER SYSTEM FREQUENCY AND PHASE REFERENCE setting. This setting
defines a particular Source to be used as the reference.
The relay will first determine if any “Phase VT” bank is indicated in the Source. If it is, voltage channel VA of that bank is
used as the angle reference. Otherwise, the relay determines if any “Aux VT” bank is indicated; if it is, the auxiliary voltage
channel of that bank is used as the angle reference. If neither of the two conditions is satisfied, then two more steps of this
hierarchical procedure to determine the reference signal include “Phase CT” bank and “Ground CT” bank.
If the AC signal pre-selected by the relay upon configuration is not measurable, the phase angles are not referenced. The
phase angles are assigned as positive in the leading direction, and are presented as negative in the lagging direction, to
more closely align with power system metering conventions. This is illustrated below.
-270o
-225o -315o
positive
angle
direction
-180o 0o
UR phase angle
reference
-135o -45o
-90o 827845A1.CDR
6
Figure 6–2: UR PHASE ANGLE MEASUREMENT CONVENTION
c) SYMMETRICAL COMPONENTS
The UR-series of relays calculate voltage symmetrical components for the power system phase A line-to-neutral voltage,
and symmetrical components of the currents for the power system phase A current. Owing to the above definition, phase
angle relations between the symmetrical currents and voltages stay the same irrespective of the connection of instrument
transformers. This is important for setting directional protection elements that use symmetrical voltages.
For display and oscillography purposes the phase angles of symmetrical components are referenced to a common refer-
ence as described in the previous sub-section.
WYE-CONNECTED INSTRUMENT TRANSFORMERS:
• ABC phase rotation: • ACB phase rotation:
1 1
V_0 = --- ( V AG + V BG + V CG ) V_0 = --- ( V AG + V BG + V CG )
3 3
1 1 2
2
V_1 = --- ( V AG + aV BG + a V CG ) V_1 = --- ( V AG + a V BG + aV CG )
3 3
1 1 2
2
V_2 = --- ( V AG + a V BG + aV CG ) V_2 = --- ( V AG + aV BG + a V CG )
3 3
The zero-sequence voltage is not measurable under the Delta connection of instrument transformers and is defaulted to
zero. The table below shows an example of symmetrical components calculations for the ABC phase rotation.
Table 6–1: SYMMETRICAL COMPONENTS CALCULATION EXAMPLE
SYSTEM VOLTAGES, SEC. V * VT UR INPUTS, SEC. V SYMM. COMP, SEC. V
CONN.
VAG VBG VCG VAB VBC VCA F5AC F6AC F7AC V0 V1 V2
13.9 76.2 79.7 84.9 138.3 85.4 WYE 13.9 76.2 79.7 19.5 56.5 23.3
∠0° ∠–125° ∠–250° ∠–313° ∠–97° ∠–241° ∠0° ∠–125° ∠–250° ∠–192° ∠–7° ∠–187°
UNKNOWN (only V1 and V2 84.9 138.3 85.4 DELTA 84.9 138.3 85.4 N/A 56.5 23.3
can be determined) ∠0° ∠–144° ∠–288° ∠0° ∠–144° ∠–288° ∠–54° ∠–234°
* The power system voltages are phase-referenced – for simplicity – to VAG and VAB, respectively. This, however, is a
relative matter. It is important to remember that the T60 displays are always referenced as specified under SETTINGS
SYSTEM SETUP POWER SYSTEM FREQUENCY AND PHASE REFERENCE.
6
reference
1
UR phase angle
A
reference
WYE VTs
C
B
0
2
U
re R ph
fe a
re se
nc a
e ng
le
A U
1
re R ph
fe a
re se
nc a
e ng
DELTA VTs le
C
B
2
827844A1.CDR
6.3.3 SOURCES
Four identical Source menus are available. The "SRC 1" text will be replaced by whatever name was programmed by the
user for the associated source (see SETTINGS SYSTEM SETUP SIGNAL SOURCES).
The relay measures (absolute values only) SOURCE DEMAND on each phase and average three phase demand for real,
reactive, and apparent power. These parameters can be monitored to reduce supplier demand penalties or for statistical
metering purposes. Demand calculations are based on the measurement type selected in the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP
DEMAND menu. For each quantity, the relay displays the demand over the most recent demand time interval, the maxi-
mum demand since the last maximum demand reset, and the time and date stamp of this maximum demand value. Maxi-
mum demand quantities can be reset to zero with the CLEAR RECORDS CLEAR DEMAND RECORDS command.
SOURCE FREQUENCY is measured via software-implemented zero-crossing detection of an AC signal. The signal is either a
Clarke transformation of three-phase voltages or currents, auxiliary voltage, or ground current as per source configuration
(see the SYSTEM SETUP POWER SYSTEM settings). The signal used for frequency estimation is low-pass filtered. The
final frequency measurement is passed through a validation filter that eliminates false readings due to signal distortions and
transients. 6
CURRENT HARMONICS are measured for each Source for the THD and 2nd to 25th harmonics per phase.
6.3.5 FLEXELEMENTS™
FLEXELEMENT 1 FLEXELEMENT 1
OpSig: 0.000 pu
The operating signals for the FlexElements are displayed in pu values using the following definitions of the base units.
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING RESTRICTED GROUND FAULT CURRENTS RESTRICTED GROUND FAULT 1(4)
The differential and restraint current values for the Restricted Ground Fault Element are displayed in this menu.
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING TRANSDUCER I/O DCMA INPUTS DCMA INPUT xx
Actual values for each dcmA input channel that is Enabled are displayed with the top line as the programmed Channel “ID”
and the bottom line as the value followed by the programmed units.
PATH: ACTUAL VALUES METERING TRANSDUCER I/O RTD INPUTS RTD INPUT xx
Actual values for each RTD input channel that is Enabled are displayed with the top line as the programmed Channel “ID”
and the bottom line as the value.
This menu displays the User-Programmable Fault Report actual values. See the User-Programmable Fault Report section
in Chapter 5 for additional information on this feature.
EVENT: 3 EVENT 3
MESSAGE
POWER ON DATE: 2000/07/14
EVENT: 2 EVENT 3
MESSAGE
POWER OFF TIME: 14:53:00.03405
EVENT: 1
MESSAGE Date and Time Stamps
EVENTS CLEARED
6 The Event Records menu shows the contextual data associated with up to the last 1024 events, listed in chronological
order from most recent to oldest. If all 1024 event records have been filled, the oldest record will be removed as a new
record is added. Each event record shows the event identifier/sequence number, cause, and date/time stamp associated
with the event trigger. Refer to the COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS menu for clearing event records.
6.4.3 OSCILLOGRAPHY
This menu allows the user to view the number of triggers involved and number of oscillography traces available. The
‘cycles per record’ value is calculated to account for the fixed amount of data storage for oscillography. See the Oscillogra-
phy section of Chapter 5 for further details.
A trigger can be forced here at any time by setting "Yes" to the FORCE TRIGGER? command. Refer to the COMMANDS
CLEAR RECORDS menu for clearing the oscillography records.
The OLDEST SAMPLE TIME is the time at which the oldest available samples were taken. It will be static until the log gets full,
at which time it will start counting at the defined sampling rate. The NEWEST SAMPLE TIME is the time the most recent sam-
ples were taken. It counts up at the defined sampling rate. If Data Logger channels are defined, then both values are static.
Refer to the COMMANDS CLEAR RECORDS menu for clearing data logger records.
SERIAL NUMBER:
MESSAGE
The product order code, serial number, Ethernet MAC address, date/time of manufacture, and operating time are shown
here.
The shown data is illustrative only. A modification file number of 0 indicates that, currently, no modifications have been
installed.
COMMANDS
COMMANDS
MESSAGE
VIRTUAL INPUTS
COMMANDS
MESSAGE
CLEAR RECORDS
COMMANDS
MESSAGE
SET DATE AND TIME
COMMANDS
MESSAGE
RELAY MAINTENANCE
The Commands menu contains relay directives intended for operations personnel. All commands can be protected from
unauthorized access via the Command Password; see the Password Security section of Chapter 5. The following flash
message appears after successfully command entry:
COMMAND
EXECUTED
This menu contains commands for clearing historical data such as the Event Records. Data is cleared by changing a com-
mand setting to “Yes” and pressing the key. After clearing data, the command setting automatically reverts to “No”.
The date and time can be entered here via the faceplate keypad only if the IRIG-B or SNTP signal is not in use. The time
setting is based on the 24-hour clock. The complete date, as a minimum, must be entered to allow execution of this com-
mand. The new time will take effect at the moment the key is clicked.
This menu contains commands for relay maintenance purposes. Commands are activated by changing a command setting
7 to “Yes” and pressing the key. The command setting will then automatically revert to “No”.
The PERFORM LAMPTEST command turns on all faceplate LEDs and display pixels for a short duration. The UPDATE
ORDER CODE command causes the relay to scan the backplane for the hardware modules and update the order code to
match. If an update occurs, the following message is shown.
UPDATING...
PLEASE WAIT
There is no impact if there have been no changes to the hardware modules. When an update does not occur, the ORDER
CODE NOT UPDATED message will be shown.
TARGETS
DIGITAL ELEMENT 1: Displayed only if targets for this element are active.
MESSAGE Example shown.
LATCHED
DIGITAL ELEMENT 16: Displayed only if targets for this element are active.
MESSAGE Example shown.
LATCHED
MESSAGE
↓
↓
The status of any active targets will be displayed in the Targets menu. If no targets are active, the display will read No
Active Targets:
When there are no active targets, the first target to become active will cause the display to immediately default to that mes-
sage. If there are active targets and the user is navigating through other messages, and when the default message timer
times out (i.e. the keypad has not been used for a determined period of time), the display will again default back to the tar-
get message.
The range of variables for the target messages is described below. Phase information will be included if applicable. If a tar-
get message status changes, the status with the highest priority will be displayed.
If a self test error is detected, a message appears indicating the cause of the error. For example UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED
indicates that the minimal relay settings have not been programmed. 7
7.2.3 RELAY SELF-TESTS
The relay performs a number of self-test diagnostic checks to ensure device integrity. The two types of self-tests (major and
minor) are listed in the tables below. When either type of self-test error occurs, the Trouble LED Indicator will turn on and a
target message displayed. All errors record an event in the event recorder. Latched errors can be cleared by pressing the
RESET key, providing the condition is no longer present.
Major self-test errors also result in the following:
• the critical fail relay on the power supply module is de-energized
• all other output relays are de-energized and are prevented from further operation
• the faceplate In Service LED indicator is turned off
• a RELAY OUT OF SERVICE event is recorded
Most of the minor self-test errors can be disabled. Refer to the settings in the User-Programmable Self-Tests section in
Chapter 5 for additional details.
a) OVERVIEW
The following commissioning tests are organized in two parts: general procedures for testing points of the differential-
restraint characteristics, and examples of the percent differential element response, based on different transformer configu-
rations and fault current distribution. The following tests can be performed by using either 2 or 3 individually adjustable cur-
rents, and do not require additional specialized equipment.
PREPARATION:
1. Select a 0° or 180° transformer phase shift and identical winding connection type into the relay.
2. Select the “Not Within Zone” setting value for each winding grounding setting.
3. Select and set the CT ratios for each winding.
4. Calculate the magnitude compensation factors M[1] and M[2] for each winding.
5. Enable the Transformer Percent Differential element, and enter the required test settings to shape the differential
restraint characteristic.
6. Connect the relay test set to inject x current (Ix) into the Winding 1 Phase A CT input, and y current (IY) into the Wind-
ing 2 Phase A CT input.
TESTING:
The tests of the differential restraint characteristic verify the minimum pickup point, the intersection point of Breakpoint 1
and Slope 1, and the intersection point of Breakpoint 2 and Slope 2.
For simplicity, enter the following settings for each winding:
SYSTEM SETUP TRANSFORMER WINDING 1(4) WINDING 1(4) CONNECTION: “Wye”
SYSTEM SETUP TRANSFORMER WINDING 1(4) WINDING 1(4) GROUNDING: “Not Within Zone”
SYSTEM SETUP TRANSFORMER WINDING 2(4) WINDING 2(4) ANGLE WRT WINDING 1: “0°”
If the power transformer phase shift is 0°, the two currents to be injected to the relay should be 180° apart. The 180° phase
shift results from the inversion of the field CT, as their positive marks are away from the protected transformer terminals and
are connected to the positively marked terminals on the relay.
b) MINIMUM PICKUP
Inject current (Ix) into Winding 1 Phase A and monitor the per-unit Phase A differential current until it exceeds the minimum
pickup setting. The theoretical injected current for minimum pickup verification can be computed as follows:
CT
I x = minimum pickup × ----------- (EQ 8.1)
M[1]
where CT is the 1 A or 5 A tap, and M[1] is the calculated magnitude compensation factor (see the Transformer section in
Chapter 5 for details on calculating the M[1] and M[2] factors).
c) SLOPE 1 / BREAKPOINT 1
The point of Slope 1 and Breakpoint 1 is tested as follows. Refer to the Differential Restraint Characteristic diagram below
for details.
1. Inject current (Iy) into Winding 2 Phase A as follows:
CT
I YB1 = Breakpoint 1 × ----------- (EQ 8.2)
M[2]
2. At Breakpoint 1, the injected current IXOP1 is determined by:
CT
I XOP1 = Breakpoint 1 × ( 1 – Slope 1 ) × ----------- (EQ 8.3)
M[1]
and the differential current should be equal to:
I d = Slope 1 (in %) × Breakpoint 1 (in pu) (EQ 8.4)
3. Preset the Ix current to 1.05 × I XOP1 . Switch on the test set. The relay should restraint, as the differential to restraint
ratio will become less than the Slope 1 setting. Switch off the current.
4. Preset the Ix current to 0.95 × I XOP1 . Switch on the test set. The relay should operate. Switch off the current.
To test any other point from the Slope 1 section of the curve, inject a per-unit restraint current smaller than the Breakpoint 1
current and repeat the steps above by substituting the Breakpoint 1 value with the new per-unit restraint current value into
the equations above.
d) SLOPE 2 / BREAKPOINT 2
The point of Slope 2 and Breakpoint 2 is tested as follows. Refer to the diagram below for details.
1. Preset the Iy current to a magnitude that results in the restraint current being equal to Breakpoint 2. Use the following
calculation to define the magnitude of the injected current:
CT
I YB2 = Breakpoint 2 × ----------- (EQ 8.5)
M[2]
2. At the above current (restraint), the IXOP2 current required to operate the element is calculated as:
CT
I XOP2 = Breakpoint 2 × ( 1 – Slope 2 ) × ----------- (EQ 8.6)
M[1]
3. Preset the Ix current to 1.05 × I XOP1 and switch on the test set. The relay should restrain, as the differential to restraint
ratio will become less than the Slope 2 setting. Switch off the current.
4. Preset the Ix current to 0.95 × I XOP1 . Switch on the test set and verify relay operation. Switch off the current.
To test any point from the Slope 2 portion of the characteristic, inject a per-unit restraint current greater than the Breakpoint
2 current as restraint and repeat the steps above by substituting the Breakpoint 2 value in the equations above with the new
per-unit restraint current value.
The above two tests can be repeated for Phases B and C.
8 Id (pu)
S2
S1
PKP
B1 B2 Ir (pu)
The T60 commissioning tests are based on secondary current injections, where two or three individually adjustable cur-
rents are required. The differential protection compares the magnitudes of the varying HV and LV currents in real time.
Therefore, the test set currents and their angles must be an exact replica of the HV and LV currents and angles shown on
the diagrams, along with the correct CT polarity and orientation.
Ensure that the thermal rating of the relay current inputs is not exceeded. Stopping the injection of the currents to the relay
by using contact outputs triggered by protection operation can prevent this from occurring.
Due to the complexity of the mathematics defining the operating characteristic of the region between Breakpoint 1 and 2,
the use of a factory-supplied Microsoft Excel simulation utility is highly recommended. This utility indicates graphically
whether the relay should operate, based on the settings and winding current injection. This allows the tester to define and
confirm various points on the operating characteristic. The spreadsheet can be found at GE Multilin website at http://
www.GEindustrial.com/multilin.
Y/y0°
Transformer
~c ~b ~c
~b
IA = 0 pu Ia = 0 pu
~c BC Fault
~b
~c ~b
Ib = 0.866 ∠–270° pu
IB = 0.866 ∠–90° pu
~c ~b ~b ~c
Figure 8–2: CURRENT DISTRIBUTION ON A Y/YG0° TRANSFORMER WITH b-c FAULT ON LV SIDE
Consider the above system, which illustrates the importance of CT orientation, polarity and relay connection. These factors
will also apply when performing the tests outlined in the next examples.
The transformer high voltage (HV) and low voltage (LV) side fault currents, and angles are all related. More specifically, the
HV and LV primary fault currents are displaced by 180°. The CT polarity marks point away from the protected zone and are
connected to the ~a terminals of the relay. The displayed current is what is reported by the relay.
8
The ~a and ~b terminal identifications are illustrative only. Refer to CT/VT Modules section in Chapter 3 for specific
terminal identification.
NOTE
a) OVERVIEW
TRANSFORMER DATA:
• 20 MVA, 115/12.47 kV, CT (HV) = 200:1, CT (LV) = 1000:1, Y/y0° with a grounded LV neutral
TEST SET CONFIGURATION:
The fault current distribution for an external b-c fault is identical for the HV and LV transformer sides and can be simulated
easily with two current sources. Connect the first current source to the relay Phase “B” and “C” terminals, corresponding to
the HV winding CTs in series, and the second source to the Phase “b” and “c” relay terminals, corresponding to the LV CTs.
Ensure the polarity is correct and the relative phase angles are similar to the shown in the figure; that is, 180° between IB
and IC, 180° between Ib and Ic, 180° between IB and Ib, and 180° between IC and Ic. Follow the magnitudes and angles of
the injected currents from the tables below to ensure the test will be performed correctly
OPERATING CRITERIA:
The differential element operates if the differential current (Id) exceeds the characteristic defined by the relay settings for
restraint current magnitude (Ir). The differential current Id is the vector sum of the compensated currents, and Ir is the larg-
est compensated current. Compensation refers to vector and magnitude corrections applied to the currents from the HV
and LV transformer sides.
The tests verify the operation and no-operation response for points from all regions of the percentage differential character-
istic. These tests are:
• Test for zero differential current
• Minimum Pickup
• Slope 1
• The region between Slope 1 and Slope 2
• Slope 2
RELAY CONFIGURATION:
The AC Inputs and Source are configured as follows:
AC INPUTS SETTING CT F1 CT M1 SOURCE SETTING SOURCE 1 SOURCE 2
Phase CT Primary 200 1000 Name SRC 1 SRC 2
Phase CT Secondary 1 1 Phase CT F1 M1
Ground CT Primary X X Ground CT X X
Ground CT Secondary X X Phase VT X X
Aux VT X X
8 Source
Rated MVA
SRC 1
20 MVA
Source
Rated MVA
SRC 2
20 MVA
Minimum PKP
Slope 1
0.1 pu
15%
Nom Ph-Ph Voltage 115 kV Nom Ph-Ph Voltage 12.47 kV Breakpoint 1 2 pu
Connection Wye Connection Wye Breakpoint 2 8 pu
Grounding Not within zone Grounding Within zone Slope 2 95%
Angle WRT 0° Angle WRT 0°
Resistance 3Ph 10.000 ohms Resistance 3Ph 10.000 ohms
APPLICATION OF EXCESSIVE CURRENT (> 3 × In) FOR EXTENTED PERIODS WILL CAUSE DAMAGE TO
THE RELAY!
WARNING
5. The following differential and restraint current should be read from the T60 actual values menu:
PHASE DIFFERENTIAL CURRENT (Id) PHASE RESTRAINT CURRENT (Ir)
A 0 ∠0° A 0 ∠0°
B 0.044 pu ∠0° B 0.275 pu ∠–180°
C 0.044 pu ∠0° C 0.275 pu ∠0° 8
The relay will not operate since Id is still lower that the 0.1 pu MINIMUM PICKUP setting.
6. Increase I1 to 0.2 A. The differential current increases to I d = 0.136 pu > Min PKP and I r < 0.67 pu .
7. Verify that the Percent Differential element operates and the following are displayed in the actual values menu:
PHASE DIFFERENTIAL CURRENT (Id) PHASE RESTRAINT CURRENT (Ir)
A 0 ∠0° A 0 ∠0°
B 0.136 ∠0° B 0.367 pu ∠–180°
C 0.136 ∠0° C 0.367 pu ∠0°
d) SLOPE 1 TEST
Inject current in such a manner that the magnitude of Ir is larger than the restraint current of 0.67 pu, corresponding to the
intersection of the minimum PKP and Slope 1 and smaller than the Breakpoint 1 setting; that is,
I r ( intersection of Min PKP and Slope 1 ) < I r ( actual ) < I r ( Break 1 ) (EQ 8.9)
2. The following differential and restraint current should be read from the T60 actual values menu:
PHASE DIFFERENTIAL CURRENT (Id) PHASE RESTRAINT CURRENT (Ir)
A 0 ∠0° A 0 ∠0°
B 0.113 pu ∠0° B 1 pu ∠–180°
C 0.113 pu ∠0° C 1 pu ∠0°
The Percent Differential element will not operate even though Id is larger than the Minimum Pickup, because Id
is not large enough to make the I d ⁄ I r ratio larger than the Slope 1 setting of 15%. The actual ratio is 11.3%.
NOTE
3. Adjust the I1 current as shown below (thereby increasing Id) and verify that the element operates.
WINDING 1 WINDING 2
PHASE SINGLE CURRENT (I1) PHASE SINGLE CURRENT (I2)
A 0 A ∠0° A 0 A ∠0°
B 0.45 A ∠0° B 1 A ∠–180°
C 0.45 A ∠–180° C 1 A ∠0°
4. The following differential and restraint current should appear in the T60 actual values menu:
PHASE DIFFERENTIAL CURRENT (Id) PHASE RESTRAINT CURRENT (Ir)
A 0 ∠0° A 0 ∠0°
B 0.170 pu ∠0° B 1 pu ∠–180°
C 0.170 pu ∠0° C 1 pu ∠0°
5. The actual I d ⁄ I r ratio is now 17%. Verify that the element operates correctly.
For this example, 2 pu < I r < 8 pu . Remember that the maximum current is the restraint current I r = 3.5 pu .
WINDING 1 WINDING 2
PHASE SINGLE CURRENT (I1) PHASE SINGLE CURRENT (I2)
A 0 A ∠0° A 0 A ∠0°
B 1.2 A ∠0° B 3.5 A ∠–180°
C 1.2 A ∠–180° C 3.5 A ∠0°
2. The following differential and restraint current should be read from the T60 actual values menu:
PHASE DIFFERENTIAL CURRENT (Id) PHASE RESTRAINT CURRENT (Ir)
A 0 ∠0° A 0 ∠0°
B 1.287 pu ∠–180° B 3.5 pu ∠–180°
C 1.287 pu ∠0° C 3.5 pu ∠0°
The I d ⁄ I r ratio is 36.77% and the Differential element does not operate because the actual I d = 1.287 pu is still too
low at I r = 3.5 pu .
Due to the mathematical complexity involved in shaping the curve between Breakpoint 1 and Breakpoint 2, an
Excel-based simulation tool is available from the GE Multilin website at http://www.GEindustrial.com/multilin.
NOTE
With this tool, the user can see the preset I d ⁄ I r curve point ratios and the actual I d ⁄ I r ratio as per the entered
test currents. The tool graphically indicates differential and restraint current magnitudes and indicates whether
the relay should operate.
3. In this example, a ratio of I d ⁄ I r > 38% causes the element to trip. Decreasing I1 as shown in the table below increases
the differential current Id, causing the element to operate.
WINDING 1 WINDING 2
PHASE SINGLE CURRENT (I1) PHASE SINGLE CURRENT (I2)
A 0 A ∠0° A 0 A ∠0°
B 1.1 A ∠0° B 3.5 A ∠–180°
C 1.1 A ∠–180° C 3.5 A ∠0°
4. The following differential and restraint current should be read from the T60 actual values menu:
PHASE DIFFERENTIAL CURRENT (Id) PHASE RESTRAINT CURRENT (Ir)
A 0 ∠0° A 0 ∠0°
B 1.471 pu ∠–180° B 3.5 pu ∠–180°
8
C 1.471 pu ∠0° C 3.5 pu ∠0°
f) SLOPE 2 TEST
Inject currents in such a manner that the magnitude of Ir is larger than the restraint current at Breakpoint 2; that is,
I r > I r ( Break 2 ) = 8 pu (EQ 8.11)
2. The following differential and restraint current should be read from the T60 actual values menu:
PHASE DIFFERENTIAL CURRENT (Id) PHASE RESTRAINT CURRENT (Ir)
A 0 ∠0° A 0 ∠0°
B 8.078 pu ∠–180° B 9 pu ∠–180°
C 8.078 pu ∠0° C 9 pu ∠0°
Since I d ⁄ I r = 89.8% and lower than the required 95%, the Percent Differential element will not operate.
3. Adjust the I1 current as shown below (thereby increasing Id) and verify that the relay operates.
WINDING 1 WINDING 2
PHASE SINGLE CURRENT (I1) PHASE SINGLE CURRENT (I2)
A 0 A ∠0° A 0 A ∠0°
B 0.2 A ∠0° B 9 A ∠–180°
C 0.2 A ∠–180° C 9 A ∠0°
4. The following differential and restraint current should appear in the T60 actual values menu:
PHASE DIFFERENTIAL CURRENT (Id) PHASE RESTRAINT CURRENT (Ir)
A 0 ∠0° A 0 ∠0°
B 8.631 pu ∠–180° B 9 pu ∠–180°
C 8.631 pu ∠0° C 9 pu ∠0°
5. The actual I d ⁄ I r ratio is now 95.9%. Verify that the element operates correctly.
g) SUMMARY
The above tests describe the principles of testing the differential element for all regions from the operating characteristic.
For verification of more points, one should consider adjusting the magnitude of the restraint current Ir to the desired portion
of the characteristic and change the other current to vary Id until the relay operates. Use the Excel tool to compare the
actual and expected operating values.
8 A blank Result Table is provided at the end of this chapter for convenience.
Fault
IB(f) = 0 pu Ib(f) = 0
B B
C C
IC(f) = 0.577 pu ∠–180° Ic(f) = 0
828737A1.CDR
Figure 8–3: CURRENT DISTRIBUTION ON A D/YG30° TRANSFORMER WITH A LV-SIDE GROUND FAULT
Figure 8–4: CURRENT DISTRIBUTION ON A YG/D30° TRANSFORMER WITH AN a TO b FAULT ON THE LV SIDE
Three adjustable currents are required in this case. The Phase A and C Wye-side line currents, identical in magnitude but
displaced by 180°, can be simulated with one current source passed through these relay terminals in series. The second
current source simulates the Phase B primary current. The third source simulates the delta “b” and “c” phase currents, also
equal in magnitude but displaced by 180°.
TEST PHASE INJECTED CURRENT DISPLAYED CURRENT STATUS
W1 CURRENT W2 CURRENT DIFFERENTIAL RESTRAINT
Balanced A 0.25 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° Not Applicable
Condition
B 0.5 ∠–180° 0.8 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0.8 ∠0°
C 0.25 ∠0° 0.8 ∠–180° 0 ∠0° 0.8 ∠–180°
Min Pickup A 0.25 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° Block
change the
B 0.5 ∠–180° 0.95 ∠0° 0.154 ∠0° 0.948 ∠0°
Id = 0.051 < Min PKP
Min PKP to
0.2 pu C 0.25 ∠0° 0.95 ∠–180° 0.155 ∠0° 0.950 ∠–180°
Minimum A 0.25 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° Operate
Pickup
B 0.5 ∠–180° 1.05 ∠0° 0.253 ∠0° 1.049 ∠0°
Id = 0.102 > Min PKP
C 0.25 ∠0° 1.05 ∠–180° 0.255 ∠0° 1.050 ∠–180°
Slope 1 A 0.25 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° Block
return the Id /Ir = 13.2%
Min PKP to B 0.5 ∠–180° 0.92 ∠0° 0.123 ∠0° 0.919 ∠0°
0.1 pu C 0.25 ∠0° 0.92 ∠–180° 0.123 ∠0° 0.919 ∠–180°
Slope 1 A 0.25 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° Operate
Id /Ir = 15.9%
B 0.5 ∠–180° 0.95 ∠0° 0.153 ∠0° 0.948 ∠0°
0.25 ∠0° 0.95 ∠–180° 0.153 ∠0° 0.948 ∠–180°
8 Intermediate
C
A 2 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° Block
Slope 1 & 2 Id /Ir = 84.3%
B 4 ∠–180° 1 ∠0° 5.37 ∠–180° 6.37 ∠0° < 86.6% computed
C 2 ∠0° 1 ∠–180° 5.37 ∠0° 6.37 ∠–180°
Intermediate A 2 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° Operate
Slope 1 & 2 Id /Ir = 87.5%
B 4 ∠–180° 0.8 ∠0° 5.57 ∠–180° 6.37 ∠0° > 86.6% computed
C 2 ∠0° 0.8 ∠–180° 5.57 ∠0° 6.37 ∠–180°
Slope 2 A 4 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° Block
Id /Ir = 93.7%
B 8 ∠–180° 0.8 ∠0° 11.93 ∠–180° 12.73 ∠0° < Slope 2 = 95%
C 4 ∠0° 0.8 ∠–180° 11.93 ∠0° 12.73 ∠–180°
Slope 2 A 4 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° 0 ∠0° Operate
Id /Ir = 95.7%
B 8 ∠–180° 0.6 ∠0° 12.13 ∠–180° 12.73 ∠0° > Slope 2 = 95%
C 4 ∠0° 0.6 ∠–180° 12.13 ∠0° 12.73 ∠–180°
H winding X winding
IB(f) = 0.866 pu ∠–90° Ib(f) = 0.866 pu ∠–90°
B B
F
C C
IC(f) = 0.866 pu ∠–270°. Ic(f) = 0.866 pu ∠–270°
828739A1.CDR
Figure 8–5: CURRENT DISTRIBUTION OF D/D TRANSFORMER WITH AN a TO b FAULT ON THE LV SIDE
The Inrush Inhibit Test requires a secondary injection test capable of producing a current with an adjustable second
harmonic component. Use the appropriate commissioning tables at the end of this chapter to record values.
NOTE
This procedure is based upon the example provided in the Differential Characteristic Test Example section. The trans-
former parameters are as follows:
Transformer: Y/y0°, 230/69 kV, CT1 (300:1), CT2 (1000:1)
2nd Harmonic Setting = 20%
1. Connect the relay test set to inject current into the Winding 1 Phase A CT input.
2. Inject currents into the relay as shown in the table below until the biased differential element picks up.
3. Confirm that only the percent differential element has operated.
4. Increase the harmonic content until the element drops out. Record this value as the Inrush Inhibit Level Pickup.
5. Gradually decrease the harmonic content level until the element picks up. Record this value as the Inrush Inhibit
Level Dropout.
6. Switch off the current.
7. Repeat steps 1 through 6 for phases B and C.
8. Repeat steps 1 through 7 for Winding 2 (and Windings 3 and 4 if necessary).
The second harmonic inhibit feature can be verified by setting the INRUSH INHIBIT MODE setting as follows:
For INRUSH INHIBIT MODE set to "2-out-of-3":
1. Set the INRUSH INHIBIT FUNCTION to "Trad. 2nd" and the INRUSH INHIBIT LEVEL to "20%".
2. Inject currents into one CT bank (one winding only) until the biased differential operates for all three phases.
3. Apply a second harmonic to Phase A higher than the set threshold and monitor operation of Phases A, B, and C. The
8 4.
element should stay operated on all three phases.
Apply a second harmonic to Phase B with a level less than the set threshold.
5. Increase the second harmonic level in Phase B. When it passes the set threshold, all three phases of differential pro-
tection should drop out.
For INRUSH INHIBIT MODE set to "Average":
1. Set the INRUSH INHIBIT FUNCTION to "Trad. 2nd" and the INRUSH INHIBIT LEVEL to "20%".
2. Inject currents into one CT bank (one winding only) until the biased differential operates for all three phases.
3. Apply a second harmonic to Phase A with a level greater than the set threshold and monitor the operation of the Per-
cent Differential element. The element should drop out when the injected second harmonic level becomes three times
larger than the set threshold.
The Overexcitation Inhibit Test requires a secondary injection from a source capable of producing an adjustable 5th
harmonic component. Use the appropriate commissioning tables at the end of this chapter to record values.
NOTE
This procedure is based upon the example provided in the Differential Characteristic Test Example section. The trans-
former parameters are as follows:
Transformer: Y/y0°, 230/69 kV, CT1 (300:1), CT2 (1000:1)
5th Harmonic Setting = 10%
1. Connect the relay test set to inject current into the Winding 1 Phase A CT input.
2. Inject a current into the relay until the biased Differential element operates.
3. Confirm that ONLY the differential element has operated.
4. Increase the 5th harmonic content level until the element drops out. Record this value as the Overexcitation Inhibit
Level Pickup.
5. Gradually decrease the harmonic content level until the element picks up. Record this value as the Overexcitation
Inhibit Level Dropout.
6. Switch off the current.
7. Repeat steps 1 through 6 for Phases B and C.
8. Repeat steps 1 through 7 for Winding 2 (and Windings 3 and 4 if necessary).
A.1PARAMETER LIST A
Table A–1: FLEXANALOG PARAMETERS (Sheet 1 of 10) Table A–1: FLEXANALOG PARAMETERS (Sheet 2 of 10)
ADDR DATA ITEM ADDR DATA ITEM
5792 RGF 1 Differential Ground Current Magnitude 6232 SRC 2 Ground Current Angle
5794 RGF 1 Restricted Ground Current Magnitude 6233 SRC 2 Zero Sequence Current Magnitude
5795 RGF 2 Differential Ground Current Magnitude 6235 SRC 2 Zero Sequence Current Angle
5797 RGF 2 Restricted Ground Current Magnitude 6236 SRC 2 Positive Sequence Current Magnitude
5798 RGF 3 Differential Ground Current Magnitude 6238 SRC 2 Positive Sequence Current Angle
5800 RGF 3 Restricted Ground Current Magnitude 6239 SRC 2 Negative Sequence Current Magnitude
5801 RGF 4 Differential Ground Current Magnitude 6241 SRC 2 Negative Sequence Current Angle
5803 RGF 4 Restricted Ground Current Magnitude 6242 SRC 2 Differential Ground Current Magnitude
5804 RGF 5 Differential Ground Current Magnitude 6244 SRC 2 Differential Ground Current Angle
5806 RGF 5 Restricted Ground Current Magnitude 6272 SRC 3 Phase A Current RMS
5807 RGF 6 Differential Ground Current Magnitude 6274 SRC 3 Phase B Current RMS
5809 RGF 6 Restricted Ground Current Magnitude 6276 SRC 3 Phase C Current RMS
6144 SRC 1 Phase A Current RMS 6278 SRC 3 Neutral Current RMS
6146 SRC 1 Phase B Current RMS 6280 SRC 3 Phase A Current Magnitude
6148 SRC 1 Phase C Current RMS 6282 SRC 3 Phase A Current Angle
6150 SRC 1 Neutral Current RMS 6283 SRC 3 Phase B Current Magnitude
6152 SRC 1 Phase A Current Magnitude 6285 SRC 3 Phase B Current Angle
6154 SRC 1 Phase A Current Angle 6286 SRC 3 Phase C Current Magnitude
6155 SRC 1 Phase B Current Magnitude 6288 SRC 3 Phase C Current Angle
6157 SRC 1 Phase B Current Angle 6289 SRC 3 Neutral Current Magnitude
6158 SRC 1 Phase C Current Magnitude 6291 SRC 3 Neutral Current Angle
6160 SRC 1 Phase C Current Angle 6292 SRC 3 Ground Current RMS
6161 SRC 1 Neutral Current Magnitude 6294 SRC 3 Ground Current Magnitude
6163 SRC 1 Neutral Current Angle 6296 SRC 3 Ground Current Angle
6164 SRC 1 Ground Current RMS 6297 SRC 3 Zero Sequence Current Magnitude
6166 SRC 1 Ground Current Magnitude 6299 SRC 3 Zero Sequence Current Angle
6168 SRC 1 Ground Current Angle 6300 SRC 3 Positive Sequence Current Magnitude
6169 SRC 1 Zero Sequence Current Magnitude 6302 SRC 3 Positive Sequence Current Angle
6171 SRC 1 Zero Sequence Current Angle 6303 SRC 3 Negative Sequence Current Magnitude
6172 SRC 1 Positive Sequence Current Magnitude 6305 SRC 3 Negative Sequence Current Angle
6174 SRC 1 Positive Sequence Current Angle 6306 SRC 3 Differential Ground Current Magnitude
6175 SRC 1 Negative Sequence Current Magnitude 6308 SRC 3 Differential Ground Current Angle
6177 SRC 1 Negative Sequence Current Angle 6336 SRC 4 Phase A Current RMS
6178 SRC 1 Differential Ground Current Magnitude 6338 SRC 4 Phase B Current RMS
6180 SRC 1 Differential Ground Current Angle 6340 SRC 4 Phase C Current RMS
6208 SRC 2 Phase A Current RMS 6342 SRC 4 Neutral Current RMS
6210 SRC 2 Phase B Current RMS 6344 SRC 4 Phase A Current Magnitude
6212 SRC 2 Phase C Current RMS 6346 SRC 4 Phase A Current Angle
6214 SRC 2 Neutral Current RMS 6347 SRC 4 Phase B Current Magnitude
6216 SRC 2 Phase A Current Magnitude 6349 SRC 4 Phase B Current Angle
6218 SRC 2 Phase A Current Angle 6350 SRC 4 Phase C Current Magnitude
6219 SRC 2 Phase B Current Magnitude 6352 SRC 4 Phase C Current Angle
6221 SRC 2 Phase B Current Angle 6353 SRC 4 Neutral Current Magnitude
6222 SRC 2 Phase C Current Magnitude 6355 SRC 4 Neutral Current Angle
6224 SRC 2 Phase C Current Angle 6356 SRC 4 Ground Current RMS
6225 SRC 2 Neutral Current Magnitude 6358 SRC 4 Ground Current Magnitude
6227 SRC 2 Neutral Current Angle 6360 SRC 4 Ground Current Angle
6228 SRC 2 Ground Current RMS 6361 SRC 4 Zero Sequence Current Magnitude
6230 SRC 2 Ground Current Magnitude 6363 SRC 4 Zero Sequence Current Angle
Table A–1: FLEXANALOG PARAMETERS (Sheet 3 of 10) Table A–1: FLEXANALOG PARAMETERS (Sheet 4 of 10)
A ADDR
6364
DATA ITEM
SRC 4 Positive Sequence Current Magnitude
ADDR
6752
DATA ITEM
SRC 2 Auxiliary Voltage Magnitude
6366 SRC 4 Positive Sequence Current Angle 6754 SRC 2 Auxiliary Voltage Angle
6367 SRC 4 Negative Sequence Current Magnitude 6755 SRC 2 Zero Sequence Voltage Magnitude
6369 SRC 4 Negative Sequence Current Angle 6757 SRC 2 Zero Sequence Voltage Angle
6370 SRC 4 Differential Ground Current Magnitude 6758 SRC 2 Positive Sequence Voltage Magnitude
6372 SRC 4 Differential Ground Current Angle 6760 SRC 2 Positive Sequence Voltage Angle
6656 SRC 1 Phase AG Voltage RMS 6761 SRC 2 Negative Sequence Voltage Magnitude
6658 SRC 1 Phase BG Voltage RMS 6763 SRC 2 Negative Sequence Voltage Angle
6660 SRC 1 Phase CG Voltage RMS 6784 SRC 3 Phase AG Voltage RMS
6662 SRC 1 Phase AG Voltage Magnitude 6786 SRC 3 Phase BG Voltage RMS
6664 SRC 1 Phase AG Voltage Angle 6788 SRC 3 Phase CG Voltage RMS
6665 SRC 1 Phase BG Voltage Magnitude 6790 SRC 3 Phase AG Voltage Magnitude
6667 SRC 1 Phase BG Voltage Angle 6792 SRC 3 Phase AG Voltage Angle
6668 SRC 1 Phase CG Voltage Magnitude 6793 SRC 3 Phase BG Voltage Magnitude
6670 SRC 1 Phase CG Voltage Angle 6795 SRC 3 Phase BG Voltage Angle
6671 SRC 1 Phase AB Voltage RMS 6796 SRC 3 Phase CG Voltage Magnitude
6673 SRC 1 Phase BC Voltage RMS 6798 SRC 3 Phase CG Voltage Angle
6675 SRC 1 Phase CA Voltage RMS 6799 SRC 3 Phase AB Voltage RMS
6677 SRC 1 Phase AB Voltage Magnitude 6801 SRC 3 Phase BC Voltage RMS
6679 SRC 1 Phase AB Voltage Angle 6803 SRC 3 Phase CA Voltage RMS
6680 SRC 1 Phase BC Voltage Magnitude 6805 SRC 3 Phase AB Voltage Magnitude
6682 SRC 1 Phase BC Voltage Angle 6807 SRC 3 Phase AB Voltage Angle
6683 SRC 1 Phase CA Voltage Magnitude 6808 SRC 3 Phase BC Voltage Magnitude
6685 SRC 1 Phase CA Voltage Angle 6810 SRC 3 Phase BC Voltage Angle
6686 SRC 1 Auxiliary Voltage RMS 6811 SRC 3 Phase CA Voltage Magnitude
6688 SRC 1 Auxiliary Voltage Magnitude 6813 SRC 3 Phase CA Voltage Angle
6690 SRC 1 Auxiliary Voltage Angle 6814 SRC 3 Auxiliary Voltage RMS
6691 SRC 1 Zero Sequence Voltage Magnitude 6816 SRC 3 Auxiliary Voltage Magnitude
6693 SRC 1 Zero Sequence Voltage Angle 6818 SRC 3 Auxiliary Voltage Angle
6694 SRC 1 Positive Sequence Voltage Magnitude 6819 SRC 3 Zero Sequence Voltage Magnitude
6696 SRC 1 Positive Sequence Voltage Angle 6821 SRC 3 Zero Sequence Voltage Angle
6697 SRC 1 Negative Sequence Voltage Magnitude 6822 SRC 3 Positive Sequence Voltage Magnitude
6699 SRC 1 Negative Sequence Voltage Angle 6824 SRC 3 Positive Sequence Voltage Angle
6720 SRC 2 Phase AG Voltage RMS 6825 SRC 3 Negative Sequence Voltage Magnitude
6722 SRC 2 Phase BG Voltage RMS 6827 SRC 3 Negative Sequence Voltage Angle
6724 SRC 2 Phase CG Voltage RMS 6848 SRC 4 Phase AG Voltage RMS
6726 SRC 2 Phase AG Voltage Magnitude 6850 SRC 4 Phase BG Voltage RMS
6728 SRC 2 Phase AG Voltage Angle 6852 SRC 4 Phase CG Voltage RMS
6729 SRC 2 Phase BG Voltage Magnitude 6854 SRC 4 Phase AG Voltage Magnitude
6731 SRC 2 Phase BG Voltage Angle 6856 SRC 4 Phase AG Voltage Angle
6732 SRC 2 Phase CG Voltage Magnitude 6857 SRC 4 Phase BG Voltage Magnitude
6734 SRC 2 Phase CG Voltage Angle 6859 SRC 4 Phase BG Voltage Angle
6735 SRC 2 Phase AB Voltage RMS 6860 SRC 4 Phase CG Voltage Magnitude
6737 SRC 2 Phase BC Voltage RMS 6862 SRC 4 Phase CG Voltage Angle
6739 SRC 2 Phase CA Voltage RMS 6863 SRC 4 Phase AB Voltage RMS
6741 SRC 2 Phase AB Voltage Magnitude 6865 SRC 4 Phase BC Voltage RMS
6743 SRC 2 Phase AB Voltage Angle 6867 SRC 4 Phase CA Voltage RMS
6744 SRC 2 Phase BC Voltage Magnitude 6869 SRC 4 Phase AB Voltage Magnitude
6746 SRC 2 Phase BC Voltage Angle 6871 SRC 4 Phase AB Voltage Angle
6747 SRC 2 Phase CA Voltage Magnitude 6872 SRC 4 Phase BC Voltage Magnitude
6749 SRC 2 Phase CA Voltage Angle 6874 SRC 4 Phase BC Voltage Angle
6750 SRC 2 Auxiliary Voltage RMS 6875 SRC 4 Phase CA Voltage Magnitude
Table A–1: FLEXANALOG PARAMETERS (Sheet 5 of 10) Table A–1: FLEXANALOG PARAMETERS (Sheet 6 of 10)
ADDR
6877
DATA ITEM
SRC 4 Phase CA Voltage Angle
ADDR
7252
DATA ITEM
SRC 3 Phase B Apparent Power
A
6878 SRC 4 Auxiliary Voltage RMS 7254 SRC 3 Phase C Apparent Power
6880 SRC 4 Auxiliary Voltage Magnitude 7256 SRC 3 Three Phase Power Factor
6882 SRC 4 Auxiliary Voltage Angle 7257 SRC 3 Phase A Power Factor
6883 SRC 4 Zero Sequence Voltage Magnitude 7258 SRC 3 Phase B Power Factor
6885 SRC 4 Zero Sequence Voltage Angle 7259 SRC 3 Phase C Power Factor
6886 SRC 4 Positive Sequence Voltage Magnitude 7264 SRC 4 Three Phase Real Power
6888 SRC 4 Positive Sequence Voltage Angle 7266 SRC 4 Phase A Real Power
6889 SRC 4 Negative Sequence Voltage Magnitude 7268 SRC 4 Phase B Real Power
6891 SRC 4 Negative Sequence Voltage Angle 7270 SRC 4 Phase C Real Power
7168 SRC 1 Three Phase Real Power 7272 SRC 4 Three Phase Reactive Power
7170 SRC 1 Phase A Real Power 7274 SRC 4 Phase A Reactive Power
7172 SRC 1 Phase B Real Power 7276 SRC 4 Phase B Reactive Power
7174 SRC 1 Phase C Real Power 7278 SRC 4 Phase C Reactive Power
7176 SRC 1 Three Phase Reactive Power 7280 SRC 4 Three Phase Apparent Power
7178 SRC 1 Phase A Reactive Power 7282 SRC 4 Phase A Apparent Power
7180 SRC 1 Phase B Reactive Power 7284 SRC 4 Phase B Apparent Power
7182 SRC 1 Phase C Reactive Power 7286 SRC 4 Phase C Apparent Power
7184 SRC 1 Three Phase Apparent Power 7288 SRC 4 Three Phase Power Factor
7186 SRC 1 Phase A Apparent Power 7289 SRC 4 Phase A Power Factor
7188 SRC 1 Phase B Apparent Power 7290 SRC 4 Phase B Power Factor
7190 SRC 1 Phase C Apparent Power 7291 SRC 4 Phase C Power Factor
7192 SRC 1 Three Phase Power Factor 7552 SRC 1 Frequency
7193 SRC 1 Phase A Power Factor 7553 SRC 2 Frequency
7194 SRC 1 Phase B Power Factor 7554 SRC 3 Frequency
7195 SRC 1 Phase C Power Factor 7555 SRC 4 Frequency
7200 SRC 2 Three Phase Real Power 7680 SRC 1 Demand Ia
7202 SRC 2 Phase A Real Power 7682 SRC 1 Demand Ib
7204 SRC 2 Phase B Real Power 7684 SRC 1 Demand Ic
7206 SRC 2 Phase C Real Power 7686 SRC 1 Demand Watt
7208 SRC 2 Three Phase Reactive Power 7688 SRC 1 Demand Var
7210 SRC 2 Phase A Reactive Power 7690 SRC 1 Demand Va
7212 SRC 2 Phase B Reactive Power 7696 SRC 2 Demand Ia
7214 SRC 2 Phase C Reactive Power 7698 SRC 2 Demand Ib
7216 SRC 2 Three Phase Apparent Power 7700 SRC 2 Demand Ic
7218 SRC 2 Phase A Apparent Power 7702 SRC 2 Demand Watt
7220 SRC 2 Phase B Apparent Power 7704 SRC 2 Demand Var
7222 SRC 2 Phase C Apparent Power 7706 SRC 2 Demand Va
7224 SRC 2 Three Phase Power Factor 7712 SRC 3 Demand Ia
7225 SRC 2 Phase A Power Factor 7714 SRC 3 Demand Ib
7226 SRC 2 Phase B Power Factor 7716 SRC 3 Demand Ic
7227 SRC 2 Phase C Power Factor 7718 SRC 3 Demand Watt
7232 SRC 3 Three Phase Real Power 7720 SRC 3 Demand Var
7234 SRC 3 Phase A Real Power 7722 SRC 3 Demand Va
7236 SRC 3 Phase B Real Power 7728 SRC 4 Demand Ia
7238 SRC 3 Phase C Real Power 7730 SRC 4 Demand Ib
7240 SRC 3 Three Phase Reactive Power 7732 SRC 4 Demand Ic
7242 SRC 3 Phase A Reactive Power 7734 SRC 4 Demand Watt
7244 SRC 3 Phase B Reactive Power 7736 SRC 4 Demand Var
7246 SRC 3 Phase C Reactive Power 7738 SRC 4 Demand Va
7248 SRC 3 Three Phase Apparent Power 8064 SRC 1 Va THD
7250 SRC 3 Phase A Apparent Power 8065 SRC 1 Va Harmonics
Table A–1: FLEXANALOG PARAMETERS (Sheet 7 of 10) Table A–1: FLEXANALOG PARAMETERS (Sheet 8 of 10)
A ADDR
8089
DATA ITEM
SRC 1 Vb THD
ADDR
10274
DATA ITEM
SRC 1 Ib Harmonics
8090 SRC 1 Vb Harmonics 10306 SRC 1 Ic THD
8114 SRC 1 Vc THD 10307 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics
8115 SRC 1 Vc Harmonics 10415 SRC 2 Ia THD
8185 SRC 2 Va THD 10416 SRC 2 Ia Harmonics
8186 SRC 2 Va Harmonics 10448 SRC 2 Ib THD
8210 SRC 2 Vb THD 10449 SRC 2 Ib Harmonics
8211 SRC 2 Vb Harmonics 10481 SRC 2 Ic THD
8235 SRC 2 Vc THD 10482 SRC 2 Ic Harmonics
8236 SRC 2 Vc Harmonics 10590 SRC 3 Ia THD
8306 SRC 3 Va THD 10591 SRC 3 Ia Harmonics
8307 SRC 3 Va Harmonics 10623 SRC 3 Ib THD
8331 SRC 3 Vb THD 10624 SRC 3 Ib Harmonics
8332 SRC 3 Vb Harmonics 10656 SRC 3 Ic THD
8356 SRC 3 Vc THD 10657 SRC 3 Ic Harmonics
8357 SRC 3 Vc Harmonics 10765 SRC 4 Ia THD
8427 SRC 4 Va THD 10766 SRC 4 Ia Harmonics
8428 SRC 4 Va Harmonics 10798 SRC 4 Ib THD
8452 SRC 4 Vb THD 10799 SRC 4 Ib Harmonics
8453 SRC 4 Vb Harmonics 10831 SRC 4 Ic THD
8477 SRC 4 Vc THD 10832 SRC 4 Ic Harmonics
8478 SRC 4 Vc Harmonics 13504 DCMA Inputs 1 Value
8960 Transformer Reference Winding 13505 DCMA Inputs 2 Value
8961 Transformer Differential Phasor Iad Magnitude 13506 DCMA Inputs 3 Value
8962 Transformer Differential Phasor Iad Angle 13507 DCMA Inputs 4 Value
8963 Transformer Restraint Phasor Iar Magnitude 13508 DCMA Inputs 5 Value
8964 Transformer Restraint Phasor Iar Angle 13509 DCMA Inputs 6 Value
8965 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Iad Magnitude 13510 DCMA Inputs 7 Value
8966 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Iad Angle 13511 DCMA Inputs 8 Value
8967 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Iad Magnitude 13512 DCMA Inputs 9 Value
8968 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Iad Angle 13513 DCMA Inputs 10 Value
8969 Transformer Differential Phasor Ibd Magnitude 13514 DCMA Inputs 11 Value
8970 Transformer Differential Phasor Ibd Angle 13515 DCMA Inputs 12 Value
8971 Transformer Restraint Phasor Ibr Magnitude 13516 DCMA Inputs 13 Value
8972 Transformer Restraint Phasor Ibr Angle 13517 DCMA Inputs 14 Value
8973 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Ibd Magnitude 13518 DCMA Inputs 15 Value
8974 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Ibd Angle 13519 DCMA Inputs 16 Value
8975 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Ibd Magnitude 13520 DCMA Inputs 17 Value
8976 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Ibd Angle 13521 DCMA Inputs 18 Value
8977 Transformer Differential Phasor Icd Magnitude 13522 DCMA Inputs 19 Value
8978 Transformer Differential Phasor Icd Angle 13523 DCMA Inputs 20 Value
8979 Transformer Restraint Phasor Icr Magnitude 13524 DCMA Inputs 21 Value
8980 Transformer Restraint Phasor Icr Angle 13525 DCMA Inputs 22 Value
8981 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Icd Magnitude 13526 DCMA Inputs 23 Value
8982 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Icd Angle 13527 DCMA Inputs 24 Value
8983 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Icd Magnitude 13552 RTD Inputs 1 Value
8984 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Icd Angle 13553 RTD Inputs 2 Value
9008 Transformer Winding 1 Tap Position 13554 RTD Inputs 3 Value
9014 Transformer Winding 1 Phase Position 13555 RTD Inputs 4 Value
10240 SRC 1 Ia THD 13556 RTD Inputs 5 Value
10241 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics 13557 RTD Inputs 6 Value
10273 SRC 1 Ib THD 13558 RTD Inputs 7 Value
Table A–1: FLEXANALOG PARAMETERS (Sheet 9 of 10) Table A–1: FLEXANALOG PARAMETERS (Sheet 10 of 10)
ADDR
13559
DATA ITEM
RTD Inputs 8 Value
ADDR
39433
DATA ITEM
FlexElement 9 Actual
A
13560 RTD Inputs 9 Value 39434 FlexElement 10 Actual
13561 RTD Inputs 10 Value 39435 FlexElement 11 Actual
13562 RTD Inputs 11 Value 39436 FlexElement 12 Actual
13563 RTD Inputs 12 Value 39437 FlexElement 13 Actual
13564 RTD Inputs 13 Value 39438 FlexElement 14 Actual
13565 RTD Inputs 14 Value 39439 FlexElement 15 Actual
13566 RTD Inputs 15 Value 39440 FlexElement 16 Actual
13567 RTD Inputs 16 Value 40971 Current Setting Group
13568 RTD Inputs 17 Value 43808 V/Hz 1 Actual
13569 RTD Inputs 18 Value 43809 V/Hz 2 Actual
13570 RTD Inputs 19 Value
13571 RTD Inputs 20 Value
13572 RTD Inputs 21 Value
13573 RTD Inputs 22 Value
13574 RTD Inputs 23 Value
13575 RTD Inputs 24 Value
13576 RTD Inputs 25 Value
13577 RTD Inputs 26 Value
13578 RTD Inputs 27 Value
13579 RTD Inputs 28 Value
13580 RTD Inputs 29 Value
13581 RTD Inputs 30 Value
13582 RTD Inputs 31 Value
13583 RTD Inputs 32 Value
13584 RTD Inputs 33 Value
13585 RTD Inputs 34 Value
13586 RTD Inputs 35 Value
13587 RTD Inputs 36 Value
13588 RTD Inputs 37 Value
13589 RTD Inputs 38 Value
13590 RTD Inputs 39 Value
13591 RTD Inputs 40 Value
13592 RTD Inputs 41 Value
13593 RTD Inputs 42 Value
13594 RTD Inputs 43 Value
13595 RTD Inputs 44 Value
13596 RTD Inputs 45 Value
13597 RTD Inputs 46 Value
13598 RTD Inputs 47 Value
13599 RTD Inputs 48 Value
13600 Ohm Inputs 1 Value
13601 Ohm Inputs 2 Value
32768 Tracking Frequency
39425 FlexElement 1 Actual
39426 FlexElement 2 Actual
39427 FlexElement 3 Actual
39428 FlexElement 4 Actual
39429 FlexElement 5 Actual
39430 FlexElement 6 Actual
39431 FlexElement 7 Actual
39432 FlexElement 8 Actual
The UR series relays support a number of communications protocols to allow connection to equipment such as personal
computers, RTUs, SCADA masters, and programmable logic controllers. The Modicon Modbus RTU protocol is the most
basic protocol supported by the UR. Modbus is available via RS232 or RS485 serial links or via ethernet (using the Mod-
bus/TCP specification). The following description is intended primarily for users who wish to develop their own master com-
munication drivers and applies to the serial Modbus RTU protocol. Note that:
• The UR always acts as a slave device, meaning that it never initiates communications; it only listens and responds to B
requests issued by a master computer.
• For Modbus®, a subset of the Remote Terminal Unit (RTU) protocol format is supported that allows extensive monitor-
ing, programming, and control functions using read and write register commands.
The Modbus® RTU protocol is hardware-independent so that the physical layer can be any of a variety of standard hard-
ware configurations including RS232 and RS485. The relay includes a faceplate (front panel) RS232 port and two rear ter-
minal communications ports that may be configured as RS485, fiber optic, 10BaseT, or 10BaseF. Data flow is half-duplex in
all configurations. See Chapter 3 for details on wiring.
Each data byte is transmitted in an asynchronous format consisting of 1 start bit, 8 data bits, 1 stop bit, and possibly 1 parity
bit. This produces a 10 or 11 bit data frame. This can be important for transmission through modems at high bit rates (11 bit
data frames are not supported by many modems at baud rates greater than 300).
The baud rate and parity are independently programmable for each communications port. Baud rates of 300, 1200, 2400,
4800, 9600, 14400, 19200, 28800, 33600, 38400, 57600, or 115200 bps are available. Even, odd, and no parity are avail-
able. Refer to the Communications section of Chapter 5 for further details.
The master device in any system must know the address of the slave device with which it is to communicate. The relay will
not act on a request from a master if the address in the request does not match the relay’s slave address (unless the
address is the broadcast address – see below).
A single setting selects the slave address used for all ports, with the exception that for the faceplate port, the relay will
accept any address when the Modbus® RTU protocol is used.
Communications takes place in packets which are groups of asynchronously framed byte data. The master transmits a
packet to the slave and the slave responds with a packet. The end of a packet is marked by ‘dead-time’ on the communica-
tions line. The following describes general format for both transmit and receive packets. For exact details on packet format-
ting, refer to subsequent sections describing each function code.
• SLAVE ADDRESS: This is the address of the slave device that is intended to receive the packet sent by the master
and to perform the desired action. Each slave device on a communications bus must have a unique address to prevent
bus contention. All of the relay’s ports have the same address which is programmable from 1 to 254; see Chapter 5 for
details. Only the addressed slave will respond to a packet that starts with its address. Note that the faceplate port is an
exception to this rule; it will act on a message containing any slave address.
A master transmit packet with slave address 0 indicates a broadcast command. All slaves on the communication link
take action based on the packet, but none respond to the master. Broadcast mode is only recognized when associated
with Function Code 05h. For any other function code, a packet with broadcast mode slave address 0 will be ignored.
• FUNCTION CODE: This is one of the supported functions codes of the unit which tells the slave what action to per-
form. See the Supported Function Codes section for complete details. An exception response from the slave is indi-
cated by setting the high order bit of the function code in the response packet. See the Exception Responses section
for further details.
• DATA: This will be a variable number of bytes depending on the function code. This may include actual values, set-
tings, or addresses sent by the master to the slave or by the slave to the master.
• CRC: This is a two byte error checking code. The RTU version of Modbus® includes a 16-bit cyclic redundancy check
B (CRC-16) with every packet which is an industry standard method used for error detection. If a Modbus slave device
receives a packet in which an error is indicated by the CRC, the slave device will not act upon or respond to the packet
thus preventing any erroneous operations. See the CRC-16 Algorithm section for details on calculating the CRC.
• DEAD TIME: A packet is terminated when no data is received for a period of 3.5 byte transmission times (about 15 ms
at 2400 bps, 2 ms at 19200 bps, and 300 µs at 115200 bps). Consequently, the transmitting device must not allow gaps
between bytes longer than this interval. Once the dead time has expired without a new byte transmission, all slaves
start listening for a new packet from the master except for the addressed slave.
The CRC-16 algorithm essentially treats the entire data stream (data bits only; start, stop and parity ignored) as one contin-
uous binary number. This number is first shifted left 16 bits and then divided by a characteristic polynomial
(11000000000000101B). The 16 bit remainder of the division is appended to the end of the packet, MSByte first. The
resulting packet including CRC, when divided by the same polynomial at the receiver will give a zero remainder if no trans-
mission errors have occurred. This algorithm requires the characteristic polynomial to be reverse bit ordered. The most sig-
nificant bit of the characteristic polynomial is dropped, since it does not affect the value of the remainder.
A C programming language implementation of the CRC algorithm will be provided upon request.
Modbus® officially defines function codes from 1 to 127 though only a small subset is generally needed. The relay supports
some of these functions, as summarized in the following table. Subsequent sections describe each function code in detail.
This function code allows the master to read one or more consecutive data registers (actual values or settings) from a relay.
Data registers are always 16 bit (two byte) values transmitted with high order byte first. The maximum number of registers
that can be read in a single packet is 125. See the Modbus Memory Map table for exact details on the data registers.
Since some PLC implementations of Modbus® only support one of function codes 03h and 04h, the relay interpretation
allows either function code to be used for reading one or more consecutive data registers. The data starting address will
determine the type of data being read. Function codes 03h and 04h are therefore identical.
The following table shows the format of the master and slave packets. The example shows a master device requesting 3
register values starting at address 4050h from slave device 11h (17 decimal); the slave device responds with the values 40,
300, and 0 from registers 4050h, 4051h, and 4052h, respectively.
This function code allows the master to perform various operations in the relay. Available operations are shown in the Sum-
mary of Operation Codes table below.
The following table shows the format of the master and slave packets. The example shows a master device requesting the
slave device 11H (17 dec) to perform a reset. The high and low Code Value bytes always have the values “FF” and “00”
respectively and are a remnant of the original Modbus® definition of this function code.
B
Table B–4: MASTER AND SLAVE DEVICE PACKET TRANSMISSION EXAMPLE
MASTER TRANSMISSION SLAVE RESPONSE
PACKET FORMAT EXAMPLE (HEX) PACKET FORMAT EXAMPLE (HEX)
SLAVE ADDRESS 11 SLAVE ADDRESS 11
FUNCTION CODE 05 FUNCTION CODE 05
OPERATION CODE - high 00 OPERATION CODE - high 00
OPERATION CODE - low 01 OPERATION CODE - low 01
CODE VALUE - high FF CODE VALUE - high FF
CODE VALUE - low 00 CODE VALUE - low 00
CRC - low DF CRC - low DF
CRC - high 6A CRC - high 6A
This function code allows the master to modify the contents of a single setting register in an relay. Setting registers are
always 16 bit (two byte) values transmitted high order byte first. The following table shows the format of the master and
slave packets. The example shows a master device storing the value 200 at memory map address 4051h to slave device
11h (17 dec).
This function code allows the master to modify the contents of a one or more consecutive setting registers in a relay. Setting
registers are 16-bit (two byte) values transmitted high order byte first. The maximum number of setting registers that can be
stored in a single packet is 60. The following table shows the format of the master and slave packets. The example shows
a master device storing the value 200 at memory map address 4051h, and the value 1 at memory map address 4052h to
slave device 11h (17 decimal).
B
Table B–7: MASTER AND SLAVE DEVICE PACKET TRANSMISSION EXAMPLE
MASTER TRANSMISSION SLAVE RESPONSE
PACKET FORMAT EXAMPLE (HEX) PACKET FORMAT EXMAPLE (HEX)
SLAVE ADDRESS 11 SLAVE ADDRESS 11
FUNCTION CODE 10 FUNCTION CODE 10
DATA STARTING ADDRESS - hi 40 DATA STARTING ADDRESS - hi 40
DATA STARTING ADDRESS - lo 51 DATA STARTING ADDRESS - lo 51
NUMBER OF SETTINGS - hi 00 NUMBER OF SETTINGS - hi 00
NUMBER OF SETTINGS - lo 02 NUMBER OF SETTINGS - lo 02
BYTE COUNT 04 CRC - lo 07
DATA #1 - high order byte 00 CRC - hi 64
DATA #1 - low order byte C8
DATA #2 - high order byte 00
DATA #2 - low order byte 01
CRC - low order byte 12
CRC - high order byte 62
Programming or operation errors usually happen because of illegal data in a packet. These errors result in an exception
response from the slave. The slave detecting one of these errors sends a response packet to the master with the high order
bit of the function code set to 1.
The following table shows the format of the master and slave packets. The example shows a master device sending the
unsupported function code 39h to slave device 11.
a) DESCRIPTION
The UR relay has a generic file transfer facility, meaning that you use the same method to obtain all of the different types of
files from the unit. The Modbus registers that implement file transfer are found in the "Modbus File Transfer (Read/Write)"
and "Modbus File Transfer (Read Only)" modules, starting at address 3100 in the Modbus Memory Map. To read a file from
the UR relay, use the following steps:
B 1. Write the filename to the "Name of file to read" register using a write multiple registers command. If the name is shorter
than 80 characters, you may write only enough registers to include all the text of the filename. Filenames are not case
sensitive.
2. Repeatedly read all the registers in "Modbus File Transfer (Read Only)" using a read multiple registers command. It is
not necessary to read the entire data block, since the UR relay will remember which was the last register you read. The
"position" register is initially zero and thereafter indicates how many bytes (2 times the number of registers) you have
read so far. The "size of..." register indicates the number of bytes of data remaining to read, to a maximum of 244.
3. Keep reading until the "size of..." register is smaller than the number of bytes you are transferring. This condition indi-
cates end of file. Discard any bytes you have read beyond the indicated block size.
4. If you need to re-try a block, read only the "size of.." and "block of data", without reading the position. The file pointer is
only incremented when you read the position register, so the same data block will be returned as was read in the pre-
vious operation. On the next read, check to see if the position is where you expect it to be, and discard the previous
block if it is not (this condition would indicate that the UR relay did not process your original read request).
The UR relay retains connection-specific file transfer information, so files may be read simultaneously on multiple Modbus
connections.
b) OTHER PROTOCOLS
All the files available via Modbus may also be retrieved using the standard file transfer mechanisms in other protocols (for
example, TFTP or MMS).
The COMMAND password is set up at memory location 4000. Storing a value of “0” removes COMMAND password protec-
tion. When reading the password setting, the encrypted value (zero if no password is set) is returned. COMMAND security
is required to change the COMMAND password. Similarly, the SETTING password is set up at memory location 4002.
These are the same settings and encrypted values found in the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP PASSWORD SECURITY
menu via the keypad. Enabling password security for the faceplate display will also enable it for Modbus, and vice-versa.
To gain COMMAND level security access, the COMMAND password must be entered at memory location 4008. To gain
SETTING level security access, the SETTING password must be entered at memory location 400A. The entered SETTING
password must match the current SETTING password setting, or must be zero, to change settings or download firmware.
COMMAND and SETTING passwords each have a 30-minute timer. Each timer starts when you enter the particular pass-
word, and is re-started whenever you “use” it. For example, writing a setting re-starts the SETTING password timer and
writing a command register or forcing a coil re-starts the COMMAND password timer. The value read at memory location
4010 can be used to confirm whether a COMMAND password is enabled or disabled (0 for Disabled). The value read at
memory location 4011 can be used to confirm whether a SETTING password is enabled or disabled.
COMMAND or SETTING password security access is restricted to the particular port or particular TCP/IP connection on
which the entry was made. Passwords must be entered when accessing the relay through other ports or connections, and
the passwords must be re-entered after disconnecting and re-connecting on TCP/IP.
B 1585
1589
...Repeated for module number 14
...Repeated for module number 15
158D ...Repeated for module number 16
Platform Direct I/O States (Read Only)
15C0 Direct Input States (6 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F500 0
15C8 Platform Direct Outputs Average Msg Return Time 1 0 to 65535 ms 1 F001 0
15C9 Platform Direct Outputs Average Msg Return Time 2 0 to 65535 ms 1 F001 0
15D0 Direct Device States 0 to 65535 --- 1 F500 0
15D1 Reserved
15D2 Platform Direct I/O CRC Fail Count 1 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
15D3 Platform Direct I/O CRC Fail Count 2 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
Ethernet Fibre Channel Status (Read/Write)
1610 Ethernet Primary Fibre Channel Status 0 to 2 --- 1 F134 0 (Fail)
1611 Ethernet Secondary Fibre Channel Status 0 to 2 --- 1 F134 0 (Fail)
Data Logger Actuals (Read Only)
1618 Data Logger Channel Count 0 to 16 CHNL 1 F001 0
1619 Time of oldest available samples 0 to 4294967295 seconds 1 F050 0
161B Time of newest available samples 0 to 4294967295 seconds 1 F050 0
161D Data Logger Duration 0 to 999.9 DAYS 0.1 F001 0
RGF Currents (Read Only) (6 modules)
16A0 Differential Ground 1 Current Magnitude 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
16A2 Restricted Ground 1 Current Magnitude 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
16A4 ...Repeated for module number 2
16A8 ...Repeated for module number 3
16AC ...Repeated for module number 4
16B0 ...Repeated for module number 5
16B4 ...Repeated for module number 6
Source Current (Read Only) (6 modules)
1800 Phase A Current RMS 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1802 Phase B Current RMS 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1804 Phase C Current RMS 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1806 Neutral Current RMS 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1808 Phase A Current Magnitude 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
180A Phase A Current Angle -359.9 to 0 ° 0.1 F002 0
180B Phase B Current Magnitude 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
180D Phase B Current Angle -359.9 to 0 ° 0.1 F002 0
180E Phase C Current Magnitude 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1810 Phase C Current Angle -359.9 to 0 ° 0.1 F002 0
1811 Neutral Current Magnitude 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1813 Neutral Current Angle -359.9 to 0 ° 0.1 F002 0
1814 Ground Current RMS 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1816 Ground Current Magnitude 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1818 Ground Current Angle -359.9 to 0 ° 0.1 F002 0
1819 Zero Sequence Current Magnitude 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
181B Zero Sequence Current Angle -359.9 to 0 ° 0.1 F002 0
181C Positive Sequence Current Magnitude 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
181E Positive Sequence Current Angle -359.9 to 0 ° 0.1 F002 0
181F Negative Sequence Current Magnitude 0 to 999999.999 A 0.001 F060 0
1821 Negative Sequence Current Angle -359.9 to 0 ° 0.1 F002 0
B 2863
28C6
...Repeated for module number 2
...Repeated for module number 3
2929 ...Repeated for module number 4
298C ...Repeated for module number 5
29EF ...Repeated for module number 6
Expanded FlexStates (Read Only)
2B00 FlexStates, one per register (256 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
Expanded Digital I/O states (Read Only)
2D00 Contact Input States, one per register (96 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
2D80 Contact Output States, one per register (64 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
2E00 Virtual Output States, one per register (64 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
Expanded Remote I/O Status (Read Only)
2F00 Remote Device States, one per register (16 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F155 0 (Offline)
2F80 Remote Input States, one per register (32 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
Oscillography Values (Read Only)
3000 Oscillography Number of Triggers 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
3001 Oscillography Available Records 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
3002 Oscillography Last Cleared Date 0 to 400000000 --- 1 F050 0
3004 Oscillography Number Of Cycles Per Record 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
Oscillography Commands (Read/Write Command)
3005 Oscillography Force Trigger 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
3011 Oscillography Clear Data 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
User Programmable Fault Report Commands (Read/Write Command)
3060 User Fault Report Clear 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
User Programmable Fault Report Actuals (Read Only)
3070 Newest Record Number 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
3071 Cleared Date 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F050 0
3073 Report Date (10 items) 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F050 0
User Programmable Fault Report (Read/Write Setting) (2 modules)
3090 Fault Report 1 Fault Trigger 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
3091 Fault Report 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
3092 Fault Report 1 Prefault Trigger 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
3093 Fault Report 1 Analog Channel x (32 items) 0 to 65536 --- 1 F600 0
30B3 Fault Report 1 Reserved (5 items) --- --- --- F001 0
30B8 ...Repeated for module number 2
Modbus File Transfer (Read/Write)
3100 Name of file to read --- --- --- F204 (none)
Modbus File Transfer (Read Only)
3200 Character position of current block within file 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F003 0
3202 Size of currently-available data block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
3203 Block of data from requested file (122 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
Event Recorder (Read Only)
3400 Events Since Last Clear 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F003 0
3402 Number of Available Events 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F003 0
3404 Event Recorder Last Cleared Date 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F050 0
Event Recorder (Read/Write Command)
3406 Event Recorder Clear Command 0 to 1 --- 1 F126 0 (No)
DCMA Input Values (Read Only) (24 modules)
34C0 DCMA Inputs x Value -9999.999 to 9999.999 --- 0.001 F004 0
B 3513
3514
...Repeated for module number 36
...Repeated for module number 37
3515 ...Repeated for module number 38
3516 ...Repeated for module number 39
3517 ...Repeated for module number 40
3518 ...Repeated for module number 41
3519 ...Repeated for module number 42
351A ...Repeated for module number 43
351B ...Repeated for module number 44
351C ...Repeated for module number 45
351D ...Repeated for module number 46
351E ...Repeated for module number 47
351F ...Repeated for module number 48
Ohm Input Values (Read Only) (2 modules)
3520 Ohm Inputs x Value 0 to 65535 1 F001 0
3521 ...Repeated for module number 2
Expanded Platform Direct I/O Status (Read Only)
3560 Direct Device States, one per register (8 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F155 0 (Offline)
3570 Direct Input States, one per register (96 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F108 0 (Off)
Passwords (Read/Write Command)
4000 Command Password Setting 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F003 0
Passwords (Read/Write Setting)
4002 Setting Password Setting 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F003 0
Passwords (Read/Write)
4008 Command Password Entry 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F003 0
400A Setting Password Entry 0 to 4294967295 --- 1 F003 0
Passwords (Read Only)
4010 Command Password Status 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
4011 Setting Password Status 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
User Display Invoke (Read/Write Setting)
4040 Invoke and Scroll through User Display Menu Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0 (Disabled)
User Display Invoke (Read/Write Setting)
4048 LED Test Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
4049 LED Test Control 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0 (Disabled)
Preferences (Read/Write Setting)
4050 Flash Message Time 0.5 to 10 s 0.1 F001 10
4051 Default Message Timeout 10 to 900 s 1 F001 300
4052 Default Message Intensity 0 to 3 --- 1 F101 0 (25%)
4053 Screen Saver Feature 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
4054 Screen Saver Wait Time 1 to 65535 min 1 F001 30
4055 Current Cutoff Level 0.002 to 0.02 pu 0.001 F001 20
4056 Voltage Cutoff Level 0.1 to 1 V 0.1 F001 10
Communications (Read/Write Setting)
407E COM1 minimum response time 0 to 1000 ms 10 F001 0
407F COM2 minimum response time 0 to 1000 ms 10 F001 0
4080 Modbus Slave Address 1 to 254 --- 1 F001 254
4083 RS485 Com1 Baud Rate 0 to 11 --- 1 F112 8 (115200)
4084 RS485 Com1 Parity 0 to 2 --- 1 F113 0 (None)
4085 RS485 Com2 Baud Rate 0 to 11 --- 1 F112 8 (115200)
B 4586
4587
Source Auxiliary VT
...Repeated for module number 2
0 to 63 --- 1 F400 0
B 58B8
58C0
...Repeated for module number 24
...Repeated for module number 25
58C8 ...Repeated for module number 26
58D0 ...Repeated for module number 27
58D8 ...Repeated for module number 28
58E0 ...Repeated for module number 29
58E8 ...Repeated for module number 30
58F0 ...Repeated for module number 31
58F8 ...Repeated for module number 32
Phase TOC (Read/Write Grouped Setting) (6 modules)
5900 Phase TOC Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
5901 Phase TOC Signal Source 0 to 5 --- 1 F167 0 (SRC 1)
5902 Phase TOC Input 0 to 1 --- 1 F122 0 (Phasor)
5903 Phase TOC Pickup 0 to 30 pu 0.001 F001 1000
5904 Phase TOC Curve 0 to 16 --- 1 F103 0 (IEEE Mod Inv)
5905 Phase TOC Multiplier 0 to 600 --- 0.01 F001 100
5906 Phase TOC Reset 0 to 1 --- 1 F104 0 (Instantaneous)
5907 Phase TOC Voltage Restraint 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
5908 Phase TOC Block For Each Phase (3 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
590B Phase TOC Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
590C Phase TOC Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
590D Reserved (3 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F001 0
5910 ...Repeated for module number 2
5920 ...Repeated for module number 3
5930 ...Repeated for module number 4
5940 ...Repeated for module number 5
5950 ...Repeated for module number 6
Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent (Read/Write Grouped Setting) (12 modules)
5A00 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
5A01 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Signal Source 0 to 5 --- 1 F167 0 (SRC 1)
5A02 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Pickup 0 to 30 pu 0.001 F001 1000
5A03 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Delay 0 to 600 s 0.01 F001 0
5A04 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Reset Delay 0 to 600 s 0.01 F001 0
5A05 Phase Inst OC 1 Block for each phase (3 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
5A08 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
5A09 Phase Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
5A0A Reserved (6 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F001 0
5A10 ...Repeated for module number 2
5A20 ...Repeated for module number 3
5A30 ...Repeated for module number 4
5A40 ...Repeated for module number 5
5A50 ...Repeated for module number 6
5A60 ...Repeated for module number 7
5A70 ...Repeated for module number 8
5A80 ...Repeated for module number 9
5A90 ...Repeated for module number 10
5AA0 ...Repeated for module number 11
5AB0 ...Repeated for module number 12
B 5E03
5E04
Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Delay
Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Reset Delay
0 to 600
0 to 600
s
s
0.01
0.01
F001
F001
0
0
5E05 Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
5E06 Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
5E07 Ground Instantaneous Overcurrent 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
5E08 Reserved (8 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F001 0
5E10 ...Repeated for module number 2
5E20 ...Repeated for module number 3
5E30 ...Repeated for module number 4
5E40 ...Repeated for module number 5
5E50 ...Repeated for module number 6
5E60 ...Repeated for module number 7
5E70 ...Repeated for module number 8
5E80 ...Repeated for module number 9
5E90 ...Repeated for module number 10
5EA0 ...Repeated for module number 11
5EB0 ...Repeated for module number 12
Transformer Percent Differential (Read/Write Grouped Setting)
6200 Percent Differential Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
6201 Percent Differential Pickup 0.05 to 1 pu 0.001 F001 100
6202 Percent Differential Slope 1 15 to 100 % 1 F001 25
6203 Percent Differential Break 1 1 to 2 pu 0.001 F001 2000
6204 Percent Differential Break 2 2 to 30 pu 0.001 F001 8000
6205 Percent Differential Slope 2 50 to 100 % 1 F001 100
6206 Inrush Inhibit Function 0 to 2 --- 1 F168 1 (Adapt. 2nd)
6207 Inrush Inhibit Level 1 to 40 % fo 0.1 F001 200
6208 Overexcitation Inhibit Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F169 0 (Disabled)
6209 Overexcitation Inhibit Level 1 to 40 % fo 0.1 F001 100
620A Percent Differential Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
620B Percent Differential Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
620C Percent Differential Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
620D Transformer Inrush Inhibit Mode 0 to 2 --- 1 F189 0 (Per phase)
Transformer Inst Differential (Read/Write Grouped Setting)
6220 Inst Differential Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
6221 Inst Differential Pickup 2 to 30 pu 0.001 F001 8000
6222 Inst Differential Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
6223 Inst Differential Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
6224 Inst Differential Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
Overfrequency (Read/Write Setting) (4 modules)
64D0 Overfrequency Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
64D1 Overfrequency Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
64D2 Overfrequency Source 0 to 5 --- 1 F167 0 (SRC 1)
64D3 Overfrequency Pickup 20 to 65 Hz 0.01 F001 6050
64D4 Overfrequency Pickup Delay 0 to 65.535 s 0.001 F001 500
64D5 Overfrequency Reset Delay 0 to 65.535 s 0.001 F001 500
64D6 Overfrequency Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
64D7 Overfrequency Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
64D8 Reserved (4 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F001 0
64DC ...Repeated for module number 2
B 730E
730F
DCMA Inputs x Range
DCMA Inputs x Minimum Value
0 to 6
-9999.999 to 9999.999
---
---
1
0.001
F173
F004
6 (4 to 20 mA)
4000
7311 DCMA Inputs x Maximum Value -9999.999 to 9999.999 --- 0.001 F004 20000
7313 DCMA Inputs x Reserved (5 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
7318 ...Repeated for module number 2
7330 ...Repeated for module number 3
7348 ...Repeated for module number 4
7360 ...Repeated for module number 5
7378 ...Repeated for module number 6
7390 ...Repeated for module number 7
73A8 ...Repeated for module number 8
73C0 ...Repeated for module number 9
73D8 ...Repeated for module number 10
73F0 ...Repeated for module number 11
7408 ...Repeated for module number 12
7420 ...Repeated for module number 13
7438 ...Repeated for module number 14
7450 ...Repeated for module number 15
7468 ...Repeated for module number 16
7480 ...Repeated for module number 17
7498 ...Repeated for module number 18
74B0 ...Repeated for module number 19
74C8 ...Repeated for module number 20
74E0 ...Repeated for module number 21
74F8 ...Repeated for module number 22
7510 ...Repeated for module number 23
7528 ...Repeated for module number 24
RTD Inputs (Read/Write Setting) (48 modules)
7540 RTD Inputs x Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
7541 RTD Inputs x ID --- --- --- F205 “RTD Ip 1 “
7547 RTD Inputs x Reserved 1 (4 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
754B RTD Inputs x Type 0 to 3 --- 1 F174 0 (100 Ω Platinum)
754C RTD Inputs x Reserved 2 (4 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
7550 ...Repeated for module number 2
7560 ...Repeated for module number 3
7570 ...Repeated for module number 4
7580 ...Repeated for module number 5
7590 ...Repeated for module number 6
75A0 ...Repeated for module number 7
75B0 ...Repeated for module number 8
75C0 ...Repeated for module number 9
75D0 ...Repeated for module number 10
75E0 ...Repeated for module number 11
75F0 ...Repeated for module number 12
7600 ...Repeated for module number 13
7610 ...Repeated for module number 14
7620 ...Repeated for module number 15
7630 ...Repeated for module number 16
7640 ...Repeated for module number 17
B 7F06
7F07
Neutral Overvoltage 1 Target
Neutral Overvoltage 1 Events
0 to 2
0 to 1
---
---
1
1
F109
F102
0 (Self-reset)
0 (Disabled)
7F08 Neutral Overvoltage 1 Reserved (8 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
7F10 ...Repeated for module number 2
7F20 ...Repeated for module number 3
Auxiliary Overvoltage (Read/Write Grouped Setting) (3 modules)
7F30 Auxiliary Overvoltage 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
7F31 Auxiliary Overvoltage 1 Signal Source 0 to 5 --- 1 F167 0 (SRC 1)
7F32 Auxiliary Overvoltage 1 Pickup 0 to 3 pu 0.001 F001 300
7F33 Auxiliary Overvoltage 1 Pickup Delay 0 to 600 s 0.01 F001 100
7F34 Auxiliary Overvoltage 1 Reset Delay 0 to 600 s 0.01 F001 100
7F35 Auxiliary Overvoltage 1 Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
7F36 Auxiliary Overvoltage 1 Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
7F37 Auxiliary Overvoltage 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
7F38 Auxiliary Overvoltage 1 Reserved (8 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
7F40 ...Repeated for module number 2
7F50 ...Repeated for module number 3
Auxiliary Undervoltage (Read/Write Grouped Setting) (3 modules)
7F60 Auxiliary UV 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
7F61 Auxiliary UV 1 Signal Source 0 to 5 --- 1 F167 0 (SRC 1)
7F62 Auxiliary UV 1 Pickup 0 to 3 pu 0.001 F001 700
7F63 Auxiliary UV 1 Delay 0 to 600 s 0.01 F001 100
7F64 Auxiliary UV 1 Curve 0 to 1 --- 1 F111 0 (Definite Time)
7F65 Auxiliary UV 1 Minimum Voltage 0 to 3 pu 0.001 F001 100
7F66 Auxiliary UV 1 Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
7F67 Auxiliary UV 1 Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
7F68 Auxiliary UV 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
7F69 Auxiliary UV 1 Reserved (7 items) 0 to 65535 --- 1 F001 0
7F70 ...Repeated for module number 2
7F80 ...Repeated for module number 3
Frequency (Read Only)
8000 Tracking Frequency 2 to 90 Hz 0.01 F001 0
FlexState Settings (Read/Write Setting)
8800 FlexState Parameters (256 items) --- --- --- F300 0
FlexElement (Read/Write Setting) (16 modules)
9000 FlexElement 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
9001 FlexElement 1 Name --- --- --- F206 “FxE 1 “
9004 FlexElement 1 InputP 0 to 65535 --- 1 F600 0
9005 FlexElement 1 InputM 0 to 65535 --- 1 F600 0
9006 FlexElement 1 Compare 0 to 1 --- 1 F516 0 (LEVEL)
9007 FlexElement 1 Input 0 to 1 --- 1 F515 0 (SIGNED)
9008 FlexElement 1 Direction 0 to 1 --- 1 F517 0 (OVER)
9009 FlexElement 1 Hysteresis 0.1 to 50 % 0.1 F001 30
900A FlexElement 1 Pickup -90 to 90 pu 0.001 F004 1000
900C FlexElement 1 DeltaT Units 0 to 2 --- 1 F518 0 (Milliseconds)
900D FlexElement 1 DeltaT 20 to 86400 --- 1 F003 20
900F FlexElement 1 Pickup Delay 0 to 65.535 s 0.001 F001 0
9010 FlexElement 1 Reset Delay 0 to 65.535 s 0.001 F001 0
9011 FlexElement 1 Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
B A41C
A41D
Selector 1 Target
Selector 1 Events
0 to 2
0 to 1
---
---
1
1
F109
F102
0 (Self-reset)
0 (Disabled)
A41E Selector 1 Reserved (10 items) --- --- --- --- ---
A428 ...Repeated for module number 2
Volts Per Hertz (Read/Write Grouped Setting) (2 modules)
AB00 V/Hz Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
AB01 V/Hz Source 0 to 5 --- 1 F167 0 (SRC 1)
AB02 V/Hz Pickup 0.8 to 4 pu 0.01 F001 80
AB03 V/Hz Curves 0 to 7 --- 1 F240 0 (Definite Time)
AB04 V/HZ TD Multiplier 0.05 to 600 --- 0.01 F001 100
AB05 V/Hz Block 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
AB08 V/Hz Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
AB09 V/Hz Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
AB0A Volts Per Hertz T Reset 0 to 1000 --- 0.1 F001 10
AB0B ...Repeated for module number 2
Volts Per Hertz Actuals (Read Only) (2 modules)
AB20 Volts Per Hertz 0 to 65.535 pu 0.001 F001 0
AB21 ...Repeated for module number 2
Flexcurve C (Read/Write Setting)
AC00 FlexCurve C (120 items) 0 to 65535 ms 1 F011 0
Flexcurve D (Read/Write Setting)
AC78 FlexCurve D (120 items) 0 to 65535 ms 1 F011 0
Non Volatile Latches (Read/Write Setting) (16 modules)
AD00 Latch 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
AD01 Latch 1 Type 0 to 1 --- 1 F519 0 (Reset Dominant)
AD02 Latch 1 Set 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
AD03 Latch 1 Reset 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
AD04 Latch 1 Target 0 to 2 --- 1 F109 0 (Self-reset)
AD05 Latch 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
AD06 Latch 1 Reserved (4 items) --- --- --- F001 0
AD0A ...Repeated for module number 2
AD14 ...Repeated for module number 3
AD1E ...Repeated for module number 4
AD28 ...Repeated for module number 5
AD32 ...Repeated for module number 6
AD3C ...Repeated for module number 7
AD46 ...Repeated for module number 8
AD50 ...Repeated for module number 9
AD5A ...Repeated for module number 10
AD64 ...Repeated for module number 11
AD6E ...Repeated for module number 12
AD78 ...Repeated for module number 13
AD82 ...Repeated for module number 14
AD8C ...Repeated for module number 15
AD96 ...Repeated for module number 16
Digital Elements (Read/Write Setting) (16 modules)
B000 Digital Element 1 Function 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
B001 Digital Element 1 Name --- --- --- F203 “Dig Element 1 “
B015 Digital Element 1 Input 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
B C068
C070
...Repeated for module number 14
...Repeated for module number 15
C078 ...Repeated for module number 16
C080 ...Repeated for module number 17
C088 ...Repeated for module number 18
C090 ...Repeated for module number 19
C098 ...Repeated for module number 20
C0A0 ...Repeated for module number 21
C0A8 ...Repeated for module number 22
C0B0 ...Repeated for module number 23
C0B8 ...Repeated for module number 24
C0C0 ...Repeated for module number 25
C0C8 ...Repeated for module number 26
C0D0 ...Repeated for module number 27
C0D8 ...Repeated for module number 28
C0E0 ...Repeated for module number 29
C0E8 ...Repeated for module number 30
C0F0 ...Repeated for module number 31
C0F8 ...Repeated for module number 32
C100 ...Repeated for module number 33
C108 ...Repeated for module number 34
C110 ...Repeated for module number 35
C118 ...Repeated for module number 36
C120 ...Repeated for module number 37
C128 ...Repeated for module number 38
C130 ...Repeated for module number 39
C138 ...Repeated for module number 40
C140 ...Repeated for module number 41
C148 ...Repeated for module number 42
C150 ...Repeated for module number 43
C158 ...Repeated for module number 44
C160 ...Repeated for module number 45
C168 ...Repeated for module number 46
C170 ...Repeated for module number 47
C178 ...Repeated for module number 48
C180 ...Repeated for module number 49
C188 ...Repeated for module number 50
C190 ...Repeated for module number 51
C198 ...Repeated for module number 52
C1A0 ...Repeated for module number 53
C1A8 ...Repeated for module number 54
C1B0 ...Repeated for module number 55
C1B8 ...Repeated for module number 56
C1C0 ...Repeated for module number 57
C1C8 ...Repeated for module number 58
C1D0 ...Repeated for module number 59
C1D8 ...Repeated for module number 60
C1E0 ...Repeated for module number 61
C1E8 ...Repeated for module number 62
B C770
C780
...Repeated for module number 15
...Repeated for module number 16
C790 ...Repeated for module number 17
C7A0 ...Repeated for module number 18
C7B0 ...Repeated for module number 19
C7C0 ...Repeated for module number 20
C7D0 ...Repeated for module number 21
C7E0 ...Repeated for module number 22
C7F0 ...Repeated for module number 23
C800 ...Repeated for module number 24
C810 ...Repeated for module number 25
C820 ...Repeated for module number 26
C830 ...Repeated for module number 27
C840 ...Repeated for module number 28
C850 ...Repeated for module number 29
C860 ...Repeated for module number 30
C870 ...Repeated for module number 31
C880 ...Repeated for module number 32
Virtual Outputs (Read/Write Setting) (64 modules)
CC90 Virtual Output x Name --- --- --- F205 “Virt Op 1 “
CC9A Virtual Output x Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
CC9B Virtual Output x Reserved (5 items) --- --- --- F001 0
CCA0 ...Repeated for module number 2
CCB0 ...Repeated for module number 3
CCC0 ...Repeated for module number 4
CCD0 ...Repeated for module number 5
CCE0 ...Repeated for module number 6
CCF0 ...Repeated for module number 7
CD00 ...Repeated for module number 8
CD10 ...Repeated for module number 9
CD20 ...Repeated for module number 10
CD30 ...Repeated for module number 11
CD40 ...Repeated for module number 12
CD50 ...Repeated for module number 13
CD60 ...Repeated for module number 14
CD70 ...Repeated for module number 15
CD80 ...Repeated for module number 16
CD90 ...Repeated for module number 17
CDA0 ...Repeated for module number 18
CDB0 ...Repeated for module number 19
CDC0 ...Repeated for module number 20
CDD0 ...Repeated for module number 21
CDE0 ...Repeated for module number 22
CDF0 ...Repeated for module number 23
CE00 ...Repeated for module number 24
CE10 ...Repeated for module number 25
CE20 ...Repeated for module number 26
CE30 ...Repeated for module number 27
CE40 ...Repeated for module number 28
B D340
D350
...Repeated for module number 12
...Repeated for module number 13
D360 ...Repeated for module number 14
D370 ...Repeated for module number 15
D380 ...Repeated for module number 16
D390 ...Repeated for module number 17
D3A0 ...Repeated for module number 18
D3B0 ...Repeated for module number 19
D3C0 ...Repeated for module number 20
D3D0 ...Repeated for module number 21
D3E0 ...Repeated for module number 22
D3F0 ...Repeated for module number 23
D400 ...Repeated for module number 24
D410 ...Repeated for module number 25
D420 ...Repeated for module number 26
D430 ...Repeated for module number 27
D440 ...Repeated for module number 28
D450 ...Repeated for module number 29
D460 ...Repeated for module number 30
D470 ...Repeated for module number 31
D480 ...Repeated for module number 32
D490 ...Repeated for module number 33
D4A0 ...Repeated for module number 34
D4B0 ...Repeated for module number 35
D4C0 ...Repeated for module number 36
D4D0 ...Repeated for module number 37
D4E0 ...Repeated for module number 38
D4F0 ...Repeated for module number 39
D500 ...Repeated for module number 40
D510 ...Repeated for module number 41
D520 ...Repeated for module number 42
D530 ...Repeated for module number 43
D540 ...Repeated for module number 44
D550 ...Repeated for module number 45
D560 ...Repeated for module number 46
D570 ...Repeated for module number 47
D580 ...Repeated for module number 48
D590 ...Repeated for module number 49
D5A0 ...Repeated for module number 50
D5B0 ...Repeated for module number 51
D5C0 ...Repeated for module number 52
D5D0 ...Repeated for module number 53
D5E0 ...Repeated for module number 54
D5F0 ...Repeated for module number 55
D600 ...Repeated for module number 56
D610 ...Repeated for module number 57
D620 ...Repeated for module number 58
D630 ...Repeated for module number 59
D640 ...Repeated for module number 60
B DB88
DB8C
...Repeated for module number 15
...Repeated for module number 16
DB90 ...Repeated for module number 17
DB94 ...Repeated for module number 18
DB98 ...Repeated for module number 19
DB9C ...Repeated for module number 20
DBA0 ...Repeated for module number 21
DBA4 ...Repeated for module number 22
DBA8 ...Repeated for module number 23
DBAC ...Repeated for module number 24
DBB0 ...Repeated for module number 25
DBB4 ...Repeated for module number 26
DBB8 ...Repeated for module number 27
DBBC ...Repeated for module number 28
DBC0 ...Repeated for module number 29
DBC4 ...Repeated for module number 30
DBC8 ...Repeated for module number 31
DBCC ...Repeated for module number 32
Platform Direct Outputs (Read/Write Setting) (96 modules)
DD00 Direct Output 1 Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
DD01 Direct Output 1 Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
DD02 ...Repeated for module number 2
DD04 ...Repeated for module number 3
DD06 ...Repeated for module number 4
DD08 ...Repeated for module number 5
DD0A ...Repeated for module number 6
DD0C ...Repeated for module number 7
DD0E ...Repeated for module number 8
DD10 ...Repeated for module number 9
DD12 ...Repeated for module number 10
DD14 ...Repeated for module number 11
DD16 ...Repeated for module number 12
DD18 ...Repeated for module number 13
DD1A ...Repeated for module number 14
DD1C ...Repeated for module number 15
DD1E ...Repeated for module number 16
DD20 ...Repeated for module number 17
DD22 ...Repeated for module number 18
DD24 ...Repeated for module number 19
DD26 ...Repeated for module number 20
DD28 ...Repeated for module number 21
DD2A ...Repeated for module number 22
DD2C ...Repeated for module number 23
DD2E ...Repeated for module number 24
DD30 ...Repeated for module number 25
DD32 ...Repeated for module number 26
DD34 ...Repeated for module number 27
DD36 ...Repeated for module number 28
DD38 ...Repeated for module number 29
B E138
E13C
...Repeated for module number 15
...Repeated for module number 16
E140 ...Repeated for module number 17
E144 ...Repeated for module number 18
E148 ...Repeated for module number 19
E14C ...Repeated for module number 20
E150 ...Repeated for module number 21
E154 ...Repeated for module number 22
E158 ...Repeated for module number 23
E15C ...Repeated for module number 24
E160 ...Repeated for module number 25
E164 ...Repeated for module number 26
E168 ...Repeated for module number 27
E16C ...Repeated for module number 28
E170 ...Repeated for module number 29
E174 ...Repeated for module number 30
E178 ...Repeated for module number 31
E17C ...Repeated for module number 32
Remote Output DNA Pairs (Read/Write Setting) (32 modules)
E600 Remote Output DNA x Operand 0 to 65535 --- 1 F300 0
E601 Remote Output DNA x Events 0 to 1 --- 1 F102 0 (Disabled)
E602 Remote Output DNA x Reserved (2 items) 0 to 1 --- 1 F001 0
E604 ...Repeated for module number 2
E608 ...Repeated for module number 3
E60C ...Repeated for module number 4
E610 ...Repeated for module number 5
E614 ...Repeated for module number 6
E618 ...Repeated for module number 7
E61C ...Repeated for module number 8
E620 ...Repeated for module number 9
E624 ...Repeated for module number 10
E628 ...Repeated for module number 11
E62C ...Repeated for module number 12
E630 ...Repeated for module number 13
E634 ...Repeated for module number 14
E638 ...Repeated for module number 15
E63C ...Repeated for module number 16
E640 ...Repeated for module number 17
E644 ...Repeated for module number 18
E648 ...Repeated for module number 19
E64C ...Repeated for module number 20
E650 ...Repeated for module number 21
E654 ...Repeated for module number 22
E658 ...Repeated for module number 23
E65C ...Repeated for module number 24
E660 ...Repeated for module number 25
E664 ...Repeated for module number 26
E668 ...Repeated for module number 27
E66C ...Repeated for module number 28
F001 F040
UR_UINT16 UNSIGNED 16 BIT INTEGER UR_UINT48 48-BIT UNSIGNED INTEGER
B F002
UR_SINT16 SIGNED 16 BIT INTEGER
F050
UR_UINT32 TIME and DATE (UNSIGNED 32 BIT INTEGER)
Gives the current time in seconds elapsed since 00:00:00 January
1, 1970.
F003
UR_UINT32 UNSIGNED 32 BIT INTEGER (2 registers)
High order word is stored in the first register. F051
Low order word is stored in the second register. UR_UINT32 DATE in SR format (alternate format for F050)
First 16 bits are Month/Day (MM/DD/xxxx). Month: 1=January,
2=February,...,12=December; Day: 1 to 31 in steps of 1
F004
Last 16 bits are Year (xx/xx/YYYY): 1970 to 2106 in steps of 1
UR_SINT32 SIGNED 32 BIT INTEGER (2 registers)
High order word is stored in the first register/
Low order word is stored in the second register. F052
UR_UINT32 TIME in SR format (alternate format for F050)
First 16 bits are Hours/Minutes (HH:MM:xx.xxx).
F005
Hours: 0=12am, 1=1am,...,12=12pm,...23=11pm;
UR_UINT8 UNSIGNED 8 BIT INTEGER
Minutes: 0 to 59 in steps of 1
Last 16 bits are Seconds (xx:xx:.SS.SSS): 0=00.000s,
F006 1=00.001,...,59999=59.999s)
UR_SINT8 SIGNED 8 BIT INTEGER
F060
F011 FLOATING_POINT IEE FLOATING POINT (32 bits)
UR_UINT16 FLEXCURVE DATA (120 points)
A FlexCurve is an array of 120 consecutive data points (x, y) which
F070
are interpolated to generate a smooth curve. The y-axis is the user
HEX2 2 BYTES - 4 ASCII DIGITS
defined trip or operation time setting; the x-axis is the pickup ratio
and is pre-defined. Refer to format F119 for a listing of the pickup
ratios; the enumeration value for the pickup ratio indicates the off-
F071
set into the FlexCurve base address where the corresponding time HEX4 4 BYTES - 8 ASCII DIGITS
value is stored.
F072
F012
HEX6 6 BYTES - 12 ASCII DIGITS
DISPLAY_SCALE DISPLAY SCALING
(unsigned 16-bit integer)
MSB indicates the SI units as a power of ten. LSB indicates the F073
number of decimal points to display. HEX8 8 BYTES - 16 ASCII DIGITS
Example: Current values are stored as 32 bit numbers with three
decimal places and base units in Amps. If the retrieved value is
F074
12345.678 A and the display scale equals 0x0302 then the dis-
HEX20 20 BYTES - 40 ASCII DIGITS
played value on the unit is 12.35 kA.
F083
F013
ENUMERATION: SELECTOR MODES
POWER_FACTOR PWR FACTOR (SIGNED 16 BIT INTEGER)
0 = Time-Out, 1 = Acknowledge
Positive values indicate lagging power factor; negative values indi-
cate leading.
F084
ENUMERATION: SELECTOR POWER UP
0 = Restore, 1 = Synchronize, 2 = Sync/Restore
F086 F106
ENUMERATION: DIGITAL INPUT DEFAULT STATE ENUMERATION: PHASE ROTATION
0 = Off, 1 = On, 2= Latest/Off, 3 = Latest/On 0 = ABC, 1 = ACB
F090 F108
ENUMERATION: LATCHING OUTPUT TYPE ENUMERATION: OFF/ON
0 = Operate-dominant, 1 = Reset-dominant 0 = Off, 1 = On B
F100 F109
ENUMERATION: VT CONNECTION TYPE ENUMERATION: CONTACT OUTPUT OPERATION
0 = Wye; 1 = Delta 0 = Self-reset, 1 = Latched, 2 = Disabled
F101 F110
ENUMERATION: MESSAGE DISPLAY INTENSITY ENUMERATION: CONTACT OUTPUT LED CONTROL
0 = 25%, 1 = 50%, 2 = 75%, 3 = 100% 0 = Trip, 1 = Alarm, 2 = None
F102 F111
ENUMERATION: DISABLED/ENABLED ENUMERATION: UNDERVOLTAGE CURVE SHAPES
0 = Disabled; 1 = Enabled 0 = Definite Time, 1 = Inverse Time
F103 F112
ENUMERATION: CURVE SHAPES ENUMERATION: RS485 BAUD RATES
bitmask curve shape bitmask curve shape bitmask value bitmask value bitmask value
0 IEEE Mod Inv 9 IAC Inverse 0 300 4 9600 8 115200
1 IEEE Very Inv 10 IAC Short Inv 1 1200 5 19200 9 14400
2 IEEE Ext Inv 11 I2t 2 2400 6 38400 10 28800
3 IEC Curve A 12 Definite Time 3 4800 7 57600 11 33600
4 IEC Curve B 13 FlexCurve™ A
5 IEC Curve C 14 FlexCurve™ B
F113
6 IEC Short Inv 15 FlexCurve™ C
ENUMERATION: PARITY
7 IAC Ext Inv 16 FlexCurve™ D
0 = None, 1 = Odd, 2 = Even
8 IAC Very Inv
F114
F104
ENUMERATION: IRIG-B SIGNAL TYPE
ENUMERATION: RESET TYPE
0 = None, 1 = DC Shift, 2 = Amplitude Modulated
0 = Instantaneous, 1 = Timed, 2 = Linear
F117
F105
ENUMERATION: NUMBER OF OSCILLOGRAPHY RECORDS
ENUMERATION: LOGIC INPUT
0 = 1×72 cycles, 1 = 3×36 cycles, 2 = 7×18 cycles, 3 = 15×9 cycles
0 = Disabled, 1 = Input 1, 2 = Input 2
F118
ENUMERATION: OSCILLOGRAPHY MODE
0 = Automatic Overwrite, 1 = Protected
bitmask element
F119
5 PHASE IOC6
ENUMERATION: FLEXCURVE™ PICKUP RATIOS
6 PHASE IOC7
mask value mask value mask value mask value 7 PHASE IOC8
0 0.00 30 0.88 60 2.90 90 5.90 8 PHASE IOC9
1 0.05 31 0.90 61 3.00 91 6.00 9 PHASE IOC10
2 0.10 32 0.91 62 3.10 92 6.50 10 PHASE IOC11
B 3 0.15 33 0.92 63 3.20 93 7.00 11 PHASE IOC12
4 0.20 34 0.93 64 3.30 94 7.50 16 PHASE TOC1
5 0.25 35 0.94 65 3.40 95 8.00 17 PHASE TOC2
6 0.30 36 0.95 66 3.50 96 8.50 18 PHASE TOC3
7 0.35 37 0.96 67 3.60 97 9.00 19 PHASE TOC4
8 0.40 38 0.97 68 3.70 98 9.50 20 PHASE TOC5
9 0.45 39 0.98 69 3.80 99 10.00 21 PHASE TOC6
10 0.48 40 1.03 70 3.90 100 10.50 24 PH DIR1
11 0.50 41 1.05 71 4.00 101 11.00 25 PH DIR2
12 0.52 42 1.10 72 4.10 102 11.50 32 NEUTRAL IOC1
13 0.54 43 1.20 73 4.20 103 12.00 33 NEUTRAL IOC2
14 0.56 44 1.30 74 4.30 104 12.50 34 NEUTRAL IOC3
15 0.58 45 1.40 75 4.40 105 13.00 35 NEUTRAL IOC4
16 0.60 46 1.50 76 4.50 106 13.50 36 NEUTRAL IOC5
17 0.62 47 1.60 77 4.60 107 14.00 37 NEUTRAL IOC6
18 0.64 48 1.70 78 4.70 108 14.50 38 NEUTRAL IOC7
19 0.66 49 1.80 79 4.80 109 15.00 39 NEUTRAL IOC8
20 0.68 50 1.90 80 4.90 110 15.50 40 NEUTRAL IOC9
21 0.70 51 2.00 81 5.00 111 16.00 41 NEUTRAL IOC10
22 0.72 52 2.10 82 5.10 112 16.50 42 NEUTRAL IOC11
23 0.74 53 2.20 83 5.20 113 17.00 43 NEUTRAL IOC12
24 0.76 54 2.30 84 5.30 114 17.50 48 NEUTRAL TOC1
25 0.78 55 2.40 85 5.40 115 18.00 49 NEUTRAL TOC2
26 0.80 56 2.50 86 5.50 116 18.50 50 NEUTRAL TOC3
27 0.82 57 2.60 87 5.60 117 19.00 51 NEUTRAL TOC4
28 0.84 58 2.70 88 5.70 118 19.50 52 NEUTRAL TOC5
29 0.86 59 2.80 89 5.80 119 20.00 53 NEUTRAL TOC6
56 NTRL DIR OC1
57 NTRL DIR OC2
F122
60 NEG SEQ DIR OC1
ENUMERATION: ELEMENT INPUT SIGNAL TYPE
61 NEG SEQ DIR OC2
0 = Phasor, 1 = RMS 64 GROUND IOC1
65 GROUND IOC2
F125 F138
ENUMERATION: ACCESS LEVEL ENUMERATION: OSCILLOGRAPHY FILE TYPE
0 = Restricted; 1 = Command, 2 = Setting, 3 = Factory Service 0 = Data File, 1 = Configuration File, 2 = Header File
F126 F140
ENUMERATION: NO/YES CHOICE ENUMERATION: CURRENT, SENS CURRENT, VOLTAGE,
B 0 = No, 1 = Yes
DISABLED
0 = Disabled, 1 = Current 46 A, 2 = Voltage 280 V, 3 = Current
4.6 A, 4 = Current 2 A, 5 = Notched 4.6 A, 6 = Notched 2 A
F127
ENUMERATION: LATCHED OR SELF-RESETTING
F141
0 = Latched, 1 = Self-Reset
ENUMERATION: SELF TEST ERROR
bitmask error
F128
0 ANY SELF TESTS
ENUMERATION: CONTACT INPUT THRESHOLD
1 IRIG-B FAILURE
0 = 17 V DC, 1 = 33 V DC, 2 = 84 V DC, 3 = 166 V DC
2 DSP ERROR
4 NO DSP INTERRUPTS
F129 5 UNIT NOT CALIBRATED
ENUMERATION: FLEXLOGIC TIMER TYPE 9 PROTOTYPE FIRMWARE
0 = millisecond, 1 = second, 2 = minute 10 FLEXLOGIC ERR TOKEN
11 EQUIPMENT MISMATCH
13 UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED
F130
14 SYSTEM EXCEPTION
ENUMERATION: SIMULATION MODE
15 LATCHING OUT ERROR
0 = Off. 1 = Pre-Fault, 2 = Fault, 3 = Post-Fault 18 SNTP FAILURE
19 BATTERY FAIL
F142
F135
ENUMERATION: EVENT RECORDER ACCESS FILE TYPE
ENUMERATION: GAIN CALIBRATION
0 = All Record Data, 1 = Headers Only, 2 = Numeric Event Cause
0 = 0x1, 1 = 1x16
F143
F136
UR_UINT32: 32 BIT ERROR CODE (F141 specifies bit number)
ENUMERATION: NUMBER OF OSCILLOGRAPHY RECORDS
A bit value of 0 = no error, 1 = error
0 = 31 x 8 cycles, 1 = 15 x 16 cycles, 2 = 7 x 32 cycles
3 = 3 x 64 cycles, 4 = 1 x 128 cycles
F144
ENUMERATION: FORCED CONTACT INPUT STATE
0 = Disabled, 1 = Open, 2 = Closed
F145 F151
ENUMERATION: ALPHABET LETTER ENUMERATION: RTD SELECTION
bitmask RTD# bitmask RTD# bitmask RTD#
bitmask type bitmask type bitmask type bitmask type
0 NONE 17 RTD 17 33 RTD 33
0 null 7 G 14 N 21 U
1 RTD 1 18 RTD 18 34 RTD 34
1 A 8 H 15 O 22 V
2 RTD 2 19 RTD 19 35 RTD 35
2 B 9 I 16 P 23 W
3 C 10 J 17 Q 24 X
3
4
RTD 3
RTD 4
20
21
RTD 20
RTD 21
36
37
RTD 36
RTD 37
B
4 D 11 K 18 R 25 Y
5 RTD 5 22 RTD 22 38 RTD 38
5 E 12 L 19 S 26 Z
6 RTD 6 23 RTD 23 39 RTD 39
6 F 13 M 20 T
7 RTD 7 24 RTD 24 40 RTD 40
8 RTD 8 25 RTD 25 41 RTD 41
F146 9 RTD 9 26 RTD 26 42 RTD 42
ENUMERATION: MISC. EVENT CAUSES 10 RTD 10 27 RTD 27 43 RTD 43
11 RTD 11 28 RTD 28 44 RTD 44
bitmask definition
12 RTD 12 29 RTD 29 45 RTD 45
0 EVENTS CLEARED
13 RTD 13 30 RTD 30 46 RTD 46
1 OSCILLOGRAPHY TRIGGERED
14 RTD 14 31 RTD 31 47 RTD 47
2 DATE/TIME CHANGED
15 RTD 15 32 RTD 32 48 RTD 48
3 DEF SETTINGS LOADED
16 RTD 16
4 TEST MODE ON
5 TEST MODE OFF
6 POWER ON
F152
7 POWER OFF ENUMERATION: SETTING GROUP
8 RELAY IN SERVICE
0 = Active Group, 1 = Group 1, 2 = Group 2, 3 = Group 3
9 RELAY OUT OF SERVICE 4 = Group 4, 5 = Group 5, 6 = Group 6
10 WATCHDOG RESET
11 OSCILLOGRAPHY CLEAR
12 REBOOT COMMAND F155
ENUMERATION: REMOTE DEVICE STATE
13 LED TEST INITIATED
14 FLASH PROGRAMMING 0 = Offline, 1 = Online
F156 F165
ENUMERATION: REMOTE INPUT BIT PAIRS ENUMERATION: TRANSFORMER TAP INPUT
0 = None, 1 = Tap Input 1, 2 = Tap Input 2, 3 = Auto-detect
bitmask RTD# bitmask RTD# bitmask RTD#
0 NONE 22 DNA-22 44 UserSt-12
1 DNA-1 23 DNA-23 45 UserSt-13 F166
2 DNA-2 24 DNA-24 46 UserSt-14 ENUMERATION: AUXILIARY VT CONNECTION TYPE
B 3 DNA-3 25 DNA-25 47 UserSt-15 0 = Vn, 1 = Vag, 2 = Vbg, 3 = Vcg, 4 = Vab, 5 = Vbc, 6 = Vca
4 DNA-4 26 DNA-26 48 UserSt-16
5 DNA-5 27 DNA-27 49 UserSt-17
6 DNA-6 28 DNA-28 50 UserSt-18 F167
ENUMERATION: SIGNAL SOURCE
7 DNA-7 29 DNA-29 51 UserSt-19
8 DNA-8 30 DNA-30 52 UserSt-20 0 = SRC 1, 1 = SRC 2, 2 = SRC 3, 3 = SRC 4,
4 = SRC 5, 5 = SRC 6
9 DNA-9 31 DNA-31 53 UserSt-21
10 DNA-10 32 DNA-32 54 UserSt-22
11 DNA-11 33 UserSt-1 55 UserSt-23 F168
12 DNA-12 34 UserSt-2 56 UserSt-24 ENUMERATION: INRUSH INHIBIT FUNCTION
13 DNA-13 35 UserSt-3 57 UserSt-25 0 = Disabled, 1 = Adapt. 2nd, 2 = Trad. 2nd
14 DNA-14 36 UserSt-4 58 UserSt-26
15 DNA-15 37 UserSt-5 59 UserSt-27
16 DNA-16 38 UserSt-6 60 UserSt-28 F169
ENUMERATION: OVEREXCITATION INHIBIT FUNCTION
17 DNA-17 39 UserSt-7 61 UserSt-29
18 DNA-18 40 UserSt-8 62 UserSt-30 0 = Disabled, 1 = 5th
19 DNA-19 41 UserSt-9 63 UserSt-31
20 DNA-20 42 UserSt-10 64 UserSt-32
F170
21 DNA-21 43 UserSt-11 ENUMERATION: LOW/HIGH OFFSET & GAIN
TRANSDUCER I/O SELECTION
0 = LOW, 1 = HIGH
F160
ENUMERATION: TRANSFORMER PHASE COMPENSATION
0 = Internal (software), 1 = External (with CTs) F171
ENUMERATION: TRANSDUCER CHANNEL INPUT TYPE
F173
F163 ENUMERATION: TRANSDUCER DCMA I/O RANGE
ENUMERATION: TRANSFORMER WINDING CONNECTION
0 = Wye, 1 = Delta, 2 = Zig-zag bitmask dcmA I/O range
0 0 to –1 mA
1 0 to 1 mA
F164
2 –1 to 1 mA
ENUMERATION: TRANSFORMER WINDING GROUNDING
3 0 to 5 mA
0 = Not within zone, 1 = Within zone 4 0 to 10 mA
5 0 to 20 mA
6 4 to 20 mA
F174 F190
ENUMERATION: TRANSDUCER RTD INPUT TYPE ENUMERATION: SIMULATED KEYPRESS
0 = 100 Ohm Platinum, 1 = 120 Ohm Nickel,
bitmsk keypress bitmsk keypress
2 = 100 Ohm Nickel, 3 = 10 Ohm Copper
0 --- 21 Escape
use between real keys
22 Enter
F175 1 1 23 Reset
ENUMERATION: PHASE LETTERS 2 2 24 User 1 B
0 = A, 1 = B, 2 = C 3 3 25 User 2
4 4 26 User 3
5 5 27 User-programmable key 1
F177
6 6 28 User-programmable key 2
ENUMERATION: COMMUNICATION PORT
7 7 29 User-programmable key 3
0 = NONE, 1 = COM1-RS485, 2 = COM2-RS485,
8 8 30 User-programmable key 4
3 = FRONT PANEL-RS232, 4 = NETWORK
9 9 31 User-programmable key 5
10 0 32 User-programmable key 6
F180 11 Decimal Pt 33 User-programmable key 7
ENUMERATION: PHASE/GROUND 12 Plus/Minus 34 User-programmable key 8
0 = PHASE, 1 = GROUND 13 Value Up 35 User-programmable key 9
14 Value Down 36 User-programmable key 10
15 Message Up 37 User-programmable key 11
F181
16 Message Down 38 User-programmable key 12
ENUMERATION: ODD/EVEN/NONE
17 Message Left 39 User 4 (control pushbutton)
0 = ODD, 1 = EVEN, 2 = NONE
18 Message Right 40 User 5 (control pushbutton)
19 Menu 41 User 6 (control pushbutton)
F183 20 Help 42 User 7 (control pushbutton)
ENUMERATION: AC INPUT WAVEFORMS
bitmask definition
F192
0 Off ENUMERATION: ETHERNET OPERATION MODE
1 8 samples/cycle
0 = Half-Duplex, 1 = Full-Duplex
2 16 samples/cycle
3 32 samples/cycle
4 64 samples/cycle F194
ENUMERATION: DNP SCALE
A bitmask of 0 = 0.01, 1 = 0.1, 2 = 1, 3 = 10, 4 = 100, 5 = 1000,
F185 6 = 10000, 7 = 100000, 8 = 0.001
ENUMERATION: PHASE A,B,C, GROUND SELECTOR
0 = A, 1 = B, 2 = C, 3 = G
F197
ENUMERATION: DNP BINARY INPUT POINT BLOCK
F186
bitmask Input Point Block
ENUMERATION: MEASUREMENT MODE
0 Not Used
0 = Phase to Ground, 1 = Phase to Phase
1 Virtual Inputs 1 to 16
2 Virtual Inputs 17 to 32
F189 3 Virtual Outputs 1 to 16
ENUMERATION: INRUSH INHIBIT MODE 4 Virtual Outputs 17 to 32
0 = Per Phase, 1 = 2-out-of-3, 2 = Average 5 Virtual Outputs 33 to 48
6 Virtual Outputs 49 to 64
7 Contact Inputs 1 to 16
8 Contact Inputs 17 to 32
9 Contact Inputs 33 to 48
10 Contact Inputs 49 to 64
11 Contact Inputs 65 to 80
F500
F511
UR_UINT16: PACKED BITFIELD BITFIELD: 3-PHASE SIMPLE ELEMENT STATE
First register indicates I/O state with bits 0(MSB)-15(LSB) corre- 0 = Operate, 1 = Operate A, 2 = Operate B, 3 = Operate C
sponding to I/0 state 1-16. The second register indicates I/O state
with bits 0-15 corresponding to I/0 state 17-32 (if required) The
third register indicates I/O state with bits 0-15 corresponding to I/0 F512
state 33-48 (if required). The fourth register indicates I/O state with
ENUMERATION: HARMONIC NUMBER
bits 0-15 corresponding to I/0 state 49-64 (if required).
The number of registers required is determined by the specific bitmask harmonic bitmask harmonic
data item. A bit value of 0 = Off, 1 = On 0 2ND 12 14TH
1 3RD 13 15TH
2 4TH 14 16TH
F501
UR_UINT16: LED STATUS 3 5TH 15 17TH
4 6TH 16 18TH
Low byte of register indicates LED status with bit 0 representing
5 7TH 17 19TH
the top LED and bit 7 the bottom LED. A bit value of 1 indicates
the LED is on, 0 indicates the LED is off. 6 8TH 18 20TH
7 9TH 19 21ST
8 10TH 20 22ND
F502
9 11TH 21 23RD
BITFIELD: ELEMENT OPERATE STATES
10 12TH 22 24TH
Each bit contains the operate state for an element. See the F124 11 13TH 23 25TH
format code for a list of element IDs. The operate bit for element ID
X is bit [X mod 16] in register [X/16].
F515 F530
ENUMERATION ELEMENT INPUT MODE ENUMERATION: FRONT PANEL INTERFACE KEYPRESS
0 = SIGNED, 1 = ABSOLUTE bitmask keypress bitmask keypress
0 None 22 Value Down
1 Menu 23 Reset
F516
2 Message Up 24 User 1
ENUMERATION ELEMENT COMPARE MODE
B 0 = LEVEL, 1 = DELTA
3
4
7
8
~
25
26
User 2
User 3
5 9 31 User PB 1
F517 6 Help 32 User PB 2
ENUMERATION: ELEMENT DIRECTION OPERATION 7 Message Left 33 User PB 3
F600
UR_UINT16: FLEXANALOG PARAMETER
The 16-bit value corresponds to the modbus address of the value
to be used when this parameter is selected. Only certain values
may be used as FlexAnalogs (basically all the metering quantities
used in protection)
The Utility Communications Architecture (UCA) Version 2 represents an attempt by utilities and vendors of electronic
equipment to produce standardized communications systems. There is a set of reference documents available from the
Electric Power Research Institute (EPRI) and vendors of UCA/MMS software libraries that describe the complete capabili-
ties of the UCA. Following, is a description of the subset of UCA/MMS features that are supported by the UR relay. The ref-
erence document set includes:
• Introduction to UCA version 2
• Generic Object Models for Substation and Feeder Equipment (GOMSFE)
• Common Application Service Models (CASM) and Mapping to MMS
• UCA Version 2 Profiles
These documents can be obtained from the UCA User’s Group at http://www.ucausersgroup.org. It is strongly recom-
mended that all those involved with any UCA implementation obtain this document set.
C
COMMUNICATION PROFILES:
The UCA specifies a number of possibilities for communicating with electronic devices based on the OSI Reference Model.
The UR relay uses the seven layer OSI stack (TP4/CLNP and TCP/IP profiles). Refer to the "UCA Version 2 Profiles" refer-
ence document for details.
The TP4/CLNP profile requires the UR relay to have a network address or Network Service Access Point (NSAP) in order
to establish a communication link. The TCP/IP profile requires the UR relay to have an IP address in order to establish a
communication link. These addresses are set in the SETTINGS PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS NETWORK
menu. Note that the UR relay supports UCA operation over the TP4/CLNP or the TCP/IP stacks and also supports opera-
tion over both stacks simultaneously. It is possible to have up to two simultaneous connections. This is in addition to DNP
and Modbus/TCP (non-UCA) connections.
C.1.2 MMS
a) DESCRIPTION
The UCA specifies the use of the Manufacturing Message Specification (MMS) at the upper (Application) layer for trans-
fer of real-time data. This protocol has been in existence for a number of years and provides a set of services suitable for
the transfer of data within a substation LAN environment. Data can be grouped to form objects and be mapped to MMS ser-
vices. Refer to the “GOMSFE” and “CASM” reference documents for details.
SUPPORTED OBJECTS:
The "GOMSFE" document describes a number of communication objects. Within these objects are items, some of which
are mandatory and some of which are optional, depending on the implementation. The UR relay supports the following
GOMSFE objects:
• DI (device identity) • PHIZ (high impedance ground detector)
• GCTL (generic control) • PIOC (instantaneous overcurrent relay)
• GIND (generic indicator) • POVR (overvoltage relay)
• GLOBE (global data) • PTOC (time overcurrent relay)
• MMXU (polyphase measurement unit) • PUVR (under voltage relay)
• PBRL (phase balance current relay) • PVPH (volts per hertz relay)
• PBRO (basic relay object) • ctRATO (CT ratio information)
• PDIF (differential relay) • vtRATO (VT ratio information)
• PDIS (distance) • RREC (reclosing relay)
• PDOC (directional overcurrent) • RSYN (synchronizing or synchronism-check relay)
• PDPR (directional power relay) • XCBR (circuit breaker)
• PFRQ (frequency relay)
PEER-TO-PEER COMMUNICATION:
Peer-to-peer communication of digital state information, using the UCA GOOSE data object, is supported via the use of the
UR Remote Inputs/Outputs feature. This feature allows digital points to be transferred between any UCA conforming
devices.
FILE SERVICES:
MMS file services are supported to allow transfer of Oscillography, Event Record, or other files from a UR relay.
COMMUNICATION SOFTWARE UTILITIES:
The exact structure and values of the implemented objects can be seen by connecting to a UR relay with an MMS browser,
such as the “MMS Object Explorer and AXS4-MMS DDE/OPC” server from Sisco Inc.
NON-UCA DATA:
C The UR relay makes available a number of non-UCA data items. These data items can be accessed through the "UR" MMS
domain. UCA data can be accessed through the "UCADevice" MMS domain.
NOTE GCTL1 = Virtual Inputs (32 total points – SI1 to SI32); includes SBO functionality.
NOTE 1 MMXU per Source (as determined from the ‘product order code’)
The following GOMSFE objects are defined by the object model described via the above table:
C
• PBRO (basic relay object)
• PDIF (differential relay)
• PDIS (distance)
• PDOC (directional overcurrent)
• PDPR (directional power relay)
• PFRQ (frequency relay)
• PHIZ (high impedance ground detector)
• PIOC (instantaneous overcurrent relay)
• POVR (over voltage relay)
• PTOC (time overcurrent relay)
• PUVR (under voltage relay)
• RSYN (synchronizing or synchronism-check relay)
• POVR (overvoltage)
• PVPH (volts per hertz relay)
• PBRL (phase balance current relay)
Actual instantiation of these objects is determined by the number of the corresponding elements present in the T60
as per the ‘product order code’.
NOTE
NOTE 1 ctRATO per Source (as determined from the product order code).
1 vtRATO per Source (as determined from the product order code).
Actual instantiation of RREC objects is determined by the number of autoreclose elements present in the T60 as
per the product order code.
NOTE
Also note that the Shots class data (i.e. Tmr1, Tmr2, Tmr3, Tmr4, RsTmr) is specified to be of type INT16S (16 bit
signed integer); this data type is not large enough to properly display the full range of these settings from the T60.
Numbers larger than 32768 will be displayed incorrectly.
Actual instantiation of XCBR objects is determined by the number of breaker control elements present in the T60 as
per the product order code.
NOTE
A built-in TCP/IP connection timeout of two minutes is employed by the UR to detect "dead" connections. If there is no data
traffic on a TCP connection for greater than two minutes, the connection will be aborted by the UR. This frees up the con-
nection to be used by other clients. Therefore, when using UCA reporting, clients should configure BasRCB objects such
that an integrity report will be issued at least every 2 minutes (120000 ms). This ensures that the UR will not abort the con-
nection. If other MMS data is being polled on the same connection at least once every 2 minutes, this timeout will not apply.
This document is adapted from the IEC 60870-5-104 standard. For ths section the boxes indicate the following: Ë
– used
in standard direction; Ë – not used; – cannot be selected in IEC 60870-5-104 standard.
1. SYSTEM OR DEVICE:
Ë System Definition
Ë Controlling Station Definition (Master)
Ë
Controlled Station Definition (Slave)
2. NETWORK CONFIGURATION:
Point-to-Point Multipoint
Multiple Point-to-Point Multipoint Star
3. PHYSICAL LAYER
Transmission Speed (control direction):
Unbalanced Interchange Unbalanced Interchange Balanced Interchange Circuit
Circuit V.24/V.28 Standard: Circuit V.24/V.28 Recommended X.24/X.27:
if >1200 bits/s: D
100 bits/sec. 2400 bits/sec. 2400 bits/sec.
200 bits/sec. 4800 bits/sec. 4800 bits/sec.
300 bits/sec. 9600 bits/sec. 9600 bits/sec.
600 bits/sec. 19200 bits/sec.
1200 bits/sec. 38400 bits/sec.
56000 bits/sec.
64000 bits/sec.
4. LINK LAYER
Link Transmission Procedure: Address Field of the Link:
Balanced Transmision Not Present (Balanced Transmission Only)
Unbalanced Transmission One Octet
Two Octets
Structured
Unstructured
Frame Length (maximum length, number of octets): Not selectable in companion IEC 60870-5-104 standard
When using an unbalanced link layer, the following ADSU types are returned in class 2 messages (low priority) with the
indicated causes of transmission:
The standard assignment of ADSUs to class 2 messages is used as follows:
5. APPLICATION LAYER
Transmission Mode for Application Data:
Mode 1 (least significant octet first), as defined in Clause 4.10 of IEC 60870-5-4, is used exclusively in this companion
stanadard.
Common Address of ADSU:
One Octet
Ë
Two Octets
Information Object Address:
One Octet Ë
Structured
D Two Octets Ë
Unstructured
Ë
Three Octets
Cause of Transmission:
One Octet
Ë
Two Octets (with originator address). Originator address is set to zero if not used.
Maximum Length of APDU: 253 (the maximum length may be reduced by the system.
Selection of standard ASDUs:
For the following lists, the boxes indicate the following: Ë
– used in standard direction; Ë – not used; – cannot be
selected in IEC 60870-5-104 standard.
Process information in monitor direction
Ë
<1> := Single-point information M_SP_NA_1
<2> := Single-point information with time tag M_SP_TA_1
Ë <3> := Double-point information M_DP_NA_1
<4> := Double-point information with time tag M_DP_TA_1
Ë <5> := Step position information M_ST_NA_1
<6> := Step position information with time tag M_ST_TA_1
Ë <7> := Bitstring of 32 bits M_BO_NA_1
<8> := Bitstring of 32 bits with time tag M_BO_TA_1
Ë <9> := Measured value, normalized value M_ME_NA_1
<10> := Measured value, normalized value with time tag M_NE_TA_1
Ë <11> := Measured value, scaled value M_ME_NB_1
<12> := Measured value, scaled value with time tag M_NE_TB_1
Ë
<13> := Measured value, short floating point value M_ME_NC_1
<14> := Measured value, short floating point value with time tag M_NE_TC_1
Ë
<15> := Integrated totals M_IT_NA_1
<16> := Integrated totals with time tag M_IT_TA_1
<17> := Event of protection equipment with time tag M_EP_TA_1
<18> := Packed start events of protection equipment with time tag M_EP_TB_1
<19> := Packed output circuit information of protection equipment with time tag M_EP_TC_1
Ë <20> := Packed single-point information with status change detection M_SP_NA_1
Ë
<30> := Single-point information with time tag CP56Time2a M_SP_TB_1
Ë <31> := Double-point information wiht time tag CP56Time2a M_DP_TB_1
Ë <32> := Step position information with time tag CP56Time2a M_ST_TB_1
Ë <33> := Bitstring of 32 bits with time tag CP56Time2a M_BO_TB_1
Ë <34> := Measured value, normalized value with time tag CP56Time2a M_ME_TD_1
Ë <35> := Measured value, scaled value with time tag CP56Time2a M_ME_TE_1
Ë <36> := Measured value, short floating point value with time tag CP56Time2a M_ME_TF_1
Ë
<37> := Integrated totals with time tag CP56Time2a M_IT_TB_1
Ë <38> := Event of protection equipment with time tag CP56Time2a M_EP_TD_1
Ë <39> := Packed start events of protection equipment with time tag CP56Time2a M_EP_TE_1
Ë <40> := Packed output circuit information of protection equipment with time tag CP56Time2a M_EP_TF_1
Either the ASDUs of the set <2>, <4>, <6>, <8>, <10>, <12>, <14>, <16>, <17>, <18>, and <19> or of the set
<30> to <40> are used.
Process information in control direction
Ë
<45> := Single command C_SC_NA_1
D
Ë <46> := Double command C_DC_NA_1
Ë <47> := Regulating step command C_RC_NA_1
Ë <48> := Set point command, normalized value C_SE_NA_1
Ë <49> := Set point command, scaled value C_SE_NB_1
Ë <50> := Set point command, short floating point value C_SE_NC_1
Ë <51> := Bitstring of 32 bits C_BO_NA_1
Ë
<58> := Single command with time tag CP56Time2a C_SC_TA_1
Ë <59> := Double command with time tag CP56Time2a C_DC_TA_1
Ë <60> := Regulating step command with time tag CP56Time2a C_RC_TA_1
Ë <61> := Set point command, normalized value with time tag CP56Time2a C_SE_TA_1
Ë <62> := Set point command, scaled value with time tag CP56Time2a C_SE_TB_1
Ë <63> := Set point command, short floating point value with time tag CP56Time2a C_SE_TC_1
Ë <64> := Bitstring of 32 bits with time tag CP56Time2a C_BO_TA_1
Either the ASDUs of the set <45> to <51> or of the set <58> to <64> are used.
System information in monitor direction
Ë
<70> := End of initialization M_EI_NA_1
File transfer
Ë <120> := File Ready F_FR_NA_1
Ë <121> := Section Ready F_SR_NA_1
Ë <122> := Call directory, select file, call file, call section F_SC_NA_1
Ë <123> := Last section, last segment F_LS_NA_1
Ë <124> := Ack file, ack section F_AF_NA_1
Ë <125> := Segment F_SG_NA_1
Ë <126> := Directory (blank or X, available only in monitor [standard] direction) C_CD_NA_1
ACTIVATION TERMINATION
REQUEST OR REQUESTED
BACKGROUND SCAN
PERIODIC, CYCLIC
FILE TRANSFER
SPONTANEOUS
DEACTIVATION
ACTIVATION
INITIALIZED
20 37
NO. MNEMONIC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 to to 44 45 46 47
36 41
<1> M_SP_NA_1 X X X X X
<2> M_SP_TA_1
<3> M_DP_NA_1
<4> M_DP_TA_1
<5> M_ST_NA_1
<6> M_ST_TA_1
<7> M_BO_NA_1
<8> M_BO_TA_1
ACTIVATION TERMINATION
REQUEST OR REQUESTED
BACKGROUND SCAN
PERIODIC, CYCLIC
FILE TRANSFER
SPONTANEOUS
DEACTIVATION
ACTIVATION
INITIALIZED
20 37
NO. MNEMONIC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 to to 44 45 46 47
36 41
<9> M_ME_NA_1 D
<10> M_ME_TA_1
<11> M_ME_NB_1
<12> M_ME_TB_1
<13> M_ME_NC_1 X X X X
<14> M_ME_TC_1
<15> M_IT_NA_1 X X
<16> M_IT_TA_1
<17> M_EP_TA_1
<18> M_EP_TB_1
<19> M_EP_TC_1
<20> M_PS_NA_1
<21> M_ME_ND_1
<30> M_SP_TB_1 X X X
<31> M_DP_TB_1
<32> M_ST_TB_1
<33> M_BO_TB_1
<34> M_ME_TD_1
<35> M_ME_TE_1
<36> M_ME_TF_1
<37> M_IT_TB_1 X X
<38> M_EP_TD_1
<39> M_EP_TE_1
<40> M_EP_TF_1
<45> C_SC_NA_1 X X X X X
<46> C_DC_NA_1
<47> C_RC_NA_1
<48> C_SE_NA_1
<49> C_SE_NB_1
ACTIVATION TERMINATION
REQUEST OR REQUESTED
BACKGROUND SCAN
PERIODIC, CYCLIC
FILE TRANSFER
SPONTANEOUS
DEACTIVATION
ACTIVATION
INITIALIZED
20 37
NO. MNEMONIC 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 to to 44 45 46 47
36 41
D <50> C_SE_NC_1
<51> C_BO_NA_1
<58> C_SC_TA_1 X X X X X
<59> C_DC_TA_1
<60> C_RC_TA_1
<61> C_SE_TA_1
<62> C_SE_TB_1
<63> C_SE_TC_1
<64> C_BO_TA_1
<70> M_EI_NA_1*) X
<100> C_IC_NA_1 X X X X X
<101> C_CI_NA_1 X X X
<102> C_RD_NA_1 X
<103> C_CS_NA_1 X X X
<104> C_TS_NA_1
<105> C_RP_NA_1 X X
<106> C_CD_NA_1
<107> C_TS_TA_1
<110> P_ME_NA_1
<111> P_ME_NB_1
<112> P_ME_NC_1 X X X
<113> P_AC_NA_1
<120> F_FR_NA_1
<121> F_SR_NA_1
<122> F_SC_NA_1
<123> F_LS_NA_1
<124> F_AF_NA_1
<125> F_SG_NA_1
<126> F_DR_TA_1*)
Ë
Global
Ë
Group 1 Ë
Group 5 Ë
Group 9 Ë
Group 13
Ë
Group 2 Ë
Group 6 Ë
Group 10 Ë
Group 14
Ë
Group 3 Ë
Group 7 Ë
Group 11 Ë
Group 15
Ë
Group 4 Ë
Group 8 Ë
Group 12 Ë
Group 16
Clock synchronization:
Ë
Clock synchronization (optional, see Clause 7.6)
Command transmission:
Ë
Direct command transmission
Ë
Supervision of maximum delay in command direction of commands and setpoint commands
Maximum allowable delay of commands and setpoint commands: 10 s
Ë
Counter read
Ë
Counter freeze without reset
Ë
Counter freeze with reset
Ë
Counter reset
Ë
General request counter
Ë
Request counter group 1
Ë
Request counter group 2
D Ë
Request counter group 3
Ë
Request counter group 4
Parameter loading:
Ë
Threshold value
Ë Smoothing factor
Ë Low limit for transmission of measured values
Ë High limit for transmission of measured values
Parameter activation:
Ë Activation/deactivation of persistent cyclic or periodic transmission of the addressed object
Test procedure:
Ë Test procedure
File transfer:
File transfer in monitor direction:
Ë Transparent file
Ë Transmission of disturbance data of protection equipment
Ë Transmission of sequences of events
Ë Transmission of sequences of recorded analog values
File transfer in control direction:
Ë Transparent file
Background scan:
Ë Background scan
Acquisition of transmission delay:
Acquisition of transmission delay
Only Source 1 data points are shown in the following table. If the NUMBER OF SOURCES IN MMENC1 LIST setting is increased,
data points for subsequent sources will be added to the list immediately following the Source 1 data points.
Table D–1: IEC 60870-5-104 POINTS (Sheet 1 of 6) Table D–1: IEC 60870-5-104 POINTS (Sheet 2 of 6)
POINT DESCRIPTION POINT DESCRIPTION
M_ME_NC_1 Points 2047 SRC 1 Positive Sequence Voltage Angle
2000 SRC 1 Phase A Current RMS 2048 SRC 1 Negative Sequence Voltage Magnitude
2001 SRC 1 Phase B Current RMS 2049 SRC 1 Negative Sequence Voltage Angle
2002 SRC 1 Phase C Current RMS 2050 SRC 1 Three Phase Real Power
2003 SRC 1 Neutral Current RMS 2051 SRC 1 Phase A Real Power
2004 SRC 1 Phase A Current Magnitude 2052 SRC 1 Phase B Real Power
2005 SRC 1 Phase A Current Angle 2053 SRC 1 Phase C Real Power
2006 SRC 1 Phase B Current Magnitude 2054 SRC 1 Three Phase Reactive Power
2007 SRC 1 Phase B Current Angle 2055 SRC 1 Phase A Reactive Power
2008 SRC 1 Phase C Current Magnitude 2056 SRC 1 Phase B Reactive Power
2009 SRC 1 Phase C Current Angle 2057 SRC 1 Phase C Reactive Power
D 2010 SRC 1 Neutral Current Magnitude 2058 SRC 1 Three Phase Apparent Power
2011 SRC 1 Neutral Current Angle 2059 SRC 1 Phase A Apparent Power
2012 SRC 1 Ground Current RMS 2060 SRC 1 Phase B Apparent Power
2013 SRC 1 Ground Current Magnitude 2061 SRC 1 Phase C Apparent Power
2014 SRC 1 Ground Current Angle 2062 SRC 1 Three Phase Power Factor
2015 SRC 1 Zero Sequence Current Magnitude 2063 SRC 1 Phase A Power Factor
2016 SRC 1 Zero Sequence Current Angle 2064 SRC 1 Phase B Power Factor
2017 SRC 1 Positive Sequence Current Magnitude 2065 SRC 1 Phase C Power Factor
2018 SRC 1 Positive Sequence Current Angle 2066 SRC 1 Positive Watthour
2019 SRC 1 Negative Sequence Current Magnitude 2067 SRC 1 Negative Watthour
2020 SRC 1 Negative Sequence Current Angle 2068 SRC 1 Positive Varhour
2021 SRC 1 Differential Ground Current Magnitude 2069 SRC 1 Negative Varhour
2022 SRC 1 Differential Ground Current Angle 2070 SRC 1 Frequency
2023 SRC 1 Phase AG Voltage RMS 2071 SRC 1 Demand Ia
2024 SRC 1 Phase BG Voltage RMS 2072 SRC 1 Demand Ib
2025 SRC 1 Phase CG Voltage RMS 2073 SRC 1 Demand Ic
2026 SRC 1 Phase AG Voltage Magnitude 2074 SRC 1 Demand Watt
2027 SRC 1 Phase AG Voltage Angle 2075 SRC 1 Demand Var
2028 SRC 1 Phase BG Voltage Magnitude 2076 SRC 1 Demand Va
2029 SRC 1 Phase BG Voltage Angle 2077 SRC 1 Ia THD
2030 SRC 1 Phase CG Voltage Magnitude 2078 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[0]
2031 SRC 1 Phase CG Voltage Angle 2079 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[1]
2032 SRC 1 Phase AB Voltage RMS 2080 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[2]
2033 SRC 1 Phase BC Voltage RMS 2081 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[3]
2034 SRC 1 Phase CA Voltage RMS 2082 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[4]
2035 SRC 1 Phase AB Voltage Magnitude 2083 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[5]
2036 SRC 1 Phase AB Voltage Angle 2084 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[6]
2037 SRC 1 Phase BC Voltage Magnitude 2085 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[7]
2038 SRC 1 Phase BC Voltage Angle 2086 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[8]
2039 SRC 1 Phase CA Voltage Magnitude 2087 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[9]
2040 SRC 1 Phase CA Voltage Angle 2088 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[10]
2041 SRC 1 Auxiliary Voltage RMS 2089 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[11]
2042 SRC 1 Auxiliary Voltage Magnitude 2090 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[12]
2043 SRC 1 Auxiliary Voltage Angle 2091 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[13]
2044 SRC 1 Zero Sequence Voltage Magnitude 2092 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[14]
2045 SRC 1 Zero Sequence Voltage Angle 2093 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[15]
2046 SRC 1 Positive Sequence Voltage Magnitude 2094 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[16]
Table D–1: IEC 60870-5-104 POINTS (Sheet 3 of 6) Table D–1: IEC 60870-5-104 POINTS (Sheet 4 of 6)
POINT DESCRIPTION POINT DESCRIPTION
2095 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[17] 2149 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[21]
2096 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[18] 2150 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[22]
2097 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[19] 2151 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[23]
2098 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[20] 2152 Transformer Reference Winding
2099 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[21] 2153 Transformer Differential Phasor Iad Magnitude
2100 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[22] 2154 Transformer Differential Phasor Iad Angle
2101 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[23] 2155 Transformer Restraint Phasor Iar Magnitude
2102 SRC 1 Ib THD 2156 Transformer Restraint Phasor Iar Angle
2103 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[0] 2157 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Iad Magnitude
2104 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[1] 2158 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Iad Angle
2105 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[2] 2159 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Iad Magnitude
2106 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[3] 2160 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Iad Angle
2107 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[4] 2161 Transformer Differential Phasor Ibd Magnitude
2108 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[5] 2162 Transformer Differential Phasor Ibd Angle
2109 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[6] 2163 Transformer Restraint Phasor Ibr Magnitude
2110 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[7] 2164 Transformer Restraint Phasor Ibr Angle
2111 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[8] 2165 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Ibd Magnitude
2112 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[9] 2166 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Ibd Angle D
2113 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[10] 2167 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Ibd Magnitude
2114 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[11] 2168 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Ibd Angle
2115 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[12] 2169 Transformer Differential Phasor Icd Magnitude
2116 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[13] 2170 Transformer Differential Phasor Icd Angle
2117 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[14] 2171 Transformer Restraint Phasor Icr Magnitude
2118 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[15] 2172 Transformer Restraint Phasor Icr Angle
2119 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[16] 2173 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Icd Magnitude
2120 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[17] 2174 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Icd Angle
2121 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[18] 2175 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Icd Magnitude
2122 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[19] 2176 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Icd Angle
2123 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[20] 2177 DCMA Inputs 1 Value
2124 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[21] 2178 DCMA Inputs 2 Value
2125 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[22] 2179 DCMA Inputs 3 Value
2126 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[23] 2180 DCMA Inputs 4 Value
2127 SRC 1 Ic THD 2181 DCMA Inputs 5 Value
2128 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[0] 2182 DCMA Inputs 6 Value
2129 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[1] 2183 DCMA Inputs 7 Value
2130 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[2] 2184 DCMA Inputs 8 Value
2131 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[3] 2185 DCMA Inputs 9 Value
2132 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[4] 2186 DCMA Inputs 10 Value
2133 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[5] 2187 DCMA Inputs 11 Value
2134 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[6] 2188 DCMA Inputs 12 Value
2135 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[7] 2189 DCMA Inputs 13 Value
2136 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[8] 2190 DCMA Inputs 14 Value
2137 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[9] 2191 DCMA Inputs 15 Value
2138 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[10] 2192 DCMA Inputs 16 Value
2139 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[11] 2193 DCMA Inputs 17 Value
2140 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[12] 2194 DCMA Inputs 18 Value
2141 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[13] 2195 DCMA Inputs 19 Value
2142 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[14] 2196 DCMA Inputs 20 Value
2143 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[15] 2197 DCMA Inputs 21 Value
2144 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[16] 2198 DCMA Inputs 22 Value
2145 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[17] 2199 DCMA Inputs 23 Value
2146 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[18] 2200 DCMA Inputs 24 Value
2147 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[19] 2201 RTD Inputs 1 Value
2148 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[20] 2202 RTD Inputs 2 Value
Table D–1: IEC 60870-5-104 POINTS (Sheet 5 of 6) Table D–1: IEC 60870-5-104 POINTS (Sheet 6 of 6)
POINT DESCRIPTION POINT DESCRIPTION
2203 RTD Inputs 3 Value 2257 FlexElement 8 Actual
2204 RTD Inputs 4 Value 2258 FlexElement 9 Actual
2205 RTD Inputs 5 Value 2259 FlexElement 10 Actual
2206 RTD Inputs 6 Value 2260 FlexElement 11 Actual
2207 RTD Inputs 7 Value 2261 FlexElement 12 Actual
2208 RTD Inputs 8 Value 2262 FlexElement 13 Actual
2209 RTD Inputs 9 Value 2263 FlexElement 14 Actual
2210 RTD Inputs 10 Value 2264 FlexElement 15 Actual
2211 RTD Inputs 11 Value 2265 FlexElement 16 Actual
2212 RTD Inputs 12 Value 2266 Current Setting Group
2213 RTD Inputs 13 Value 2267 VHZ 1 Actual
2214 RTD Inputs 14 Value 2268 VHZ 2 Actual
2215 RTD Inputs 15 Value P_ME_NC_1 Points
2216 RTD Inputs 16 Value 5000 - Threshold values for M_ME_NC_1 points
5268
2217 RTD Inputs 17 Value
M_SP_NA_1 Points
2218 RTD Inputs 18 Value
100 - 115 Virtual Input States[0]
2219 RTD Inputs 19 Value
D 2220 RTD Inputs 20 Value
116 - 131
132 - 147
Virtual Input States[1]
Virtual Output States[0]
2221 RTD Inputs 21 Value
148 - 163 Virtual Output States[1]
2222 RTD Inputs 22 Value
164 - 179 Virtual Output States[2]
2223 RTD Inputs 23 Value
180 - 195 Virtual Output States[3]
2224 RTD Inputs 24 Value
196 - 211 Contact Input States[0]
2225 RTD Inputs 25 Value
212 - 227 Contact Input States[1]
2226 RTD Inputs 26 Value
228 - 243 Contact Input States[2]
2227 RTD Inputs 27 Value
244 - 259 Contact Input States[3]
2228 RTD Inputs 28 Value
260 - 275 Contact Input States[4]
2229 RTD Inputs 29 Value
276 - 291 Contact Input States[5]
2230 RTD Inputs 30 Value
292 - 307 Contact Output States[0]
2231 RTD Inputs 31 Value
308 - 323 Contact Output States[1]
2232 RTD Inputs 32 Value
324 - 339 Contact Output States[2]
2233 RTD Inputs 33 Value
340 - 355 Contact Output States[3]
2234 RTD Inputs 34 Value
356 - 371 Remote Input x States[0]
2235 RTD Inputs 35 Value
372 - 387 Remote Input x States[1]
2236 RTD Inputs 36 Value
388 - 403 Remote Device x States
2237 RTD Inputs 37 Value
404 - 419 LED Column x State[0]
2238 RTD Inputs 38 Value
420 - 435 LED Column x State[1]
2239 RTD Inputs 39 Value
C_SC_NA_1 Points
2240 RTD Inputs 40 Value
1100 - 1115 Virtual Input States[0] - No Select Required
2241 RTD Inputs 41 Value
1116 - 1131 Virtual Input States[1] - Select Required
2242 RTD Inputs 42 Value
M_IT_NA_1 Points
2243 RTD Inputs 43 Value
4000 Digital Counter 1 Value
2244 RTD Inputs 44 Value
4001 Digital Counter 2 Value
2245 RTD Inputs 45 Value
4002 Digital Counter 3 Value
2246 RTD Inputs 46 Value
4003 Digital Counter 4 Value
2247 RTD Inputs 47 Value
4004 Digital Counter 5 Value
2248 RTD Inputs 48 Value
4005 Digital Counter 6 Value
2249 Tracking Frequency
4006 Digital Counter 7 Value
2250 FlexElement 1 Actual
4007 Digital Counter 8 Value
2251 FlexElement 2 Actual
2252 FlexElement 3 Actual
2253 FlexElement 4 Actual
2254 FlexElement 5 Actual
2255 FlexElement 6 Actual
2256 FlexElement 7 Actual
The following table provides a ‘Device Profile Document’ in the standard format defined in the DNP 3.0 Subset Definitions
Document.
Notable objects, functions, and/or qualifiers supported in addition to the Highest DNP Levels Supported (the complete
list is described in the attached table):
Binary Inputs (Object 1)
Binary Input Changes (Object 2)
Binary Outputs (Object 10)
Binary Counters (Object 20)
Frozen Counters (Object 21)
E
Counter Change Event (Object 22)
Frozen Counter Event (Object 23)
Analog Inputs (Object 30)
Analog Input Changes (Object 32)
Analog Deadbands (Object 34)
Maximum Data Link Frame Size (octets): Maximum Application Fragment Size (octets):
Transmitted: 292 Transmitted: 240
Received: 292 Received: 2048
Others:
Transmission Delay: No intentional delay
Inter-character Timeout: 50 ms
Need Time Delay: Configurable (default = 24 hrs.)
Select/Operate Arm Timeout: 10 s
Binary input change scanning period: 8 times per power system cycle
Count > 1 Ë
Never Ë Always Ë Sometimes Ë Configurable
Pulse On Ë Never Ë Always Ë
Sometimes Ë Configurable
Pulse Off Ë Never Ë Always Ë
Sometimes Ë Configurable
Latch On Ë Never Ë Always Ë
Sometimes Ë Configurable
Latch Off Ë Never Ë Always Ë
Sometimes Ë Configurable
Queue Ë
Never Ë Always Ë Sometimes Ë Configurable
Clear Queue Ë
Never Ë Always Ë Sometimes Ë Configurable
Explanation of ‘Sometimes’: Object 12 points are mapped to UR Virtual Inputs. The persistence of Virtual Inputs is
determined by the VIRTUAL INPUT X TYPE settings. Both “Pulse On” and “Latch On” operations perform the same func-
tion in the UR; that is, the appropriate Virtual Input is put into the “On” state. If the Virtual Input is set to “Self-Reset”,
it will reset after one pass of FlexLogic™. The On/Off times and Count value are ignored. “Pulse Off” and “Latch Off”
operations put the appropriate Virtual Input into the “Off” state. “Trip” and “Close” operations both put the appropriate
Virtual Input into the “On” state.
Reports Binary Input Change Events when no Reports time-tagged Binary Input Change Events when no
specific variation requested: specific variation requested:
Ë Never Ë Never
Ë
Only time-tagged Ë
Binary Input Change With Time
Ë Only non-time-tagged Ë Binary Input Change With Relative Time
Ë Configurable Ë Configurable (attach explanation)
The following table identifies the variations, function codes, and qualifiers supported by the UR in both request messages
and in response messages. For static (non-change-event) objects, requests sent with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, will be
responded with qualifiers 00 or 01. Static object requests sent with qualifiers 17 or 28 will be responded with qualifiers 17 or
28. For change-event objects, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded.
Table E–2: IMPLEMENTATION TABLE (Sheet 1 of 4)
OBJECT REQUEST RESPONSE
OBJECT VARIATION DESCRIPTION FUNCTION QUALIFIER FUNCTION QUALIFIER
NO. NO. CODES (DEC) CODES (HEX) CODES (DEC) CODES (HEX)
1 0 Binary Input (Variation 0 is used to request 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
default variation) 22 (assign class) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
17, 28 (index)
1 Binary Input 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
22 (assign class) 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) (see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
2 Binary Input with Status 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default – see Note 1) 22 (assign class) 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) (see Note 2)
17, 28 (index)
2 0 Binary Input Change (Variation 0 is used to 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
request default variation) 07, 08 (limited quantity)
1 Binary Input Change without Time 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 (response) 17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited quantity) 130 (unsol. resp.)
2 Binary Input Change with Time 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 (response 17, 28 (index)
E 3
(default – see Note 1)
Binary Input Change with Relative Time 1 (read)
07, 08 (limited quantity)
06 (no range, or all)
130 (unsol. resp.)
The following table lists both Binary Counters (Object 20) and Frozen Counters (Object 21). When a freeze function is per-
formed on a Binary Counter point, the frozen value is available in the corresponding Frozen Counter point.
Table E–3: BINARY INPUTS (Sheet 1 of 10) Table E–3: BINARY INPUTS (Sheet 2 of 10)
POINT NAME/DESCRIPTION CHANGE EVENT POINT NAME/DESCRIPTION CHANGE EVENT
INDEX CLASS (1/2/3/NONE) INDEX CLASS (1/2/3/NONE)
0 Virtual Input 1 2 32 Virtual Output 1 2
1 Virtual Input 2 2 33 Virtual Output 2 2
2 Virtual Input 3 2 34 Virtual Output 3 2
E 3 Virtual Input 4 2 35 Virtual Output 4 2
4 Virtual Input 5 2 36 Virtual Output 5 2
5 Virtual Input 6 2 37 Virtual Output 6 2
6 Virtual Input 7 2 38 Virtual Output 7 2
7 Virtual Input 8 2 39 Virtual Output 8 2
8 Virtual Input 9 2 40 Virtual Output 9 2
9 Virtual Input 10 2 41 Virtual Output 10 2
10 Virtual Input 11 2 42 Virtual Output 11 2
11 Virtual Input 12 2 43 Virtual Output 12 2
12 Virtual Input 13 2 44 Virtual Output 13 2
13 Virtual Input 14 2 45 Virtual Output 14 2
14 Virtual Input 15 2 46 Virtual Output 15 2
15 Virtual Input 16 2 47 Virtual Output 16 2
16 Virtual Input 17 2 48 Virtual Output 17 2
17 Virtual Input 18 2 49 Virtual Output 18 2
18 Virtual Input 19 2 50 Virtual Output 19 2
19 Virtual Input 20 2 51 Virtual Output 20 2
20 Virtual Input 21 2 52 Virtual Output 21 2
21 Virtual Input 22 2 53 Virtual Output 22 2
22 Virtual Input 23 2 54 Virtual Output 23 2
23 Virtual Input 24 2 55 Virtual Output 24 2
24 Virtual Input 25 2 56 Virtual Output 25 2
25 Virtual Input 26 2 57 Virtual Output 26 2
26 Virtual Input 27 2 58 Virtual Output 27 2
27 Virtual Input 28 2 59 Virtual Output 28 2
28 Virtual Input 29 2 60 Virtual Output 29 2
29 Virtual Input 30 2 61 Virtual Output 30 2
30 Virtual Input 31 2 62 Virtual Output 31 2
31 Virtual Input 32 2 63 Virtual Output 32 2
Table E–3: BINARY INPUTS (Sheet 3 of 10) Table E–3: BINARY INPUTS (Sheet 4 of 10)
POINT NAME/DESCRIPTION CHANGE EVENT POINT NAME/DESCRIPTION CHANGE EVENT
INDEX CLASS (1/2/3/NONE) INDEX CLASS (1/2/3/NONE)
64 Virtual Output 33 2 113 Contact Input 18 1
65 Virtual Output 34 2 114 Contact Input 19 1
66 Virtual Output 35 2 115 Contact Input 20 1
67 Virtual Output 36 2 116 Contact Input 21 1
68 Virtual Output 37 2 117 Contact Input 22 1
69 Virtual Output 38 2 118 Contact Input 23 1
70 Virtual Output 39 2 119 Contact Input 24 1
71 Virtual Output 40 2 120 Contact Input 25 1
72 Virtual Output 41 2 121 Contact Input 26 1
73 Virtual Output 42 2 122 Contact Input 27 1
74 Virtual Output 43 2 123 Contact Input 28 1
75 Virtual Output 44 2 124 Contact Input 29 1
76 Virtual Output 45 2 125 Contact Input 30 1
77 Virtual Output 46 2 126 Contact Input 31 1
78 Virtual Output 47 2 127 Contact Input 32 1
79 Virtual Output 48 2 128 Contact Input 33 1
80 Virtual Output 49 2 129 Contact Input 34 1
81 Virtual Output 50 2 130 Contact Input 35 1
82 Virtual Output 51 2 131 Contact Input 36 1
83 Virtual Output 52 2 132 Contact Input 37 1
84 Virtual Output 53 2 133 Contact Input 38 1 E
85 Virtual Output 54 2 134 Contact Input 39 1
86 Virtual Output 55 2 135 Contact Input 40 1
87 Virtual Output 56 2 136 Contact Input 41 1
88 Virtual Output 57 2 137 Contact Input 42 1
89 Virtual Output 58 2 138 Contact Input 43 1
90 Virtual Output 59 2 139 Contact Input 44 1
91 Virtual Output 60 2 140 Contact Input 45 1
92 Virtual Output 61 2 141 Contact Input 46 1
93 Virtual Output 62 2 142 Contact Input 47 1
94 Virtual Output 63 2 143 Contact Input 48 1
95 Virtual Output 64 2 144 Contact Input 49 1
96 Contact Input 1 1 145 Contact Input 50 1
97 Contact Input 2 1 146 Contact Input 51 1
98 Contact Input 3 1 147 Contact Input 52 1
99 Contact Input 4 1 148 Contact Input 53 1
100 Contact Input 5 1 149 Contact Input 54 1
101 Contact Input 6 1 150 Contact Input 55 1
102 Contact Input 7 1 151 Contact Input 56 1
103 Contact Input 8 1 152 Contact Input 57 1
104 Contact Input 9 1 153 Contact Input 58 1
105 Contact Input 10 1 154 Contact Input 59 1
106 Contact Input 11 1 155 Contact Input 60 1
107 Contact Input 12 1 156 Contact Input 61 1
108 Contact Input 13 1 157 Contact Input 62 1
109 Contact Input 14 1 158 Contact Input 63 1
110 Contact Input 15 1 159 Contact Input 64 1
111 Contact Input 16 1 160 Contact Input 65 1
112 Contact Input 17 1 161 Contact Input 66 1
Table E–3: BINARY INPUTS (Sheet 5 of 10) Table E–3: BINARY INPUTS (Sheet 6 of 10)
POINT NAME/DESCRIPTION CHANGE EVENT POINT NAME/DESCRIPTION CHANGE EVENT
INDEX CLASS (1/2/3/NONE) INDEX CLASS (1/2/3/NONE)
162 Contact Input 67 1 211 Contact Output 20 1
163 Contact Input 68 1 212 Contact Output 21 1
164 Contact Input 69 1 213 Contact Output 22 1
165 Contact Input 70 1 214 Contact Output 23 1
166 Contact Input 71 1 215 Contact Output 24 1
167 Contact Input 72 1 216 Contact Output 25 1
168 Contact Input 73 1 217 Contact Output 26 1
169 Contact Input 74 1 218 Contact Output 27 1
170 Contact Input 75 1 219 Contact Output 28 1
171 Contact Input 76 1 220 Contact Output 29 1
172 Contact Input 77 1 221 Contact Output 30 1
173 Contact Input 78 1 222 Contact Output 31 1
174 Contact Input 79 1 223 Contact Output 32 1
175 Contact Input 80 1 224 Contact Output 33 1
176 Contact Input 81 1 225 Contact Output 34 1
177 Contact Input 82 1 226 Contact Output 35 1
178 Contact Input 83 1 227 Contact Output 36 1
179 Contact Input 84 1 228 Contact Output 37 1
180 Contact Input 85 1 229 Contact Output 38 1
181 Contact Input 86 1 230 Contact Output 39 1
E 182 Contact Input 87 1 231 Contact Output 40 1
183 Contact Input 88 1 232 Contact Output 41 1
184 Contact Input 89 1 233 Contact Output 42 1
185 Contact Input 90 1 234 Contact Output 43 1
186 Contact Input 91 1 235 Contact Output 44 1
187 Contact Input 92 1 236 Contact Output 45 1
188 Contact Input 93 1 237 Contact Output 46 1
189 Contact Input 94 1 238 Contact Output 47 1
190 Contact Input 95 1 239 Contact Output 48 1
191 Contact Input 96 1 240 Contact Output 49 1
192 Contact Output 1 1 241 Contact Output 50 1
193 Contact Output 2 1 242 Contact Output 51 1
194 Contact Output 3 1 243 Contact Output 52 1
195 Contact Output 4 1 244 Contact Output 53 1
196 Contact Output 5 1 245 Contact Output 54 1
197 Contact Output 6 1 246 Contact Output 55 1
198 Contact Output 7 1 247 Contact Output 56 1
199 Contact Output 8 1 248 Contact Output 57 1
200 Contact Output 9 1 249 Contact Output 58 1
201 Contact Output 10 1 250 Contact Output 59 1
202 Contact Output 11 1 251 Contact Output 60 1
203 Contact Output 12 1 252 Contact Output 61 1
204 Contact Output 13 1 253 Contact Output 62 1
205 Contact Output 14 1 254 Contact Output 63 1
206 Contact Output 15 1 255 Contact Output 64 1
207 Contact Output 16 1 256 Remote Input 1 1
208 Contact Output 17 1 257 Remote Input 2 1
209 Contact Output 18 1 258 Remote Input 3 1
210 Contact Output 19 1 259 Remote Input 4 1
Table E–3: BINARY INPUTS (Sheet 7 of 10) Table E–3: BINARY INPUTS (Sheet 8 of 10)
POINT NAME/DESCRIPTION CHANGE EVENT POINT NAME/DESCRIPTION CHANGE EVENT
INDEX CLASS (1/2/3/NONE) INDEX CLASS (1/2/3/NONE)
260 Remote Input 5 1 309 PHASE IOC6 Element OP 1
261 Remote Input 6 1 310 PHASE IOC7 Element OP 1
262 Remote Input 7 1 311 PHASE IOC8 Element OP 1
263 Remote Input 8 1 320 PHASE TOC1 Element OP 1
264 Remote Input 9 1 321 PHASE TOC2 Element OP 1
265 Remote Input 10 1 322 PHASE TOC3 Element OP 1
266 Remote Input 11 1 323 PHASE TOC4 Element OP 1
267 Remote Input 12 1 324 PHASE TOC5 Element OP 1
268 Remote Input 13 1 325 PHASE TOC6 Element OP 1
269 Remote Input 14 1 328 PH DIR1 Element OP 1
270 Remote Input 15 1 336 NEUTRAL IOC1 Element OP 1
271 Remote Input 16 1 337 NEUTRAL IOC2 Element OP 1
272 Remote Input 17 1 338 NEUTRAL IOC3 Element OP 1
273 Remote Input 18 1 339 NEUTRAL IOC4 Element OP 1
274 Remote Input 19 1 340 NEUTRAL IOC5 Element OP 1
275 Remote Input 20 1 341 NEUTRAL IOC6 Element OP 1
276 Remote Input 21 1 342 NEUTRAL IOC7 Element OP 1
277 Remote Input 22 1 343 NEUTRAL IOC8 Element OP 1
278 Remote Input 23 1 352 NEUTRAL TOC1 Element OP 1
279 Remote Input 24 1 353 NEUTRAL TOC2 Element OP 1
280 Remote Input 25 1 354 NEUTRAL TOC3 Element OP 1 E
281 Remote Input 26 1 355 NEUTRAL TOC4 Element OP 1
282 Remote Input 27 1 356 NEUTRAL TOC5 Element OP 1
283 Remote Input 28 1 357 NEUTRAL TOC6 Element OP 1
284 Remote Input 29 1 368 GROUND IOC1 Element OP 1
285 Remote Input 30 1 369 GROUND IOC2 Element OP 1
286 Remote Input 31 1 370 GROUND IOC3 Element OP 1
287 Remote Input 32 1 371 GROUND IOC4 Element OP 1
288 Remote Device 1 1 372 GROUND IOC5 Element OP 1
289 Remote Device 2 1 373 GROUND IOC6 Element OP 1
290 Remote Device 3 1 374 GROUND IOC7 Element OP 1
291 Remote Device 4 1 375 GROUND IOC8 Element OP 1
292 Remote Device 5 1 384 GROUND TOC1 Element OP 1
293 Remote Device 6 1 385 GROUND TOC2 Element OP 1
294 Remote Device 7 1 386 GROUND TOC3 Element OP 1
295 Remote Device 8 1 387 GROUND TOC4 Element OP 1
296 Remote Device 9 1 388 GROUND TOC5 Element OP 1
297 Remote Device 10 1 389 GROUND TOC6 Element OP 1
298 Remote Device 11 1 390 RESTD GND FT1 Element OP 1
299 Remote Device 12 1 391 RESTD GND FT2 Element OP 1
300 Remote Device 13 1 392 RESTD GND FT3 Element OP 1
301 Remote Device 14 1 393 RESTD GND FT4 Element OP 1
302 Remote Device 15 1 444 AUX UV1 Element OP 1
303 Remote Device 16 1 448 PHASE UV1 Element OP 1
304 PHASE IOC1 Element OP 1 449 PHASE UV2 Element OP 1
305 PHASE IOC2 Element OP 1 452 AUX OV1 Element OP 1
306 PHASE IOC3 Element OP 1 456 PHASE OV1 Element OP 1
307 PHASE IOC4 Element OP 1 460 NEUTRAL OV1 Element OP 1
308 PHASE IOC5 Element OP 1 512 XFRMR INST DIFF Elemnt OP 1
Table E–3: BINARY INPUTS (Sheet 9 of 10) Table E–3: BINARY INPUTS (Sheet 10 of 10)
POINT NAME/DESCRIPTION CHANGE EVENT POINT NAME/DESCRIPTION CHANGE EVENT
INDEX CLASS (1/2/3/NONE) INDEX CLASS (1/2/3/NONE)
513 XFRMR PCNT DIFF Elemnt OP 1 849 COUNTER 2 Element OP 1
514 VOLTS PER HERTZ1 Elem. OP 1 850 COUNTER 3 Element OP 1
515 VOLTS PER HERTZ2 Elem. OP 1 851 COUNTER 4 Element OP 1
640 SETTING GROUP Element OP 1 852 COUNTER 5 Element OP 1
641 RESET Element OP 1 853 COUNTER 6 Element OP 1
648 OVERFREQ1 Element OP 1 854 COUNTER 7 Element OP 1
649 OVERFREQ2 Element OP 1 855 COUNTER 8 Element OP 1
650 OVERFREQ3 Element OP 1 864 LED State 1 (IN SERVICE) 1
651 OVERFREQ4 Element OP 1 865 LED State 2 (TROUBLE) 1
655 OVERFREQ Element OP 1 866 LED State 3 (TEST MODE) 1
656 UNDERFREQ 1 Element OP 1 867 LED State 4 (TRIP) 1
657 UNDERFREQ 2 Element OP 1 868 LED State 5 (ALARM) 1
658 UNDERFREQ 3 Element OP 1 869 LED State 6(PICKUP) 1
659 UNDERFREQ 4 Element OP 1 880 LED State 9 (VOLTAGE) 1
660 UNDERFREQ 5 Element OP 1 881 LED State 10 (CURRENT) 1
661 UNDERFREQ 6 Element OP 1 882 LED State 11 (FREQUENCY) 1
704 FLEXELEMENT 1 Element OP 1 883 LED State 12 (OTHER) 1
705 FLEXELEMENT 2 Element OP 1 884 LED State 13 (PHASE A) 1
706 FLEXELEMENT 3 Element OP 1 885 LED State 14 (PHASE B) 1
707 FLEXELEMENT 4 Element OP 1 886 LED State 15 (PHASE C) 1
E 708 FLEXELEMENT 5 Element OP 1 887 LED State 16 (NTL/GROUND) 1
709 FLEXELEMENT 6 Element OP 1 898 SNTP FAILURE 1
710 FLEXELEMENT 7 Element OP 1 899 BATTERY FAIL 1
711 FLEXELEMENT 8 Element OP 1 900 PRI ETHERNET FAIL 1
712 FLEXELEMENT 9 Element OP 1 901 SEC ETHERNET FAIL 1
713 FLEXELEMENT 10 Element OP 1 902 EEPROM DATA ERROR 1
714 FLEXELEMENT 11 Element OP 1 903 SRAM DATA ERROR 1
715 FLEXELEMENT 12 Element OP 1 904 PROGRAM MEMORY 1
716 FLEXELEMENT 13 Element OP 1 905 WATCHDOG ERROR 1
717 FLEXELEMENT 14 Element OP 1 906 LOW ON MEMORY 1
718 FLEXELEMENT 15 Element OP 1 907 REMOTE DEVICE OFF 1
719 FLEXELEMENT 16 Element OP 1 908 DIRECT DEVICE OFF
816 DIG ELEM 1 Element OP 1 909 DIRECT RING BREAK
817 DIG ELEM 2 Element OP 1 910 ANY MINOR ERROR 1
818 DIG ELEM 3 Element OP 1 911 ANY MAJOR ERROR 1
819 DIG ELEM 4 Element OP 1 912 ANY SELF-TESTS 1
820 DIG ELEM 5 Element OP 1 913 IRIG-B FAILURE 1
821 DIG ELEM 6 Element OP 1 914 DSP ERROR 1
822 DIG ELEM 7 Element OP 1 916 NO DSP INTERUPTS 1
823 DIG ELEM 8 Element OP 1 917 UNIT NOT CALIBRATED 1
824 DIG ELEM 9 Element OP 1 921 PROTOTYPE FIRMWARE 1
825 DIG ELEM 10 Element OP 1 922 FLEXLOGIC ERR TOKEN 1
826 DIG ELEM 11 Element OP 1 923 EQUIPMENT MISMATCH 1
827 DIG ELEM 12 Element OP 1 925 UNIT NOT PROGRAMMED 1
828 DIG ELEM 13 Element OP 1 926 SYSTEM EXCEPTION 1
829 DIG ELEM 14 Element OP 1 927 LATCHING OUT ERROR 1
830 DIG ELEM 15 Element OP 1
831 DIG ELEM 16 Element OP 1
848 COUNTER 1 Element OP 1
Supported Control Relay Output Block fields: Pulse On, Pulse Off, Latch On, Latch Off, Paired Trip, Paired Close.
E.2.3 COUNTERS
The following table lists both Binary Counters (Object 20) and Frozen Counters (Object 21). When a freeze function is per-
formed on a Binary Counter point, the frozen value is available in the corresponding Frozen Counter point.
BINARY COUNTERS
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 20
Change Event Object Number: 22
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read), 7 (freeze), 8 (freeze noack), 9 (freeze and clear),
10 (freeze and clear, noack), 22 (assign class)
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Binary Counter with Flag)
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Counter Change Event without time)
Change Event Buffer Size: 10
Default Class for all points: 2
FROZEN COUNTERS
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 21
Change Event Object Number: 23
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read)
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Frozen Counter with Flag)
E Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Frozen Counter Event without time)
Change Event Buffer Size: 10
Default Class for all points: 2
A counter freeze command has no meaning for counters 8 and 9. T60 Digital Counter values are represented as 32-bit inte-
gers. The DNP 3.0 protocol defines counters to be unsigned integers. Care should be taken when interpreting negative
counter values.
The following table lists Analog Inputs (Object 30). It is important to note that 16-bit and 32-bit variations of analog inputs
are transmitted through DNP as signed numbers. Even for analog input points that are not valid as negative values, the
maximum positive representation is 32767 for 16-bit values and 2147483647 for 32-bit values. This is a DNP requirement.
The deadbands for all Analog Input points are in the same units as the Analog Input quantity. For example, an Analog Input
quantity measured in volts has a corresponding deadband in units of volts. This is in conformance with DNP Technical Bul-
letin 9809-001 Analog Input Reporting Deadband. Relay settings are available to set default deadband values according to
data type. Deadbands for individual Analog Input Points can be set using DNP Object 34.
When using the T60 in DNP systems with limited memory, the Analog Input Points below may be replaced with a user-
definable list. This user-definable list uses the same settings as the Modbus User Map and can be configured with the Mod-
bus User Map settings. When used with DNP, each entry in the Modbus User Map represents the starting Modbus address
of a data item available as a DNP Analog Input point. To enable use of the Modbus User Map for DNP Analog Input points,
set the USER MAP FOR DNP ANALOGS setting to Enabled (this setting is in the PRODUCT SETUP COMMUNICATIONS
DNP PROTOCOL menu). The new DNP Analog points list can be checked via the “DNP Analog Input Points List” webpage,
accessible from the “Device Information menu” webpage.
After changing the USER MAP FOR DNP ANALOGS setting, the relay must be powered off and then back on for the set-
ting to take effect.
NOTE
Only Source 1 data points are shown in the following table. If the NUMBER OF SOURCES IN ANALOG LIST setting is increased,
data points for subsequent sources will be added to the list immediately following the Source 1 data points.
Units for Analog Input points are as follows:
• Current: A (amps) • Frequency: Hz (hertz)
• Voltage: V (volts) • Angle: degrees
E
• Real Power: W (watts) • Ohm Input: ohms
• Reactive Power: var (vars) • RTD Input: °C (degrees Celsius)
• Apparent Power: VA (volt-amps)
• Energy Wh, varh (watt-hours, var-hours)
Table E–6: ANALOG INPUT POINTS (Sheet 1 of 6) Table E–6: ANALOG INPUT POINTS (Sheet 2 of 6)
POINT DESCRIPTION POINT DESCRIPTION
0 SRC 1 Phase A Current RMS 52 SRC 1 Phase B Real Power
1 SRC 1 Phase B Current RMS 53 SRC 1 Phase C Real Power
2 SRC 1 Phase C Current RMS 54 SRC 1 Three Phase Reactive Power
3 SRC 1 Neutral Current RMS 55 SRC 1 Phase A Reactive Power
4 SRC 1 Phase A Current Magnitude 56 SRC 1 Phase B Reactive Power
5 SRC 1 Phase A Current Angle 57 SRC 1 Phase C Reactive Power
6 SRC 1 Phase B Current Magnitude 58 SRC 1 Three Phase Apparent Power
7 SRC 1 Phase B Current Angle 59 SRC 1 Phase A Apparent Power
8 SRC 1 Phase C Current Magnitude 60 SRC 1 Phase B Apparent Power
9 SRC 1 Phase C Current Angle 61 SRC 1 Phase C Apparent Power
10 SRC 1 Neutral Current Magnitude 62 SRC 1 Three Phase Power Factor
11 SRC 1 Neutral Current Angle 63 SRC 1 Phase A Power Factor
12 SRC 1 Ground Current RMS 64 SRC 1 Phase B Power Factor
13 SRC 1 Ground Current Magnitude 65 SRC 1 Phase C Power Factor
14 SRC 1 Ground Current Angle 66 SRC 1 Positive Watthour
15 SRC 1 Zero Sequence Current Magnitude 67 SRC 1 Negative Watthour
16 SRC 1 Zero Sequence Current Angle 68 SRC 1 Positive Varhour
17 SRC 1 Positive Sequence Current Magnitude 69 SRC 1 Negative Varhour
18 SRC 1 Positive Sequence Current Angle 70 SRC 1 Frequency
19 SRC 1 Negative Sequence Current Magnitude 71 SRC 1 Demand Ia
20 SRC 1 Negative Sequence Current Angle 72 SRC 1 Demand Ib
E 21
22
SRC 1 Differential Ground Current Magnitude
SRC 1 Differential Ground Current Angle
73
74
SRC 1 Demand Ic
SRC 1 Demand Watt
23 SRC 1 Phase AG Voltage RMS 75 SRC 1 Demand Var
24 SRC 1 Phase BG Voltage RMS 76 SRC 1 Demand Va
25 SRC 1 Phase CG Voltage RMS 77 SRC 1 Ia THD
26 SRC 1 Phase AG Voltage Magnitude 78 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[0]
27 SRC 1 Phase AG Voltage Angle 79 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[1]
28 SRC 1 Phase BG Voltage Magnitude 80 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[2]
29 SRC 1 Phase BG Voltage Angle 81 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[3]
30 SRC 1 Phase CG Voltage Magnitude 82 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[4]
31 SRC 1 Phase CG Voltage Angle 83 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[5]
32 SRC 1 Phase AB Voltage RMS 84 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[6]
33 SRC 1 Phase BC Voltage RMS 85 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[7]
34 SRC 1 Phase CA Voltage RMS 86 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[8]
35 SRC 1 Phase AB Voltage Magnitude 87 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[9]
36 SRC 1 Phase AB Voltage Angle 88 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[10]
37 SRC 1 Phase BC Voltage Magnitude 89 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[11]
38 SRC 1 Phase BC Voltage Angle 90 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[12]
39 SRC 1 Phase CA Voltage Magnitude 91 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[13]
40 SRC 1 Phase CA Voltage Angle 92 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[14]
41 SRC 1 Auxiliary Voltage RMS 93 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[15]
42 SRC 1 Auxiliary Voltage Magnitude 94 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[16]
43 SRC 1 Auxiliary Voltage Angle 95 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[17]
44 SRC 1 Zero Sequence Voltage Magnitude 96 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[18]
45 SRC 1 Zero Sequence Voltage Angle 97 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[19]
46 SRC 1 Positive Sequence Voltage Magnitude 98 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[20]
47 SRC 1 Positive Sequence Voltage Angle 99 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[21]
48 SRC 1 Negative Sequence Voltage Magnitude 100 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[22]
49 SRC 1 Negative Sequence Voltage Angle 101 SRC 1 Ia Harmonics[23]
50 SRC 1 Three Phase Real Power 102 SRC 1 Ib THD
51 SRC 1 Phase A Real Power 103 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[0]
Table E–6: ANALOG INPUT POINTS (Sheet 3 of 6) Table E–6: ANALOG INPUT POINTS (Sheet 4 of 6)
POINT DESCRIPTION POINT DESCRIPTION
104 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[1] 156 Transformer Restraint Phasor Iar Angle
105 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[2] 157 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Iad Magnitude
106 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[3] 158 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Iad Angle
107 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[4] 159 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Iad Magnitude
108 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[5] 160 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Iad Angle
109 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[6] 161 Transformer Differential Phasor Ibd Magnitude
110 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[7] 162 Transformer Differential Phasor Ibd Angle
111 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[8] 163 Transformer Restraint Phasor Ibr Magnitude
112 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[9] 164 Transformer Restraint Phasor Ibr Angle
113 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[10] 165 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Ibd Magnitude
114 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[11] 166 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Ibd Angle
115 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[12] 167 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Ibd Magnitude
116 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[13] 168 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Ibd Angle
117 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[14] 169 Transformer Differential Phasor Icd Magnitude
118 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[15] 170 Transformer Differential Phasor Icd Angle
119 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[16] 171 Transformer Restraint Phasor Icr Magnitude
120 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[17] 172 Transformer Restraint Phasor Icr Angle
121 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[18] 173 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Icd Magnitude
122 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[19] 174 Transformer Differential 2nd Harm Icd Angle
123 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[20] 175 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Icd Magnitude
124 SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[21] 176 Transformer Differential 5th Harm Icd Angle
125
126
SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[22]
SRC 1 Ib Harmonics[23]
177
178
DCMA Inputs 1 Value
DCMA Inputs 2 Value
E
127 SRC 1 Ic THD 179 DCMA Inputs 3 Value
128 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[0] 180 DCMA Inputs 4 Value
129 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[1] 181 DCMA Inputs 5 Value
130 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[2] 182 DCMA Inputs 6 Value
131 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[3] 183 DCMA Inputs 7 Value
132 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[4] 184 DCMA Inputs 8 Value
133 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[5] 185 DCMA Inputs 9 Value
134 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[6] 186 DCMA Inputs 10 Value
135 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[7] 187 DCMA Inputs 11 Value
136 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[8] 188 DCMA Inputs 12 Value
137 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[9] 189 DCMA Inputs 13 Value
138 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[10] 190 DCMA Inputs 14 Value
139 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[11] 191 DCMA Inputs 15 Value
140 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[12] 192 DCMA Inputs 16 Value
141 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[13] 193 DCMA Inputs 17 Value
142 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[14] 194 DCMA Inputs 18 Value
143 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[15] 195 DCMA Inputs 19 Value
144 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[16] 196 DCMA Inputs 20 Value
145 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[17] 197 DCMA Inputs 21 Value
146 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[18] 198 DCMA Inputs 22 Value
147 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[19] 199 DCMA Inputs 23 Value
148 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[20] 200 DCMA Inputs 24 Value
149 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[21] 201 RTD Inputs 1 Value
150 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[22] 202 RTD Inputs 2 Value
151 SRC 1 Ic Harmonics[23] 203 RTD Inputs 3 Value
152 Transformer Reference Winding 204 RTD Inputs 4 Value
153 Transformer Differential Phasor Iad Magnitude 205 RTD Inputs 5 Value
154 Transformer Differential Phasor Iad Angle 206 RTD Inputs 6 Value
155 Transformer Restraint Phasor Iar Magnitude 207 RTD Inputs 7 Value
Table E–6: ANALOG INPUT POINTS (Sheet 5 of 6) Table E–6: ANALOG INPUT POINTS (Sheet 6 of 6)
POINT DESCRIPTION POINT DESCRIPTION
208 RTD Inputs 8 Value 260 FlexElement 11 Actual
209 RTD Inputs 9 Value 261 FlexElement 12 Actual
210 RTD Inputs 10 Value 262 FlexElement 13 Actual
211 RTD Inputs 11 Value 263 FlexElement 14 Actual
212 RTD Inputs 12 Value 264 FlexElement 15 Actual
213 RTD Inputs 13 Value 265 FlexElement 16 Actual
214 RTD Inputs 14 Value 266 Current Setting Group
215 RTD Inputs 15 Value 267 VHZ 1 Actual
216 RTD Inputs 16 Value 268 VHZ 2 Actual
217 RTD Inputs 17 Value
218 RTD Inputs 18 Value
219 RTD Inputs 19 Value
220 RTD Inputs 20 Value
221 RTD Inputs 21 Value
222 RTD Inputs 22 Value
223 RTD Inputs 23 Value
224 RTD Inputs 24 Value
225 RTD Inputs 25 Value
226 RTD Inputs 26 Value
227 RTD Inputs 27 Value
228 RTD Inputs 28 Value
E 229
230
RTD Inputs 29 Value
RTD Inputs 30 Value
231 RTD Inputs 31 Value
232 RTD Inputs 32 Value
233 RTD Inputs 33 Value
234 RTD Inputs 34 Value
235 RTD Inputs 35 Value
236 RTD Inputs 36 Value
237 RTD Inputs 37 Value
238 RTD Inputs 38 Value
239 RTD Inputs 39 Value
240 RTD Inputs 40 Value
241 RTD Inputs 41 Value
242 RTD Inputs 42 Value
243 RTD Inputs 43 Value
244 RTD Inputs 44 Value
245 RTD Inputs 45 Value
246 RTD Inputs 46 Value
247 RTD Inputs 47 Value
248 RTD Inputs 48 Value
249 Tracking Frequency
250 FlexElement 1 Actual
251 FlexElement 2 Actual
252 FlexElement 3 Actual
253 FlexElement 4 Actual
254 FlexElement 5 Actual
255 FlexElement 6 Actual
256 FlexElement 7 Actual
257 FlexElement 8 Actual
258 FlexElement 9 Actual
259 FlexElement 10 Actual
3-16 3-16 Update Updated TRANSDUCER I/O MODULE WIRING diagram to 827831A9-X1.
2-4 2-4 Update Updated ORDER CODES table to add the 67 Digital I/O option.
2-5 2-5 Update Updated ORDER CODES FOR REPLACEMENT MODULES table to add the 67 Module option.
3-11 3-11 Update Updated DIGITAL I/O MODULE ASSIGNMENTS table to add the 67 module.
3-13 3-13 Update Updated the DIGITAL I/O MODULE WIRING diagram to show the 67 module.
B-8 B-8 Update Updated MODBUS MEMORY MAP to reflect new firmware 3.4x.
2-5 2-5 Update Added specifications for SELECTOR SWITCH, CONTROL PUSHBUTTONS, USER-DEFINABLE
DISPLAYS, DIRECT INPUTS, DIRECT OUTPUTS, LATCHING OUTPUTS, and LED TEST.
3-11 3-11 Update Updated DIGITAL I/O MODULE ASSIGNMENTS table to add the 4A, 4B, 4C, and 4L modules.
3-13 3-13 Update Updated the DIGITAL I/O MODULE WIRING diagram to 827719CX.
3-30 3-29 Add Added section for IEEE C37.94 Direct I/O communications.
B-8 B-8 Update Updated MODBUS MEMORY MAP to reflect new firmware 3.3x features.
1-6 1-6 Update Updated CONNECTING URPC WITH THE T60 section to reflect new URPC software. F
2-3 2-3 Update Updated OTHER DEVICE FUNCTIONS table to include User-Programmable Fault Reports and
User-Programmable Self Tests
2-6 2-6 Add Added specifications for USER-PROGRAMMABLE FAULT REPORT element.
3-6 3-6 Update Updated TYPICAL WIRING DIAGRAM to drawing number 828712AD.
5-13 5-13 Update Updated UCA/MMS PROTOCOL sub-section to include two new settings.
5-17 5-16 Add Added USER-PROGRAMMABLE FAULT REPORT section.
5-22 5-21 Add Added USER-PROGRAMMABLE SELF-TESTS section.
5-52 5-51 Update Updated FLEXLOGIC™ OPERANDS table to include firmware revision 3.2x features.
5-96 5-96 Update Updated RESTRICTED GROUND FAULT section.
6-16 6-16 Add Added RESTRICTED GROUND FAULT actual values section.
6-17 6-17 Add Added USER-PROGRAMMABLE FAULT REPORT actual values section.
B-9 B-8 Update Updated MODBUS MEMORY MAP to reflect new firmware 3.2x features.
In the event of a failure covered by warranty, GE Multilin will undertake to repair or replace the relay
providing the warrantor determined that it is defective and it is returned with all transportation
charges prepaid to an authorized service centre or the factory. Repairs or replacement under war-
ranty will be made without charge.
Warranty shall not apply to any relay which has been subject to misuse, negligence, accident,
incorrect installation or use not in accordance with instructions nor any unit that has been altered
outside a GE Multilin authorized factory outlet.
F GE Multilin is not liable for special, indirect or consequential damages or for loss of profit or for
expenses sustained as a result of a relay malfunction, incorrect application or adjustment.
For complete text of Warranty (including limitations and disclaimers), refer to GE Multilin Standard
Conditions of Sale.
INDEX
specifications ................................................................ 2-11 contact inputs .................................. 2-10, 3-13, 5-129, 5-144
FREQUENCY dcmA inputs ................................................2-10, 3-16, 5-142
actual values ................................................................. 6-15 direct inputs ................................................................... 2-10
IRIG-B .................................................................. 2-10, 3-19
settings ..........................................................................5-95
METERING specifications .................................................................. 2-6
conventions .............................................................. 6-8, 6-9 NEUTRAL OVERVOLTAGE
current ............................................................................ 2-9 FlexLogic™ operands .....................................................5-61
demand ........................................................................... 2-9